10-K

HANCOCK WHITNEY CORP (HWC)

10-K 2026-02-27 For: 2025-12-31
View Original
Added on April 07, 2026

Table of Contents

Dece1IRA

UNITED STATES

SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

Washington, D. C. 20549

FORM 10-K

ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2025

OR

TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

Commission file number 001-36872

Hancock Whitney Corporation

(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)

Mississippi 64-0693170
(State or other jurisdiction of incorporation or organization) (I.R.S. Employer Identification Number)
Hancock Whitney Plaza<br><br>2510 14th Street <br>Gulfport, Mississippi 39501
--- ---
(Address of principal executive offices) (Zip Code)

(228) 868-4000

Registrant’s telephone number, including area code

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:

Title of Each Class Trading Symbol Name of Exchange on Which Registered
Common Stock, par value $3.33 per share HWC The NASDAQ Stock Market, LLC
6.25% Subordinated Notes HWCPZ The NASDAQ Stock Market, LLC

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act: NONE

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act. Yes ☒ No ☐

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act. Yes ☐ No ☒

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports) and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days. Yes ☒ No ☐

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically every Interactive Data File required to be submitted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit such files). Yes ☒ No ☐

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer small reporting company or an emerging growth company. See definitions of “ large accelerated filer” “accelerated filer,” “smaller reporting company,” and “emerging growth company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act:

Large accelerated filer Accelerated filer
Non-accelerated filer Smaller reporting company
Emerging growth company

If an emerging growth company, indicate by check mark if the registrant has elected not to use the extended transition period for complying with any new or revised financial accounting standards provided pursuant to Section 13(a) of the Exchange Act. 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has filed a report on and attestation to its management’s assessment of the effectiveness of its internal control over financial reporting under Section 404(b) of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act (15 U.S.C. 7262(b)) by the registered public accounting firm that prepared or issued its audit report. ☒

If securities are registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act, indicate by check mark whether the financial statements of the registrant included in the filing reflect the correction of an error to previously issued financial statements. ☐

Indicate by check mark whether any of those error corrections are restatements that required a recovery analysis of incentive-based compensation received by any of the registrant's executive officers during the relevant recovery period pursuant to §240.10D-1(b). ☐

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Act). Yes ☐ No ☒

The aggregate market value of the voting stock held by nonaffiliates of the registrant was $4.9 billion based upon the closing market price on NASDAQ on June 30, 2025. For purposes of this calculation only, shares held by nonaffiliates are deemed to consist of (a) shares held by all shareholders other than directors and executive officers of the registrant plus (b) shares held by directors and officers as to which beneficial ownership has been disclaimed.

On January 31, 2026, the registrant had 81,662,941 shares of common stock outstanding.

DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE

Portions of the definitive proxy statement for our annual meeting of shareholders to be filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC” or “the Commission”) are incorporated by reference into Part III of this Report.

Table of Contents

Hancock Whitney Corporation

Form 10-K

Index

PART I
ITEM 1. BUSINESS 7
ITEM 1A. RISK FACTORS 26
ITEM 1B. UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS 41
ITEM 1C. CYBERSECURITY 41
ITEM 2. PROPERTIES 43
ITEM 3. LEGAL PROCEEDINGS 43
ITEM 4. MINE SAFETY DISCLOSURES 43
PART II
ITEM 5. MARKET FOR THE REGISTRANT’S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS <br>AND ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES 44
ITEM 6. RESERVED 45
ITEM 7. MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS <br>OF OPERATIONS 46
ITEM 7A. QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK 82
ITEM 8. FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA 83
ITEM 9. CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND <br>FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE 146
ITEM 9A. CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES 146
ITEM 9B. OTHER INFORMATION 146
ITEM 9C. DISCLOSURE REGARDING FOREIGN JURISDICTIONS THAT PREVENT INSPECTIONS 146
PART III
ITEM 10. DIRECTORS, EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND CORPORATE GOVERNANCE 147
ITEM 11. EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION 147
ITEM 12. SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT AND <br>RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS 147
ITEM 13. CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS, AND DIRECTOR INDEPENDENCE 147
ITEM 14. PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTANT FEES AND SERVICES 147
PART IV
ITEM 15. EXHIBITS, FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES 148
ITEM 16 FORM 10-K SUMMARY 151

Table of Contents

Hancock Whitney Corporation

Glossary of Defined Terms

Entities:

Hancock Whitney Corporation – a financial holding company registered with the Securities and Exchange Commission

Hancock Whitney Bank – a wholly-owned subsidiary of Hancock Whitney Corporation through which Hancock Whitney Corporation conducts its banking operations

Hancock Whitney Investment Services – a wholly owned subsidiary of Hancock Whitney Corporation, through which Hancock Whitney Corporation conducts limited broker-dealer services

Company – Hancock Whitney Corporation and its consolidated subsidiaries

Parent – Hancock Whitney Corporation, exclusive of its subsidiaries

Bank – Hancock Whitney Bank

Other Terms:

ACL – Allowance for credit losses

AFS – Available for sale securities

AI – Artificial Intelligence

ALCO – Asset Liability Management Committee

ALLL – Allowance for loan and lease losses

AML – Anti-money laundering

AOCI – Accumulated other comprehensive income or loss

ARG – Associate resource groups

ASC – Accounting Standards Codification

ASR– Accelerated share repurchase

ASU– Accounting Standards Update

ATM – Automated teller machine

Basel III - Basel Committee's 2010 Regulatory Capital Framework (Third Accord)

Beta – amount by which loan yields or deposit costs change in response to movements in market rates

BOLI – Bank-owned life insurance

bp(s) – basis point(s)

C&I – Commercial and industrial loans

CAMT – Corporate Alternative Minimum Tax

CD – Certificate of deposit

CDE – Community Development Entity

CECL – Current Expected Credit Losses

CEO – Chief Executive Officer

CET1 – Common equity tier 1 capital as defined by Basel III capital rules

CFPB – Consumer Financial Protection Bureau

CFO – Chief Financial Officer

CISO – Chief Information Security Officer

CMO – Collateralized mortgage obligation

Core client deposits – total deposits excluding public funds and brokered deposits

Core deposits – total deposits excluding certificates of deposit of $250,000 or more and brokered deposits

COSO – Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission

CRA – Community Reinvestment Act of 1977

CRE – Commercial real estate

DEI – Diversity, equity and inclusion

DIF – Deposit Insurance Fund

Table of Contents

Dodd-Frank Act – The Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act

ERM – Enterprise risk management

ESG – Environmental, Social and Governance; term used in discussion of risks and corporate policies related to those items

EVE – Economic Value of Equity

Excess Liquidity – deposits held at the Federal Reserve above normal levels

FASB – Financial Accounting Standards Board

FDIC – Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation

FDICIA – Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation Improvement Act of 1991

Federal Reserve Board – The 7-member Board of Governors that oversees the Federal Reserve System, establishes monetary policy (interest rates, credit, etc.), and monitors the economic health of the country. Its members are appointed by the President, subject to Senate confirmation, and serve 14-year terms.

Federal Reserve System – The 12 Federal Reserve Banks, with each one serving member banks in its own district. This system, supervised by the Federal Reserve Board, has broad regulatory powers over the money supply and the credit structure. They implement the policies of the Federal Reserve Board and also conduct economic research.

FFIEC – Federal Financial Institutions Examination Council

FHA – Federal Housing Administration

FHLB – Federal Home Loan Bank

GAAP – Generally Accepted Accounting Principles in the United States of America

HTM – Held to maturity securities

ICS – Insured cash sweep

IRR – Interest rate risk

IRS – Internal Revenue Service

IT – Information Technology

LIHTC – Low Income Housing Tax Credit

LTIP – Long-term incentive plan

MBS – Mortgage-backed securities

MD&A – Management’s discussion and analysis of financial condition and results of operations

MDBCF – Mississippi Department of Banking and Consumer Finance

MEFD – reportable modified loans to borrowers experiencing financial difficulty, as defined by ASC 326 effective January 1, 2023

NAICS – North American Industry Classification System

NII – Net interest income

n/m – not meaningful

NOL – Net operating loss

NSF – Nonsufficient funds

OBBBA – “An Act to Provide for Reconciliation Pursuant to Title II of H. Con. Res. 14,” more commonly referred to as the “One Big Beautiful Bill Act,” enacted of July 4, 2025

OCI – Other comprehensive income or loss

OD – Overdraft

ORE – Other real estate defined as foreclosed and surplus real estate

PCD – Purchased credit deteriorated loans, as defined by ASC 326

Pension Plan – the Hancock Whitney Corporation Pension Plan and Trust Agreement

PPNR – Pre-provision net revenue, a non-GAAP measure

QSCB – Qualified School Construction Bonds

QZAB – Qualified Zone Academy Bonds

RSA – restricted share awards

RSU – restricted stock units

Sabal – Sabal Trust Company, an entity acquired May 2, 2025

SBA – Small Business Administration

SBIC – Small Business Investment Company

Table of Contents

SEC – U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission

Securities Act – Securities Act of 1933, as amended

Short-term Investments – the sum of Interest-bearing bank deposits and Federal funds sold

SOFR – Secured Overnight Financing Rate

Supplemental disclosure items – certain highlighted items that are outside of our principal business and/or are not indicative of forward-looking trends.

TBA – To Be Announced security contracts

te – taxable equivalent adjustment, or the term used to indicate that a financial measure is presented on a fully taxable equivalent basis

TSR – Total shareholder return

USA Patriot Act – Uniting and Strengthening America by Providing Appropriate Tools Required to Intercept and Obstruct Terrorism Act of 2001

U.S. Treasury – The United States Department of the Treasury

Volcker Rule – Section 619 of the Dodd-Frank Act and regulations promulgated thereunder, as applicable

401(k) Plan – the Hancock Whitney Corporation 401(k) Savings Plan and Trust Agreement

Table of Contents

PART I

FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

This report contains forward-looking statements within the meaning and protections of section 27A of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and section 21E of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended. Important factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from the forward-looking statements we make in this annual report are set forth in this Annual Report on Form 10-K and in other reports or documents that we file from time to time with the SEC and include, but are not limited to, the following:

  • general economic and business conditions in our local markets, including conditions affecting employment levels, interest rates, inflation, the threat of recession, volatile equity capital markets, property and casualty insurance costs, collateral values, customer income, creditworthiness and confidence, spending and savings that may affect customer bankruptcies, defaults, charge-offs and deposit activity; and the impact of the foregoing on client behavior, including the velocity and levels of deposit withdrawals and loan repayment, the risk of accelerated deposit outflows driven by digital banking channels, real-time payments, or social media-driven concerns that may materially increase liquidity risk;
  • uncertainties surrounding geopolitical events, trade policy, taxation policy, and monetary policy which continue to impact the outlook for future economic growth; impacts from current and/or future imposition of tariffs by the United States against other nations; consideration of responsive actions by these nations, including retaliatory tariffs, or the expansion of import fees and tariffs among a larger group of nations continues to bring greater ambiguity to the outlook for future economic growth, including volatility in consumer spending, lower economic growth or recession, reduced demand for banking products and services, and negative credit quality developments arising from the foregoing or other factors;
  • balance sheet and revenue growth expectations may differ from actual results;
  • the risk that our provision for credit losses may be inadequate or may be negatively affected by credit risk exposure;
  • loan growth expectations;
  • management’s predictions about charge-offs;
  • fluctuations in commercial and residential real estate values, especially as they relate to the value of collateral supporting the Company’s loans;
  • the risk that our enterprise risk management framework may not identify or address risks adequately, which may result in unexpected losses;
  • the impact of current (including Sabal Trust Company) and future business combinations on our performance and financial condition including our ability to successfully integrate the businesses;
  • the potential impact of third-party business combinations in our footprint on our performance and financial condition;
  • deposit trends, including growth, pricing and betas;
  • credit quality trends;
  • changes in interest rates, including actions taken by the Federal Reserve Board and the impact of fluctuations in interest rates on our financial projections, models and guidance;
  • net interest margin trends, including the impact of changes in interest rates;
  • changes in the cost and availability of funding due to changes in the deposit and credit markets;
  • success of revenue-generating and cost-reducing initiatives;
  • future expense levels;
  • changes in expense to revenue (efficiency ratio), including the risk that we may not realize and/or sustain benefits from our efficiency and growth initiatives or that we may not be able to realize cost savings or revenue benefits in the time period expected, which could negatively affect our future profitability;
  • the effectiveness of derivative financial instruments and hedging activities to manage risks;
  • risks related to our reliance on third parties to provide key components of our business infrastructure, including the risks related to disruptions in services or financial difficulties of a third-party vendor;
  • risks related to potential claims, damages, penalties, fines and reputational damage resulting from pending or future litigation, regulatory proceedings or enforcement actions;
  • risks related to the ability of our operational framework to manage risks associated with our business such as credit risk and operation risk, including third-party vendors and other service providers, which could, among other things, result in a material breach of operating or security systems as a result of a cyber-attack or similar acts;

Table of Contents

  • the extensive use, reliability, disruption, and accuracy of the models and data upon which we rely, including evolving supervisory expectations regarding model governance, validation, transparency, and explainability, particularly for models incorporating artificial intelligence (AI);
  • risks related to our implementation of new lines of business, new products and services, new technologies, and expansion of our existing business opportunities, including entering and/or expanding markets through de novo branching;
  • projected tax rates;
  • future profitability;
  • purchase accounting impacts, such as accretion levels;
  • our ability to identify and address potential cybersecurity risks and/or breaches, which may be exacerbated by recent developments in generative AI, on our systems and/or third-party vendors and service providers on which we rely, a material failure of which could disrupt our business and result in the disclosure of and/or misuse or misappropriation of confidential or proprietary information, disruption or damage to our systems, increased costs, losses, or adverse effects to our reputation, including the increasing sophistication of AI‑enabled fraud and financial crime, which may heighten operational, compliance and reputational risks;
  • our ability to receive dividends from Hancock Whitney Bank could affect our liquidity, including our ability to pay dividends or take other capital actions;
  • the risk that we may be required to make substantial expenditures to keep pace with regulatory initiatives and rapid technology changes in the financial services market;
  • the impact of AI on our business operations, including emerging risks associated with the use of AI‑driven tools in customer interactions, credit processes, operational activities, and internal decision‑making, as well as uncertainty in laws and regulations over AI, our ability to comply with existing and/or future laws regulating development and use of AI;
  • the impact on our financial results, reputation, and business if we are unable to comply with all applicable federal and state regulations or other supervisory actions or directives and any necessary capital initiatives;
  • our ability to effectively compete with other traditional and non-traditional financial services companies, some of whom possess greater financial resources than we do or are subject to different regulatory standards;
  • our ability to maintain adequate internal controls over financial reporting;
  • the financial impact of future regulatory and tax legislation;
  • the effects of geopolitical conflicts, civil unrest, war or other conflicts, acts of terrorism, climate change, natural disasters such as hurricanes, freezes, flooding, man-made disasters, such as oil spills, health emergencies, epidemics or pandemics, or other catastrophic events that may affect general economic conditions, and/or increase costs, including, but not limited to, property and casualty and other insurance costs;
  • action or inaction by the federal government, including as a result of any prolonged government shutdown or government intervention in the U.S. financial system;
  • a deterioration of the credit rating for U.S. long-term sovereign debt, actions that the U.S. government may take to avoid exceeding the debt ceiling, and uncertainties surrounding the federal budget and economic policy;
  • risks related to diversity, equity and inclusion, and environmental, social and governance legislation, rulemaking, activism and litigation, the scope and pace of which could alter our reputation and shareholder, associate, customer and third-party affiliations;
  • changes in laws and regulations affecting our businesses, including governmental monetary and fiscal policies, legislation and regulations relating to bank products and services, increased regulatory scrutiny resulting from bank failures, as well as changes in the enforcement and interpretation of such laws and regulations by applicable governmental and self-regulatory agencies, which could require us to change certain business practices, increase compliance risk, reduce our revenue, impose additional costs on us, or otherwise negatively affect our businesses;
  • adverse developments in the banking industry highlighted by high-profile bank failures and the potential impact of such developments on customer confidence, liquidity and regulatory responses to these developments (including increases in the cost of our deposit insurance assessments), the Company's ability to effectively manage its liquidity risk and any growth plans, and the availability of capital and funding, including the heightened risk that technology‑enabled payment platforms, digital assets, or emerging alternatives such as tokenized deposits or stablecoins may influence customer behavior and deposit flows; and
  • the potential implementation of a regulatory reform agenda under the current administration that is significantly different than that of prior administrations, impacting rulemaking, supervision, examination and enforcement priorities of the federal banking agencies;

Also, any statement that does not describe historical or current facts is a forward-looking statement. These statements often include the words “believes,” “expects,” “anticipates,” “estimates,” “intends,” “plans,” “forecast,” “goals,” “targets,” “initiatives,” “focus,”

Table of Contents

“potentially,” “probably,” “projects,” “outlook” or similar expressions or future conditional verbs such as “may,” “will,” “should,” “would,” and “could.” Forward-looking statements are based upon the current beliefs and expectations of management and on information currently available to management. Our statements speak as of the date hereof, and we do not assume any obligation to update these statements or to update the reasons why actual results could differ from those contained in such statements in light of new information or future events. Factors that could cause actual results to differ from those expressed in the Company’s forward-looking statements include, but are not limited to, those risk factors outlined in Item 1A. “Risk Factors.”

You are cautioned not to place undue reliance on these forward-looking statements. We do not intend, and undertake no obligation, to update or revise any forward-looking statements, whether as a result of differences in actual results, changes in assumptions or changes in other factors affecting such statements, except as required by law.

Table of Contents

ITEM 1. BUSINESS

ORGANIZATION

Hancock Whitney Corporation (the “Company”) is registered with the Federal Reserve as a bank holding company and has elected to be treated as a financial holding company under the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956, as amended. The Company provides comprehensive financial services through its bank subsidiary, Hancock Whitney Bank (the “Bank”), a Mississippi state bank, and other nonbank affiliates. Our principal executive offices are located at 2510 14th Street, Gulfport, Mississippi, 39501, and our telephone number is (800) 522-6542. Our common stock trades on the Nasdaq Global Select Market under the ticker symbol “HWC.”

At December 31, 2025, our balance sheet totaled $35.5 billion, with loans of $24.0 billion and deposits of $29.3 billion.

NATURE OF BUSINESS AND MARKETS

The Bank offers a broad range of traditional and online banking services to commercial, small business and retail customers, providing a variety of transaction and savings deposit products, treasury management services, secured and unsecured loan products (including revolving credit facilities), letters of credit and similar financial guarantees. The Bank provides trust and investment management services to retirement plans, corporations and individuals and provides its customers with access to investment advisory and brokerage products.

We offer other services through bank and nonbank subsidiaries. The Bank’s subsidiaries Hancock Whitney Equipment Finance, LLC and Hancock Whitney Equipment Finance and Leasing, LLC provide commercial finance products to middle market and corporate clients, including leases and related structures. We have other subsidiaries of the Bank for purposes such as facilitating investments in new market tax credit activities and holding certain foreclosed assets. Our holding company’s nonbank subsidiary, Hancock Whitney Investment Services, Inc., provides customers with access to fixed annuity and life insurance products, investment advisory services and also participates in select underwriting transactions, primarily for banking clients.

We operate primarily in southern and central Mississippi; southern and central Alabama; northwest, central and southern Louisiana; the northern, central and panhandle regions of Florida; certain areas of east and northeast Texas; and the metropolitan areas of Nashville, Tennessee and Atlanta, Georgia. At December 31, 2025, we had 180 banking locations and 221 ATMs across our footprint. Our operating strategy is to provide customers with the financial sophistication and range of products of a regional bank, while successfully retaining the commercial appeal and level of service of a community bank.

Our priority is to continue to grow revenue in our existing markets with controlled expenses while providing five-star service through enhanced technology and processes that make banking simpler for our clients. We have and will continue to invest in promoting new and enhanced products and services that contribute to the goal of diversifying our sources of revenue from both new and existing clients. We continue to make progress in our multiyear organic growth plan announced in late 2024 that includes both the hiring of additional revenue-generating associates and expanding our footprint in Florida and Texas. To-date, we have added a net 22 new bankers associated with this growth plan and expect to hire as many as 50 new bankers in 2026 that will support both commercial and business banking growth initiatives. We opened one new financial center in 2025 and expect to open four additional centers in 2026, all located in the North Dallas, Texas area. The May 2025 acquisition of Florida-based Sabal Trust Company expanded our trust and asset management business with the addition of their leadership team and clients, including approximately $3 billion in assets under management. This acquisition provides the opportunity to develop relationships and offer other private banking, wholesale and retail banking products and services in high-growth markets in the central Florida region. We also continue to evaluate future acquisition opportunities that have the potential to increase shareholder value, provided overall economic conditions and our capital levels would support such a transaction.

Additional information regarding the Company and the Bank is available at investors.hancockwhitney.com.

Loan Production, Underwriting Standards and Credit Review

The Bank’s primary lending focus is to provide commercial, consumer and real estate loans to consumers, small and middle market businesses, and corporate clients in the markets served by the Bank. In addition, and to a lesser degree, the Bank makes loans both regionally and nationally, generally through its specialty lines of business, including the equipment finance, commercial real estate and healthcare segments, often with sponsors in our market areas. We seek to provide quality loan products that are attractive to borrowers and profitable to the Bank. We look to build enduring, profitable client relationships over time and maintain a strong presence and position of influence in the communities we serve. Through our relationship-based approach, we have developed a deep knowledge of our customers and the markets in which they operate. We continually work to provide a consistent lending process across our banking footprint, to strengthen the underwriting criteria we employ to evaluate new loans and loan renewals, and to diversify our loan portfolio in terms of type, industry and geographical concentration. We believe that these measures position the

Table of Contents

Bank to meet the credit needs of businesses and consumers in the markets we serve while pursuing a balanced strategy of loan profitability, growth and credit quality.

The following describes the underwriting procedures of the lending function and presents our principal categories of loans. The results of our lending activities and the relative risk of the loan portfolio are discussed in Item 7. “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations.”

The Bank has a set of loan policies, underwriting standards and key underwriting functions designed to achieve a consistent lending and credit review approach. Our underwriting standards address the following criteria:

  • collateral requirements;
  • guarantor requirements (including policies on financial statements, tax returns, and guarantees);
  • appraisal requirements (and their review);
  • loan approval hierarchy;
  • standard consumer and small business credit scoring underwriting criteria (including credit score thresholds, maximum maturity and amortization, loan-to-value limits, global debt service coverage, and debt to income limits);
  • commercial real estate and commercial and industrial underwriting guidelines (including minimum debt service coverage ratio, maximum amortization, minimum equity requirements, and maximum loan-to-value ratios);
  • lending limits; and
  • credit approval authorities.

Additionally, our loan concentration policy sets limits and manages our exposures within specified concentration tolerances, including those to particular borrowers, foreign entities, industries, and property types for commercial real estate. This policy sets standards for portfolio risk management and reporting, monitoring of large borrower concentration limits and systematic tracking of large commercial loans and our portfolio mix. We continually monitor our concentration of commercial real estate, healthcare, shared national credits, leveraged loans and energy-related loans so that the mix is consistent with our risk tolerance. In addition, we also employ enhanced due diligence on select customers, portfolios, industry sectors and concentrations for economic or other risk events to foster alignment between credit risk appetite and concentration risk management. Information related to our loan portfolio concentrations is presented in Table 12, "Commercial and Industrial Loans by Industry Concentration" and Table 13, "Commercial Real Estate-Income Producing and Construction by Property Type Concentration" in Item 7. "Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations."

Our underwriting process is structured to require oversight that is proportional to the size and complexity of the lending relationship. We delegate lending authority primarily to Regional or Senior Commercial Credit Officers and loan credit specialists in our centralized underwriting units, which can be utilized to approve credit commitments for a single borrowing relationship. The limit of delegated authority is based upon the experience, skill and training of the credit officer or loan credit specialist. Minimal loan authority is held by leaders within the originating lines of business and is in place to primarily support limited incremental approvals under specific parameters. Certain types and sizes of loans and relationships must be approved by either one of the Bank’s centralized underwriting units or by Regional or Senior Regional Commercial Credit Officers, either individually or jointly with another member of the Executive Credit Officer group, depending upon the overall size of the borrowing relationship.

Loans are underwritten in accordance with the underwriting standards and loan policies of the Bank. Loans are underwritten primarily on the basis of the borrower’s ability to make timely debt service payments, and secondarily on collateral value. Generally, real estate secured loans and mortgage loans are made when the borrower produces evidence of the ability to make timely debt service payments along with appropriate equity investment in the property. Appropriate and regulatory compliant third-party valuations are required at the time of origination for real estate secured loans.

Loans are assigned internal risk ratings using various processes depending on the type and size of the loan. Internal risk ratings are used in the origination and renewal processes to assess risk on proposed transactions, monitor customer and portfolio quality trends, establish a basis for appropriate pricing, and gauge the degree of attention, servicing and/or monitoring required. Internal risk ratings are updated as new information becomes available as a result of periodic reviews of credit quality, a change in borrower performance or approval of new loan exposure.

Table of Contents

The Bank also has an independent credit review team to provide the Board of Directors and Executive Management with an independent review and monitoring system for evaluating the corporation’s credit quality and compliance with external regulations and internal policies, practices, and procedures related to credit risk exposure. The credit review staff assists in the early identification of credit problems and determines that corrective measures are being taken to reduce or avoid potential losses. This includes reviewing the activities of lending personnel to allow for timely follow-up and corrective action for loans showing signs of deteriorating financial condition. It also encompasses identifying and making corrective recommendations concerning deficiencies existing in the lending function and contributing toward refinement of the Bank’s loan policies.

The following briefly describes the composition of our loan portfolio by segment:

Commercial and industrial

The Bank offers a variety of commercial loan services to a diversified customer base over a broad range of industries. Commercial and industrial loans are made available to businesses for working capital (including financing of inventory and receivables), for business expansion, to facilitate the acquisition of a business, and for the purchase of equipment and machinery, including equipment leasing, among other items.

Commercial non-real estate loans may be secured by the assets being financed or other tangible or intangible business assets such as accounts receivable, inventory, enterprise value, or commodity interest and may incorporate a personal or corporate guarantee; however, some short-term loans may be made on an unsecured basis, including a relatively small portfolio of corporate credit cards, generally issued as a part of overall customer relationships. Asset-based loans, such as accounts receivable and business inventory secured loans, may have limits on borrowing that are based on the collateral values. Our source of repayment for asset-based loans is generally the conversion of those assets to cash and may be substantially dependent on the ability of the borrower to collect amounts due from its customers.

Commercial real estate – owner occupied loans consist of commercial mortgages on properties where repayment is generally dependent on the cash flow from the ongoing operations and activities of the borrower. Like commercial non-real estate, these loans are primarily made based on the identified cash flows of the borrower, but also have the added strength of the value of underlying real estate collateral.

Commercial real estate – income producing

Commercial real estate – income producing loans consist of loans secured by commercial mortgages on properties where the loan is made to real estate developers or investors and repayment is dependent on the sale, refinance or income generated from the operation of the property. Properties financed include multifamily, retail, healthcare related facilities, industrial, office, hotel/motel and restaurants, and other commercial properties.

Repayment of commercial real estate – income producing loans is generally dependent on the successful operation of the property securing the loan. Commercial real estate loans may be adversely affected by conditions in the real estate markets or in the general economy. The properties securing the commercial real estate – income producing portfolios are diverse in terms of type and geographic location. We monitor and evaluate these loans based on collateral, geography and risk grade criteria. Past experience has shown that commercial real estate conditions can be volatile, particularly during economic downturns, so we actively monitor concentrations within this portfolio segment, among others.

Construction and land development

Construction and land development loans are made to facilitate the acquisition, development, improvement and construction of both commercial and residential-purpose properties. Such loans are generally made to builders and investors where repayment is expected to be made from the sale, refinance or operation of the property or to businesses to be used in their operations.

Acquisition and development loans are generally underwritten utilizing feasibility studies, independent appraisal reviews, sensitivity analysis of real estate absorption and lease rates, and financial analysis of the developers and property owners, with consideration of the size and complexity of the facility. Construction loans are largely based upon cost estimates, the amount of sponsor equity investment, and the projected value of the completed project. The Bank monitors the construction process to mitigate or identify risks as they arise. Construction loans often involve the disbursement of substantial funds with repayment largely dependent on the success of the ultimate project. Sources of repayment for these types of construction loans may be permanent loans from external lenders, sales of developed property, or an interim loan commitment from the Bank until permanent financing is obtained. These loans are typically closely monitored by on-site inspections and are considered to have higher risks than other real estate loans due to their ultimate repayment being sensitive to interest rate changes, governmental regulation of real property, general economic conditions, and the availability of long-term financing to repay the construction loan in full.

Table of Contents

Owner occupied loans for the development and improvement of real property to commercial customers to be used in their business operations are underwritten subject to normal commercial and industrial credit standards and are generally subject to project tracking processes, similar to those required for commercial real estate – income producing loans.

This portfolio also includes residential construction loans and loans secured by raw land not yet under development.

Residential Mortgages

Residential mortgages consist of closed-end loans secured by first liens on 1-4 family residential properties. The portfolio includes both fixed and adjustable-rate loans, although most longer-term, fixed-rate loans originated are generally sold in the secondary mortgage market, depending on current strategies. The sale of fixed-rate mortgage loans allows the Bank to manage the interest rate risks related to such lending operations.

Consumer

Consumer loans include second lien mortgage home loans, home equity lines of credit and nonresidential consumer purpose loans. Nonresidential consumer loans are made to finance the purchase of personal property, including automobiles, recreational vehicles and boats, and for other personal purposes (secured and unsecured), and deposit account secured loans. Consumer loans also include a relatively small portfolio of credit card receivables issued on the basis of applications received through referrals from the Bank’s branches, online and other marketing efforts.

The Bank approves consumer loans based on income and financial information submitted by prospective borrowers as well as credit reports collected from various credit agencies. Financial stability and credit history of the borrower are the primary factors the Bank considers in granting such loans. The availability of collateral and whether the borrower is located in the Bank’s primary market areas are also factors considered in making such loans.

Securities Portfolio

The investment portfolio primarily consists of U.S. agency debt securities, U.S. agency mortgage-related securities and obligations of states and municipalities classified as either available for sale or held to maturity. We consider the available for sale portfolio as one of many sources of liquidity available to fund our operations. Investments are made in accordance with an investment policy approved by the Board Risk Committee. Company policies generally limit investments to agency securities and municipal securities determined to be investment grade according to an internally generated score, which generally includes a rating of not less than “Baa” or its equivalent by a nationally recognized statistical rating organization. The investment portfolio is tested monthly under multiple stressed interest rate scenarios, the results of which are used to manage our interest rate risk position. The rate scenarios include regulatory and management agreed upon instantaneous and ramped rate movements that may be up to plus or minus 500 basis points. The combined portfolio has a target effective duration of two to five and a half years.

A significant portion of the securities portfolio is used to secure certain deposits and other liabilities requiring collateralization. We limit the percentage of securities that can be pledged in order to keep a portion of securities available to support liquidity. The securities portfolio can also be pledged to increase our line of credit available at the Federal Home Loan Bank (FHLB) of Dallas and the Federal Reserve Bank of Atlanta.

The investments subcommittee of the asset/liability committee (ALCO) is responsible for the oversight, monitoring and management of the investment portfolio. The investments subcommittee is also responsible for the development of investment strategies for the consideration and approval of ALCO, including purchases, sales, classification as either available for sale or held to maturity, and hedging activities. Final authority and responsibility for all aspects of the conduct of investment activities rests with the Board Risk Committee, all in accordance with the overall guidance and limitations of the investment policy. See Item 7. “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations-Enterprise Risk Management,” for further discussion of the Company's risk management structure and governance.

Deposits

The Bank has several programs designed to attract and retain deposit accounts from consumers and businesses at interest rates generally consistent with market conditions. Deposits are the most significant funding source for the Company’s interest-earning assets. Interest paid on deposits represents a significant component of our interest expense. Deposits are attracted principally from clients within our retail branch network through the offering of a broad array of deposit products to individuals and businesses, including noninterest-bearing demand deposit accounts, interest-bearing transaction accounts, savings accounts, money market deposit accounts, and time deposit accounts. Terms vary among deposit products with respect to commitment periods, minimum balances and applicable fees. Interest rates offered on interest-bearing deposits are determined based on a number of factors, including, but not limited to (1) interest rates offered in local markets by competitors, (2) current and expected economic conditions, (3) anticipated future interest rates, (4) the expected amount and timing of funding needs, and (5) the availability and cost of alternative funding

Table of Contents

sources. Deposit flows are generally controlled primarily through pricing, and to a lesser extent, through promotional activities. Deposit levels can also be, and in the past have been influenced by other factors such as inflows from government stimulus programs, general changes in consumer and business spending behavior, including those as a result of inflation and recessionary concerns, inflows from hurricane-related insurance proceeds, and customer confidence in the institution, among other things. Further, deposit levels are also impacted by the level of brokered deposits, discussed below. Management believes that the rates that it offers on deposit accounts are generally competitive with other financial institutions in the Bank’s market areas. Client deposits are attractive sources of funding because of their stability and low relative cost. Deposits are regarded as an important part of the overall client relationship. We consider our deposit base to be seasoned, stable and well diversified.

The Bank also holds deposits of public entities. The Bank’s strategy for acquiring public funds, as with any type of deposit, is determined by ALCO’s funding and liquidity subcommittee, while pricing strategies are determined by ALCO’s deposit pricing subcommittee. Typically, many public fund deposits are allocated based upon the rate of interest offered and the ability of a bank to provide collateralization. The Bank can influence the level of its public fund deposits through pricing decisions. Public deposits typically require the pledging of collateral, most commonly marketable securities and Federal Home Loan Bank letters of credit. This is taken into account when determining the level of interest to be paid on public deposits. The pledging of collateral, monitoring and management reporting represents additional operational requirements for the Bank. Public fund deposits are more volatile than other core deposits because they tend to be price sensitive, have large balances, and are subject to seasonal balance changes. Public funds are only one of many possible sources of liquidity that the Bank has available to draw upon as part of its liquidity funding strategy as set by ALCO.

Brokered deposits, including time deposits and money market accounts, are funds which the Bank obtains through deposit brokers who sell participations in a given bank deposit account or instrument to one or more investors. Brokered deposits are fully insured by the FDIC because they are participated out by the deposit broker in shares of $250,000 or less. Brokered deposit issuances are approved by ALCO as one component of its funding strategy to support ongoing asset growth until such time customer deposit growth ultimately replaces the brokered deposits. Under the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation Improvement Act of 1991 (FDICIA), the Bank may continue to accept brokered deposits as long as it is either “well-capitalized” or “adequately-capitalized.” Brokered deposits as of December 31, 2025 were negligible at less than $1,000.

Trust Services

The Bank, through its trust department, offers a full range of trust services on a fee basis. In its trust capacities, the Bank provides investment management services on an agency basis and acts as trustee for pension plans, profit sharing plans, corporate and municipal bond issues, living trusts, life insurance trusts and various other types of trusts created by or for individuals, businesses, and charitable and religious organizations. The May 2025 acquisition of Sabal Trust Company expanded assets under management by approximately $3 billion. At December 31, 2025, the trust department of the Bank had approximately $39.7 billion of assets under administration, comprised of investment management and investment advisory agency accounts of $8.1 billion and other custody and safekeeping accounts of $14.3 billion, corporate trust accounts of $5.1 billion, and personal, employee benefit, estate and other trust accounts totaling $12.2 billion.

HUMAN CAPITAL RESOURCES

Our employees, whom we refer to as associates, are our most valuable asset. Associates are the collective face, voice and spirit of our organization. To the people and communities we serve, our associates are Hancock Whitney. For more than 125 years, our culture and core values are a consistent beacon that guides how our associates carry on our legacy with honor, integrity and service. Additionally, the policies and practices we define for associates further reinforce the founding principles fundamental to who we are and how we do business. Embracing the uniqueness our associates bring to our various teams fortifies us, making us a stronger and more resilient company. This inclusivity cultivates a sense of belonging and encouragement, supporting our associates, clients, communities, and shareholders in realizing their individual potential, aspirations and ambitions.

We promise our associates an environment where they can grow, have a voice, and are important. We are committed to providing an associate experience and total rewards package that attracts, develops and retains top quality talent. We continually review and develop strategies that support the needs of our associates while balancing business needs. In 2025, the Company’s human capital strategy continued to focus on evolving to meet the ever-changing needs of our associates and supporting various initiatives to improve operations and overall efficiency while maintaining our commitment to our clients, communities and shareholders.

A strong and impactful human capital program begins at the top. Our Board of Directors oversees our overall corporate strategy and sets the tone for our culture, values and high ethical standards, and through its committees, holds management accountable for results. The Board of Directors’ Compensation Committee expands beyond a traditional compensation-focused role to include oversight of all human capital management efforts within Hancock Whitney. The Compensation Committee is provided periodic updates on the Company’s human capital management efforts, including talent acquisition and retention; talent and performance management;

Table of Contents

learning and development; total rewards; and associate well-being through a human capital management dashboard that it reviews periodically throughout the year. The dashboard includes a mixture of trending and point-in-time metrics designed to provide information and analysis of workforce demographics, talent acquisition, workforce stability, total rewards, and associate programs.

Workforce Demographics

As of December 31, 2025, the Company had 3,627 full-time equivalent associates, predominately located in our core footprint of Mississippi, Louisiana, Alabama, Florida, Texas and Tennessee, compared to 3,476 associates as of December 31, 2024. Approximately 43% of associates were employed in Consumer Banking, 12% in Commercial Banking, 10% in Wealth Management, and 35% in Treasury, Operations, and Other Corporate Business & Administration. As of December 31, 2025, approximately 65% of our associates were female and approximately 29% were people of color. In 2025, approximately 58% of our new hires were female and approximately 35% of new hires were people of color. All associates are chosen on the basis of their qualifications, experience and merit. Our hiring practices are maintained and implemented in accordance with applicable law.

Inclusion and Belonging

Our more than 125-year-old founding principles inspire us to prioritize doing good to positively impact the lives and communities we serve. Embracing inclusivity and a sense of belonging is at the core of our values, recognizing that diverse perspectives, backgrounds, and experiences strengthen our ability to meet the needs of our associates, communities, clients and shareholders. By fostering a culture that values varied viewpoints, we enhance teamwork, encourage innovative collaboration, and improve organizational performance. This wider range of thinking empowers us to serve our stakeholders more effectively.

Our commitment to inclusion and belonging starts at the top of our organization, with oversight by the Compensation Committee. The Company has a council dedicated to our ongoing commitment to inclusion and belonging. With oversight from executive leadership, the council consists of associates from a variety of locations, business segments, demographics, tenures, and experiences who work together to promote an inclusive workplace.

We are committed to fostering respect, belonging and individual potential, supporting, developing, and celebrating our workforce, and creating a high-performing culture where all associates can thrive. We continuously assess the impact of our initiatives, programs and practices to uphold these commitments to our associates and the Company.

In 2025, we continued our efforts to build and attract an inclusive workforce by cultivating new relationships, strengthening existing partnerships, and enhancing recruiting efforts with key organizations. We were intentional with our campus recruiting, internship, and programming efforts across the footprint, to have a diverse talent pool that is representative of the communities we serve. Our corporate internship program continued to provide an inclusive experience that uniquely incorporates mentorship, financial education, community connection, and learning opportunities across the organization and footprint. We proudly hosted the 2025 class of interns, all chosen based on merit and qualifications, expanding our diverse pool of future talent and campus advocates. Additionally, we continued to partner with many external professional organizations to expand our talent pipeline.

The Company continues to enhance its learning opportunities with programs and experiences designed to listen and learn directly from the voices and experiences of our associates including Living Room Conversations, Cultural Tasting Series, Understanding Cultural Bias Training, and Associate Spotlights featuring new associates, women of excellence, kindness, and for living our core values to help drive inclusive behaviors and inspire a growth mindset.

Our Associate Resource Groups (ARGs), introduced in 2023, continue to grow and cultivate community, connection, and inclusion. These voluntary groups, led by associates, serve as a platform for networking, creating community, professional development, and raising awareness about relevant issues that promote inclusion and belonging in the workplace and beyond. All ARGs are open to all associates regardless of background. By engaging in our ARGs, associates can learn, celebrate, and support one another, fostering stronger teams, increased productivity, and a culture of innovation. Launched in March 2023, the SheConnects ARG aims to establish an environment that empowers women to connect, learn, and uplift one another. In August 2023, the Able ARG was introduced to promote unity, facilitate meaningful conversations, and provide support for individuals with disabilities and, when applicable, their caregivers. The Black Professional Collaborative ARG, launched in 2024, creates avenues for professional growth, development, and support for African American/Black associates. Introduced in 2024, the Young Professional Network ARG empowers early career professionals to network with peers and seasoned associates, gaining insights into the unique challenges and opportunities at the early stages of their careers for development and growth.

Table of Contents

Total Rewards

We strive to provide a comprehensive total rewards package that meets the various needs of our associates, including market-competitive pay and robust benefit options that attract and retain top talent. To assist in keeping our total rewards programs competitive, we engage in nationally recognized third-party compensation and benefits surveys and utilize the expertise of an independent executive compensation firm, an outside benefits broker, and benefits consulting firms. These resources are used to objectively evaluate our compensation and benefits packages and benchmark them against industry peers and similarly situated organizations on an annual basis.

Our compensation philosophy is a performance-based strategy which aligns our programs with our business goals and objectives. Base salaries are established considering competitive market rates for specific roles as well as the experience and performance levels of our associates. The Company rewards associates for individual performance through merit-based compensation increases and provides additional opportunities for financial advancement through promotions and various incentive opportunities.

We promote a pay-for-performance philosophy and motivate a majority of our associate population with incentive compensation designed to drive strategies, behaviors and business goals while effectively balancing risk and reward. We also use long-term incentive compensation to attract and retain top talent and to keep associates focused on long-term company performance, significant milestone achievements and creation of shareholder value.

Talent Acquisition, Development and Retention

Hancock Whitney is dedicated to attracting, developing and retaining exceptional talent and strives to keep associates motivated, rewarded and appreciated through our commitment to competitive total rewards packages, career development, and an inclusive workplace.

Recognizing the development of our associates is critical to our success, the Company invests in resources for associates to have access to the tools needed to do their jobs effectively and succeed within the organization, including technical, skills-based, management and leadership programs, as well as formal talent, performance management and succession planning processes. Through customized learning plans, associates are provided with targeted resources to help them gain the knowledge and skills needed to successfully perform their duties in accordance with the Company’s practices. Associates also have access to a full suite of optional classes and self-directed resources to personalize career development and prioritize their unique needs and growth opportunities. Additionally, the Company supports the use of external resources such as professional conferences, specialized seminars, banking schools and other development and leadership programs to supplement associates’ professional development and provides a tuition assistance program for those seeking to deepen their education at undergraduate and graduate levels.

Our agile Learning and Development strategy, LEARN (Leverage Education and Resources Now), offers individualized learning and development solutions for associates at all levels. Built on the ethos of associate growth, voice, and importance, LEARN enhances the associate learning experience. LEARN fosters a culture that gives all associates permission to learn and grow, expanding opportunities and creating tailored pathways for development.

Health, Safety & Well-Being

At Hancock Whitney, the overall health, safety, and well-being of our associates are top priorities. We are committed to providing robust, competitive benefits and programs that support associates in all aspects and stages of life. We continually explore opportunities for new or enhanced benefits and other programs to better support the overall well-being of our associates.

Supplementing our various benefit plans and programs, the Hancock Whitney Associate Assistance Fund provides assistance for associates with personal and financial needs during times of unexpected or unavoidable emergencies or disasters. The fund is managed by the Gulf Coast Community Foundation and funded by contributions from the Company as well as associates, board members and partner organizations.

Rooted in the Gulf South, we recognize that providing relief and recovery resources to help associates and their families remain safe and recover quickly when a storm hits is paramount. Throughout the year, especially during hurricane season, we encourage associates to prepare for inclement weather and natural disasters. We provide associates with resources to prepare for and respond to emergencies, including the American Red Cross, Employee Assistance Program, and Hancock Whitney Associate Assistance Fund. We periodically prompt associates to review and update contact information and emergency contact information in our HR system so that that they receive company communications and outreach during emergency situations.

We remain committed to providing a safe, secure environment for our associates and clients. We continuously remind associates of their critical role in maintaining a safe and secure working environment. Trainings and communications are provided to educate and

Table of Contents

reinforce our safety and security protocols including safely accessing facilities and workspaces; safeguarding information and devices; and preventing, detecting, and reporting crimes and suspicious activities.

Associate Engagement

We strive to create a culture of engagement where each associate knows they are important, valued, and can grow. We engage our associates through various channels including written, digital and face-to-face communications with targeted audiences ranging from all associates, core leaders, teams and one-on-ones. We encourage continuous open communication with our associates and leaders where input is welcomed through an environment of mutual respect and trust. We promote a workplace focused on gratitude and appreciation through our Value of You recognition program, Community Connection volunteer program as well as other associate campaigns throughout the year.

We generally conduct associate engagement surveys on a biennial basis to measure our associates’ connection and commitment to the Company and its goals. In our 2024 assessment, we conducted an anonymous online associate engagement survey to measure associate engagement and collect associate feedback. During the survey, associates answered questions and provided comments to capture their feelings about the Company, leadership, and their team of associates. Our Company leaders are grateful for the consistent, strong response from our associates, indicating an engaged, connected and committed workforce. The survey reflected that almost three out of every four associates feel a sense of belonging and respect across the Company. Using the results of the engagement survey, a leadership series was launched to communicate ongoing leader insights and engage associates to reiterate the key role our associates play in shaping our path forward.

Open Communication

Our Open Communication Policy cultivates a culture of open and honest communication between managers and associates as a day-to-day business practice. Managers set the tone of the workplace by welcoming input from associates in an environment of mutual respect and trust. We believe this process helps to define any issue and work toward resolving it in an informal manner.

We encourage associates to work with their immediate managers to resolve questions, conflicts and disputes. If concerns involve the immediate manager, or if the issue has not been resolved appropriately, associates may escalate the issue to the next-level manager and ultimately Human Resources.

Integrity in Action

Upholding the core values of Honor & Integrity, Strength & Stability and Personal Responsibility and further protecting our clients, associates, and Company’s financial safety and soundness, our associates are expected to conduct business in a lawful, ethical and fair manner. All associates are strongly encouraged to report ethical concerns related to matters such as accounting, internal controls, auditing, discrimination, and harassment and/or violations or suspected violations of laws or regulations, our Code of Conduct, or other Company policies and procedures by clients, associates, or vendors. Integrity in Action, our whistleblower policy, provides our associates and others with a confidential method of reporting illegal, unethical, or unsafe activity. Administered through a third-party provider, the independent reporting service allows individuals to make reports confidentially by telephone or online 24 hours a day, seven days a week and allows for anonymous reports, if desired. All reports are investigated by Human Resources and/or Internal Audit and monitored through final disposition. Updates are provided to the Audit Committee on a quarterly basis. A copy of our Integrity in Action Whistleblower Policy is available under Governance Documents on our website, www.hancockwhitney.com.

COMPETITION

The financial services industry is highly competitive and may become more competitive as a result of recent and ongoing legislative, regulatory, and technological changes, as well as continued consolidation within the financial services industry and the addition of nontraditional competitors into our markets, including financial technology companies (fintechs), crowdfunding, stablecoins, cryptocurrency exchanges and other emerging digital and mobile payment platforms. The traditional factors in the competition for deposits and loans are interest rates and fee structures associated with the various products offered. We also compete through the efficiency, quality and range of services and products we provide, as well as the convenience provided by an extensive network of customer access channels including local branch offices, ATMs, online and mobile banking, and telebanking centers. In attracting deposits and in our lending activities, we generally compete with other commercial banks, savings associations, credit unions, mortgage banking firms, private equity companies, securities brokerage firms, mutual funds and insurance companies, and other financial and non-financial institutions offering similar products.

The continuing consolidation within the financial services industry is leading to larger, better capitalized and geographically diverse institutions with enhanced product and technology capabilities. In addition to competition from fintechs and other emerging digital platforms, certain technology companies are working to provide financial services directly to their customers. These nontraditional

Table of Contents

financial service providers have been successful in developing digital and other products and services that effectively compete with traditional banking services, but are in some cases subject to fewer regulatory restrictions than banks and bank holding companies, allowing them to operate with greater flexibility and lower cost structures. Further, bank failures have and may in the future diminish public confidence in small and regional banks’ abilities to safeguard deposits in excess of federally insured limits, which could prompt customers to maintain their deposits with larger financial institutions.

Recent federal regulatory developments, including the establishment of a national framework for “payment stablecoins” under the GENIUS Act, may further increase competition from nonbank entities and fintech firms authorized to issue, distribute, or support stablecoin‑based payment instruments. These regulated stablecoins could serve as substitutes for traditional bank deposits and payment products, potentially affecting deposit levels, payment‑related fee income, and customer treasury‑management relationships.

We believe our relationship-based approach to banking has allowed us to remain competitive in our markets as many of our financial services clients are generally influenced by convenience, quality of service, personal contacts, price of services, availability of products, and technology that supports the client experience. We have made and continue to make investments in technology to develop the Company's digital platform and capabilities to remain competitive in meeting our clients’ evolving needs and expectations.

AVAILABLE INFORMATION

We make available free of charge, on or through our investor relations website investors.hancockwhitney.com, our Annual Reports on Form 10-K, Quarterly Reports on Form 10-Q, Current Reports on Form 8-K, and other filings pursuant to Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, and amendments to such filings, as soon as reasonably practicable after each is electronically filed with, or furnished to, the SEC. The SEC maintains a website that contains the Company’s reports, proxy statements, and the Company’s other SEC filings. The address of the SEC’s website is www.sec.gov. We include our website address throughout this filing only as textual references. The information contained on our website is not incorporated in this document by reference.

Also available on our investor relations website are our corporate governance documents, including our Corporate Governance Guidelines, Code of Business Ethics for Officers and Associates, Whistleblower Policy, Code of Ethics for Financial Officers, Code of Ethics for Directors and Committee Charting. These documents are also available in print to any shareholder who requests a copy.

SUPERVISION AND REGULATION

Bank holding companies and banks are extensively regulated under federal and state law. This discussion is a summary and is qualified in its entirety by reference to the particular statutory and regulatory provisions described below and is not intended to be an exhaustive description of the statutes or regulations applicable to the Company or the Bank or all aspects of those statutes and regulations.

Changes in laws and regulations may alter the structure, regulation and competitive relationships of financial institutions. In addition, bank regulatory agencies may issue enforcement actions, policy statements, interpretive letters and similar written guidance applicable to the Company or the Bank. It cannot be predicted whether and in what form new laws and regulations, or interpretations thereof, may be adopted or the extent to which the business of the Company and the Bank may be affected thereby, but they may have a material adverse effect on our business, operations, and earnings.

Supervision, regulation, and examination of the Company, the Bank, and our respective subsidiaries by the appropriate regulatory agencies, as described herein, are intended primarily for the protection of consumers, bank depositors and the Deposit Insurance Fund (DIF) of the FDIC, and the U.S. banking and financial system, rather than holders of our capital stock.

Table of Contents

Bank Holding Company Regulation

The Company is subject to extensive supervision and regulation by the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (the Federal Reserve) pursuant to the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956, as amended (the BHC Act). We are required to file with the Federal Reserve periodic reports and such other information as the Federal Reserve may request. Ongoing supervision is provided through regular examinations by the Federal Reserve and other means that allow the regulators to gauge management’s ability to identify, assess and control risk in all areas of operations in a safe and sound manner and to ensure compliance with laws and regulations. The Company is subject to regulation by the State of Mississippi under its general business corporation laws, and to supervision by the Mississippi Department of Banking and Consumer Finance (the MDBCF). The Federal Reserve may also examine our non-bank subsidiaries. Various federal and state bodies regulate and supervise our brokerage, investment advisory and insurance agency operations. These include, but are not limited to, the SEC, the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority (FINRA), federal and state banking regulators and various state regulators of insurance and brokerage activities.

Violations of laws and regulations, or other unsafe and unsound practices, may result in regulatory agencies imposing fines or penalties, cease and desist orders, or taking other enforcement actions. Under certain circumstances, these agencies may enforce these remedies directly against officers, directors, employees and other parties participating in the affairs of a bank or bank holding company. Under federal and state laws and regulations pertaining to the safety and soundness of insured depository institutions, federal and state banking regulators have the authority to compel or restrict certain actions on our part if they determine that we have insufficient capital or other resources, or are otherwise operating in a manner that may be deemed to be inconsistent with safe and sound banking practices. Under this authority, our regulators can require us or our subsidiaries to enter into informal or formal supervisory agreements, including board resolutions, memoranda of understanding, written agreements and consent or cease and desist orders, pursuant to which we would be required to take identified corrective actions to address cited concerns and to refrain from taking certain actions.

If we become subject to and are unable to comply with the terms of any future regulatory actions or directives, supervisory agreements, or orders, then we could become subject to additional, heightened supervisory actions and orders, possibly including consent orders, prompt corrective action restrictions and/or other regulatory actions, including prohibitions on the payment of dividends on our common stock and, if issued, preferred stock. If our regulators were to take such additional supervisory actions, then we could, among other things, become subject to significant restrictions on our ability to develop any new business, as well as restrictions on our existing business, and we could be required to raise additional capital, dispose of certain assets and liabilities within a prescribed period of time, or both. The terms of any such supervisory action could have a material negative effect on our business, reputation, operating flexibility, financial condition, and the value of our common stock and preferred stock, if issued.

Activity Limitations. The Company is registered with the Federal Reserve as a bank holding company and has elected to be treated as a financial holding company under the BHC Act. Bank holding companies generally are limited to the business of banking, managing or controlling banks, and other activities that the Federal Reserve determines to be closely related to banking, or managing or controlling banks as to be a proper incident thereto. Bank holding companies are prohibited from acquiring or obtaining control of more than 5% of any class of voting interests of any company that engages in activities other than those activities permissible for bank holding companies. Examples of activities that the Federal Reserve has determined to be permissible are making, acquiring, brokering, or servicing loans; leasing personal property; providing certain investment or financial advice; performing certain data processing services; acting as agent or broker in selling credit life insurance and other insurance products in certain locations; securities brokerage; and performing certain insurance underwriting activities. The BHC Act does not place domestic geographic limits on permissible non-banking activities of bank holding companies. Even with respect to permissible activities, however, the Federal Reserve has the power to order a holding company or its subsidiaries to terminate any activity or its control of any subsidiary when the Federal Reserve has reasonable cause to believe that continuation of such activity or control of such subsidiary would pose a serious risk to the financial safety, soundness or stability of any bank subsidiary of that holding company.

As a financial holding company, we are permitted to engage directly or indirectly in a broader range of activities than those permitted for a bank holding company that has not elected to be a financial holding company. Financial holding companies may also engage in activities that are considered to be financial in nature, as well as those incidental or, if determined by the Federal Reserve, complementary to financial activities. If the Bank ceases to be “well capitalized” or “well managed” under applicable regulatory standards, or if the Bank receives a rating of less than satisfactory under the Community Reinvestment Act of 1977 (CRA), the Federal Reserve may, among other things, place limitations on our ability to conduct these broader financial activities or, if the deficiencies persist, require us to divest the banking subsidiary or the businesses engaged in activities permissible only for financial holding companies.

As further described below, the Company and the Bank are each well-capitalized under applicable regulatory standards as of December 31, 2025, and the Bank has a rating of “Outstanding” in its most recent CRA evaluation.

Table of Contents

Source of Strength Obligations. A bank holding company, such as Hancock Whitney Corporation, is required to act as a source of financial and managerial strength to its subsidiary bank and to maintain resources adequate to support its bank. The term “source of financial strength” means the ability of a company, such as us, that directly or indirectly owns or controls an insured depository institution, such as the Bank, to provide financial assistance to such insured depository institution in the event of financial distress. The appropriate federal banking agency for the depository institution (in the case of the Bank, this agency is the FDIC) may require reports from us to assess our ability to serve as a source of strength and to enforce compliance with the source of strength requirements by requiring us to provide financial assistance to the Bank in the event of financial distress. If we were to enter bankruptcy or become subject to the orderly liquidation process established by the Dodd-Frank Act, any commitment by us to a federal bank regulatory agency to maintain the capital of the Bank would be assumed by the bankruptcy trustee or the FDIC, as appropriate, and entitled to a priority of payment. In addition, the FDIC provides that any insured depository institution generally will be liable for any loss incurred by the FDIC in connection with the default of, or any assistance provided by the FDIC, to a commonly controlled insured depository institution. The Bank is an FDIC-insured depository institution and thus subject to these requirements.

Acquisitions. The BHC Act requires every bank holding company to obtain the prior approval of the Federal Reserve or waiver of such prior approval before it (1) acquires ownership or control of any voting shares of any bank if, after such acquisition, such bank holding company will own or control more than 5% of any class of the voting shares of such bank, (2) acquires all of the assets of a bank, or (3) merges with any other bank holding company. In reviewing a proposed covered acquisition, among other factors, the Federal Reserve considers (1) the financial and managerial resources of the companies involved, including pro forma capital ratios; (2) the risk to the stability of the United States banking or financial system; (3) the convenience and needs of the communities to be served, including performance under the CRA; and (4) the effectiveness of the companies in combating money laundering. The Federal Reserve also reviews any indebtedness to be incurred by a bank holding company in connection with a proposed acquisition to ensure that the bank holding company can service such indebtedness without adversely affecting its ability to serve as a source of strength to its bank subsidiaries. Well capitalized and well managed bank holding companies are permitted to acquire control of banks in any state, subject to federal regulatory approval, without regard to whether such a transaction is prohibited by the laws of any state. However, a bank holding company may not, following an interstate acquisition, control more than 10% of nationwide insured deposits or 30% of deposits within any state in which the acquiring bank operates. States have the right to lower the 30% limit, although no states within the Company’s current market area have done so. Federal banking regulators are also required to take into account compliance with the CRA in evaluating any proposal for interstate bank acquisitions.

Change in Control. Federal law restricts the amount of voting stock of a bank holding company or a bank that a person may acquire without the prior approval of banking regulators. Under the Change in Bank Control Act and the regulations thereunder, a person or group must give advance notice to and obtain approval from the Federal Reserve before acquiring control of any bank holding company, such as the Company. The Change in Bank Control Act creates a rebuttable presumption of control if a member or group acquires a certain percentage or more of any class of a bank holding company’s voting stock. As a result, a person or entity generally must provide prior notice to the Federal Reserve before acquiring the power to vote 10% or more of our outstanding common stock. The overall effect of such laws is to make it more difficult to acquire a bank holding company by tender offer or similar means than it might be to acquire control of another type of corporation. Consequently, shareholders of the Company may be less likely to benefit from the rapid increases in stock prices that may result from tender offers or similar efforts to acquire control of other companies. Investors should be aware of these requirements when acquiring shares of our stock.

Anti-tying rules. A bank holding company and its subsidiaries are prohibited from engaging in certain tying arrangements in connection with extensions of credit, leases or sales of property, or furnishing of services.

Volcker Rule. The Volcker Rule prohibits us and our subsidiaries from (i) engaging in certain proprietary trading for our own account, and (ii) acquiring or retaining an ownership interest in or sponsoring a “covered fund,” all subject to certain exceptions. The Volcker Rule also specifies certain limited activities in which we and our subsidiaries may continue to engage, and requires us to implement a compliance program.

Capital Requirements

The Company and the Bank are required under federal law to maintain certain minimum capital levels based on ratios of capital to total assets and capital to risk-weighted assets. The required capital ratios are minimums, and the federal banking agencies may determine that a banking organization, based on its size, complexity or risk profile, must maintain a higher level of capital in order to operate in a safe and sound manner. Risks such as concentration of credit risks and the risk arising from non-traditional activities, as well as the institution’s exposure to a decline in the economic value of its capital due to changes in interest rates, and an institution’s ability to manage those risks are important factors that are to be taken into account by the federal banking agencies in assessing an institution’s overall capital adequacy. The following is a brief description of the relevant provisions of these capital rules and their potential impact on our capital levels.

Table of Contents

The Company and the Bank are subject to the following risk-based capital ratios: a common equity Tier 1 (CET1) risk-based capital ratio, a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio, which includes CET1 and additional Tier 1 capital, and a total risk-based capital ratio, which includes Tier 1 and Tier 2 capital. CET1 is primarily comprised of the sum of common stock instruments and related surplus net of treasury stock, retained earnings, and certain qualifying minority interests, less certain adjustments and deductions, including with respect to goodwill, intangible assets, mortgage servicing assets and deferred tax assets subject to temporary timing differences. Additional Tier 1 capital is primarily comprised of noncumulative perpetual preferred stock, tier 1 minority interests and grandfathered trust preferred securities. Tier 2 capital consists of instruments disqualified from Tier 1 capital, including qualifying subordinated debt, other preferred stock and certain hybrid capital instruments, and a limited amount of allowance for credit loss up to a maximum of 1.25% of risk-weighted assets, subject to certain eligibility criteria. The capital rules also define the risk-weights assigned to assets and off-balance sheet items to determine the risk-weighted asset components of the risk-based capital rules, including, for example, certain “high volatility” commercial real estate, past due assets, structured securities and equity holdings.

The leverage capital ratio, which serves as a minimum capital standard, is the ratio of Tier 1 capital to quarterly average total assets net of goodwill, certain other intangible assets, and certain required deduction items. The required minimum leverage ratio for all banks and bank holding companies is 4%.

In addition, the capital rules also require a capital conservation buffer of CET1 capital of 2.5% above each of the minimum capital ratio requirements (CET1, Tier 1, and total risk-based capital), which is designed to absorb losses during periods of economic stress. These buffer requirements must be met for a bank or bank holding company to be able to pay dividends, engage in share buybacks or make discretionary bonus payments to executive management without restriction.

The Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation Improvement Act of 1991 (FDICIA), among other things, requires the federal bank regulatory agencies to take “prompt corrective action” regarding depository institutions that do not meet minimum capital requirements. FDICIA establishes five regulatory capital tiers: “well capitalized,” “adequately capitalized,” “undercapitalized,” “significantly undercapitalized,” and “critically undercapitalized.” A depository institution’s capital tier will depend upon how its capital levels compare to various relevant capital measures and certain other factors, as established by regulation. FDICIA generally prohibits a depository institution from making any capital distribution (including payment of a dividend) or paying any management fee to its holding company if the depository institution would thereafter be undercapitalized. FDICIA imposes progressively more restrictive restraints on operations, management and capital distributions, depending on the category in which an institution is classified. Undercapitalized depository institutions are subject to restrictions on borrowing from the Federal Reserve System. In addition, undercapitalized depository institutions may not accept brokered deposits absent a waiver from the FDIC, are subject to growth limitations and are required to submit capital restoration plans for regulatory approval. A depository institution’s holding company must guarantee any required capital restoration plan, up to an amount equal to the lesser of 5% of the depository institution’s assets at the time it becomes undercapitalized or the amount of the capital deficiency when the institution fails to comply with the plan. Federal banking agencies may not accept a capital plan without determining, among other things, that the plan is based on realistic assumptions and is likely to succeed in restoring the depository institution’s capital. If a depository institution fails to submit an acceptable plan, it is treated as if it is significantly undercapitalized. The Bank was well capitalized at December 31, 2025, and brokered deposits are not restricted.

To be well-capitalized, the Bank must maintain at least the following capital ratios:

  • 5.0% leverage ratio.
  • 6.5% CET1 to risk-weighted assets;
  • 8.0% Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets; and
  • 10.0% Total capital to risk-weighted assets.

The Federal Reserve has different requirements than those imposed under the current capital rules applicable to banks. For purposes of the Federal Reserve’s Regulation Y, including determining whether a bank holding company meets the requirements to be a financial holding company, bank holding companies, such as the Company, must maintain a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of 6.0% or greater and a total risk-based capital ratio of 10.0% or greater to be well-capitalized. If the Federal Reserve were to apply the same or a very similar well-capitalized standard to bank holding companies as that applicable to the Bank, the Company’s capital ratios as of December 31, 2025 would exceed such revised well-capitalized standard. Also, the Federal Reserve may require bank holding companies, including the Company, to maintain capital ratios substantially in excess of mandated minimum levels, depending upon general economic conditions and a bank holding company’s particular condition, risk profile and growth plans.

Table of Contents

Throughout 2025, the Company’s and the Bank’s regulatory capital ratios were above the applicable well-capitalized standards and met the capital conservation buffer requirements. Based on current estimates, we believe that the Company and the Bank will continue to exceed all applicable well-capitalized regulatory capital requirements and the capital conservation buffer in 2026. Risk-based capital ratios and the leverage capital ratio at December 31, 2025 for the Company and the Bank were as follows:

Minimum Capital
Well-Capitalized Plus Capital
Under Prompt Conservation
Minimum Corrective Action* Buffer Company Bank
Tier 1 leverage capital ratio 4.00 % 5.00 % N/A 11.17 % 10.84 %
Risk-based capital ratios
Common Equity Tier 1 capital 4.50 % 6.50 % 7.00 % 13.65 % 13.24 %
Tier 1 capital 6.00 % 8.00 % 8.50 % 13.65 % 13.24 %
Total risk-based capital (Tier 1 plus Tier 2) 8.00 % 10.00 % 10.50 % 15.45 % 14.43 %

*Applies to Bank.

Payment of Dividends

Hancock Whitney Corporation is a legal entity separate and distinct from Hancock Whitney Bank and other subsidiaries. Its primary source of cash, other than securities offerings, is dividends from the Bank. Under the Federal Deposit Insurance Act, no dividends may be paid by an insured bank if the bank is in arrears in the payment of any insurance assessment due to the FDIC. The payment of dividends by the Bank may also be affected by other regulatory requirements and policies, such as the maintenance of adequate capital. If, in the opinion of the applicable regulatory authority, a bank under its jurisdiction is engaged in, or is about to engage in, an unsafe or unsound practice (which, depending on the financial condition of the bank, could include the payment of dividends), such authority may require, after notice and hearing, that such bank cease and desist from such practice. The FDIC has formal and informal policies which provide that insured banks should generally pay dividends only out of current operating earnings.

Under a Federal Reserve policy adopted in 2009, the board of directors of a bank holding company must consider certain factors to ensure that its dividend level is prudent relative to maintaining a strong financial position, and is not based on overly optimistic earnings scenarios, such as potential events that could affect its ability to pay, while still maintaining a strong financial position. As a general matter, the Federal Reserve has indicated that the board of directors of a bank holding company should consult with the Federal Reserve and eliminate, defer or significantly reduce the bank holding company’s dividends if:

  • its net income available to shareholders for the past four quarters, net of dividends previously paid during that period, is not sufficient to fully fund the dividends;
  • its prospective rate of earnings retention is not consistent with its capital needs and overall current and prospective financial condition; or
  • it will not meet, or is in danger of not meeting, its minimum regulatory capital adequacy ratios.

Bank Regulation

The operation of the Bank is subject to state and federal statutes applicable to state banks and the regulations of the Federal Reserve, the FDIC and the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau (CFPB). The operations of the Bank may also be subject to applicable Office of the Comptroller of the Currency (OCC) regulation to the extent state banks are granted parity with national banks. Such statutes and regulations relate to, among other things, investments, loans, mergers and consolidations, issuances of securities, payments of dividends, establishment of branches, consumer protection and other aspects of the Bank’s operations. Violations of laws and regulations, or other unsafe and unsound practices, may result in these agencies imposing fines or penalties, cease and desist orders, or taking other enforcement actions. Under certain circumstances, these agencies may enforce these remedies directly against officers, directors, employees and other parties participating in the affairs of a bank or bank holding company.

Safety and Soundness. The Federal Deposit Insurance Act requires the federal prudential bank regulatory agencies, such as the FDIC, to prescribe, by regulation or guideline, operational and managerial standards for all insured depository institutions relating to: (1) internal controls; (2) information systems and audit systems; (3) loan documentation; (4) credit underwriting; (5) interest rate risk exposure; and (6) asset quality. The agencies also must prescribe standards for asset quality, earnings, and stock valuation, as well as standards for compensation, fees and benefits. The federal banking agencies have adopted regulations and Interagency Guidelines Establishing Standards for Safety and Soundness to implement these required standards. These guidelines set forth the safety and soundness standards used to identify and address problems at insured depository institutions before capital becomes impaired. Under the regulations, if a regulator determines that a bank fails to meet any standards prescribed by the guidelines, the regulator may require the bank to submit an acceptable plan to achieve compliance, consistent with deadlines for the submission and review of such safety and soundness compliance plans.

Table of Contents

Examinations. The Bank is subject to regulation, reporting, and periodic examinations by the FDIC, the MDBCF, and the CFPB. These regulatory authorities routinely examine the Bank’s loan and investment quality, consumer compliance, management policies, procedures and practices and other aspects of operations. The FDIC has adopted the Federal Financial Institutions Examination Council’s (FFIEC) rating system and assigns each financial institution a confidential composite rating based on an evaluation and rating of six essential components of an institution’s financial condition and operations, including Capital Adequacy, Asset Quality, Management, Earnings, Liquidity and Sensitivity to Market Risk (CAMELS), as well as the quality of risk management practices. Federal banking regulators and Congress have recently signaled that updates to the CAMELS rating framework are under consideration, including potential reforms intended to improve the objectivity, clarity, and consistency of component ratings; however, these initiatives remain in development and have not yet been finalized, and the potential impact on the Bank’s future examinations is uncertain.

Consumer Protection. The CFPB has rule writing, examination, and enforcement authority with regard to the Bank’s (and the Company’s) compliance with a wide array of consumer financial protection laws, including the Truth in Lending Act, the Real Estate Settlement Procedures Act, the Truth in Savings Act, the Electronic Funds Transfer Act, the Equal Credit Opportunity Act, the Home Mortgage Disclosure Act, the S.A.F.E. Mortgage Licensing Act, the Fair Credit Reporting Act (except Sections 615(e) and 628), the Fair Debt Collection Practices Act, and the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act (sections 502 through 509 relating to privacy), among others. The CFPB has broad authority to enforce a prohibition on unfair, deceptive, or abusive acts and practices. The Bank is subject to direct supervision and examination by the CFPB. The CFPB also may examine our other direct or indirect subsidiaries that offer consumer financial products or services. In addition, the Dodd-Frank Act permits states to adopt consumer protection laws and regulations that are stricter than those regulations promulgated by the CFPB, and state attorneys general are permitted to enforce consumer protection rules adopted by the CFPB against certain institutions.

In March 2023, the CFPB issued a final rule to implement Section 1071 of the Dodd-Frank Act, which requires lenders to collect, and report information about lending to “women owned, minority-owned and small businesses.” This rule was due to take effect in stages depending upon lending volume of the depository institution as early as 2025. However, the final rule has been subject to ongoing court challenges with federal courts granting nationwide stays, delaying compliance. In June 2025, the CFBP published an interim final rule that pushed back compliance dates, acknowledging litigation and industry concerns. In November 2025, the CFPB issued proposed revisions to streamline the rule, reduce complexity for lenders and improve data quality. The proposed revision included increasing the threshold for covered transactions, narrowing the scope to exclude certain products and discretionary data points, simplifying the demographics and delaying the compliance dates under a phased in approach to 2027 through 2028. The comment period for the proposed rule ended on December 15, 2025. The Bank continues to monitor these developments.

Branching. The Dodd-Frank Act authorizes national and state banks to establish de novo branches in other states to the same extent a bank chartered in those states would be so permitted.

Deposit Insurance Assessments. The deposits of the Bank are insured by the FDIC up to applicable limits. The Deposit Insurance Fund (DIF) of the FDIC insures the deposits of the Bank generally up to a maximum of $250,000 per depositor, per insured bank, for each account ownership category. The FDIC charges insured depository institutions quarterly premiums to maintain the DIF. Deposit insurance assessments are based on average total consolidated assets minus its average tangible equity and applies one of four risk categories determined by reference to its capital levels, supervisory ratings, and certain other factors. The assessment rate schedule can change from time to time, at the discretion of the FDIC, subject to certain limits. In October of 2022, the FDIC adopted a final rule to increase the initial base deposit insurance assessment rate by two basis points, applicable to all insured depository institutions, which began with the first quarterly assessment period in 2023 and will remain in effect until the level of the DIF reserve ratios to insured deposits meets the FDIC's long-term goals. The increased assessment remains in effect and is expected to continue in the near-term.

In addition, under section 13(c)(4)(G) of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act, a loss to the DIF arising from the use of a systemic risk exception must be recovered from one or more special assessments on insured depository institutions, depository institution holding companies (with the concurrence of the Secretary of the Treasury with respect to holding companies), or both, as the FDIC determines to be appropriate. In November 2023, the FDIC approved a final rule to implement a special assessment to recover the loss to the DIF associated with two bank failures that occurred during early 2023. The assessment base for the special assessment is equal to estimated uninsured deposits reported as of December 31, 2022, adjusted to exclude the first $5 billion, to be collected at an annual rate of approximately 13.4 basis points for an anticipated total of eight quarterly assessment periods, beginning with the first quarterly assessment period of 2024.

In 2024, as a result of changes in loss estimates for the 2023 failures, the FDIC began providing quarterly updates to the collection period for the special assessment for impacted institutions. Under the final rule, the FDIC retains the ability to cease collection early, extend the special assessment collection period one or more quarters beyond the initial eight-quarter collection period, or impose a final shortfall special assessment on a one-time basis after the receiverships for the two banks are terminated. The collection period could change due to updates to the estimated loss pursuant to the systemic risk determination or if assessments collected change due to

Table of Contents

corrective amendments to the amount of uninsured deposits reported for the December 31, 2022 reporting period. In December 2025, the FDIC issued an interim final rule to amend the collection period of the special assessment, reducing the rate at which the special assessment will be collected in the eighth collection quarter, to ensure that the cumulative amount collected through the eighth collection quarter will be approximately equal to the loss estimate as of September 30, 2025, and will enable the FDIC to avoid collecting amounts in excess of that loss estimate. The interim final rule also requires the FDIC to provide an offset to regular quarterly deposit insurance assessments for banks subject to the special assessment if the aggregate amount collected exceeds losses following the resolution of litigation. In addition, under the interim final rule, upon final termination of the receiverships, the FDIC will either: (1) provide an offset to regular quarterly deposit insurance assessments if the FDIC has over collected or (2) collect a one-time final shortfall special assessment if the FDIC has under collected. The interim final rule was effective upon publication in the Federal Register on December 19, 2025, with a 30-day comment period. The Bank continues to monitor these developments.

Insurance of deposits may be terminated by the FDIC upon a finding that an institution has engaged in unsafe or unsound practices, is in an unsafe or unsound condition to continue operations or has violated any applicable law, regulation, rule, order or condition imposed by the FDIC. The Bank is not subject to any action, condition or violation that could lead to termination of its deposit insurance. In addition, the Federal Deposit Insurance Act provides that, in the event of the liquidation or other resolution of an insured depository institution, the claims of depositors of the institution, including the claims of the FDIC as subrogee of insured depositors, and certain claims for administrative expenses of the FDIC as a receiver, will have priority over other general unsecured claims against the institution, including those of the parent bank holding company.

Transactions with Affiliates and Insiders. The Bank is subject to restrictions on extensions of credit and certain other transactions between the Bank and the Company or any nonbank affiliate. Generally, these covered transactions with either the Company or any affiliate are limited to 10% of the Bank’s capital and surplus, and all such transactions between the Bank and the Company and all of its nonbank affiliates combined are limited to 20% of the Bank’s capital and surplus. Loans and other extensions of credit from the Bank to the Company or any affiliate generally are required to be secured by eligible collateral in specified amounts. In addition, any transaction between the Bank and the Company or any affiliate are required to be on an arm’s length basis. Federal banking laws also place similar restrictions on certain extensions of credit by insured banks, such as the Bank, to their directors, executive officers and principal shareholders.

Mergers, Subsidiaries. The FDIC is also authorized to approve mergers, consolidations and assumption of deposit liability transactions between insured banks and between insured banks and uninsured banks or institutions to prevent capital or surplus diminution in such transactions where the resulting, continuing or assumed bank is an insured nonmember state bank.

On September 17, 2024, the FDIC approved the Final Statement of Policy on Bank Merger Transactions (2024 Statement of Policy) which, if it remained in place, would have resulted in additional scrutiny, including heightened financial stability analysis, to mergers that result in a large insured depository institution with more than $100 billion in total assets, public meetings for mergers that result in insured depository institutions with $50 billion or more in total assets, and board briefings for applications over 270 days old. On May 20, 2025, the FDIC approved the rescission of the agency’s 2024 Statement of Policy and the reinstatement of the Statement of Policy on Bank Merger Transactions that was in effect prior to 2024. The agency plans to conduct a broader re-evaluation of its bank merger review process.

Reserves. Although the Bank is not a member of the Federal Reserve, it is subject to Federal Reserve regulations that require the Bank to maintain reserves against transaction accounts (primarily checking accounts). These reserve requirements are subject to annual adjustment by the Federal Reserve. Effective March 26, 2020, reserve requirement ratios were reduced to zero percent.

Anti-Money Laundering. A continued focus of governmental policy relating to financial institutions has been combating money laundering and terrorist financing. The USA PATRIOT Act broadened the application of anti-money laundering (AML) regulations to apply to additional types of financial institutions such as broker-dealers, investment advisors and insurance companies, and strengthened the ability of the U.S. Government to help prevent, detect and prosecute international money laundering and the financing of terrorism. The principal provisions of Title III of the USA PATRIOT Act require that regulated financial institutions, including state member banks: (i) establish an AML program that includes training and audit components; (ii) comply with regulations regarding the verification of the identity of any person seeking to open an account; (iii) take additional required precautions with non-U.S. owned accounts; and (iv) perform certain verification and certification of money laundering risk for their foreign correspondent banking relationships. Failure of a financial institution to comply with the USA PATRIOT Act’s requirements could have serious legal and reputational consequences for the institution. The Bank has systems and procedures in place to meet the requirements of these regulations and will continue to revise and update its policies, procedures and controls to reflect changes required by law.

Table of Contents

FinCEN has adopted rules that require financial institutions to obtain beneficial ownership information with respect to legal entities with which such institutions conduct business, subject to certain exclusions and exemptions. Bank regulators are focusing their examinations on AML compliance, and we continue to monitor and augment, where necessary, our AML compliance programs.

Bank regulators routinely examine institutions for compliance with these AML obligations and have imposed “cease and desist” and other regulatory orders and money penalty sanctions against institutions found to be in violation of these requirements. On January 1, 2021, Congress passed federal legislation that made sweeping changes to federal AML laws, subject to pending implementation by regulatory rulemaking. On June 30, 2021, FinCEN published the first set of “national AML priorities,” as required by the Bank Secrecy Act, which include, but are not limited to, cybercrime, terrorist financing, fraud, and drug/human trafficking. FinCEN is required to implement regulations to specify how covered financial institutions, such as the Company, should incorporate these national priorities into their AML programs.

Economic Sanctions. The Office of Foreign Assets Control (OFAC) is responsible for helping to ensure that U.S. entities do not engage in transactions with certain prohibited parties, as defined by various Executive Orders and acts of Congress. OFAC publishes, and routinely updates, lists of names of persons and organizations suspected of aiding, harboring or engaging in terrorist acts, including the Specially Designated Nationals and Blocked Persons List. If we find a name on any transaction, account or wire transfer that is on an OFAC list, we must undertake certain specified activities, which could include blocking or freezing the account or transaction requested, and we must notify the appropriate authorities.

Concentrations in Lending. During 2006, the federal bank regulatory agencies released guidance on “Concentrations in Commercial Real Estate Lending” (the Guidance) and advised financial institutions of the risks posed by commercial real estate (CRE) lending concentrations. The Guidance requires that appropriate processes be in place to identify, monitor and control risks associated with real estate lending concentrations. Higher allowances for loan losses and capital levels may also be required. The Guidance is triggered when CRE loan concentrations exceed either:

  • Total reported loans for construction, land development, and other land of 100% or more of a bank’s total risk-based capital; or
  • Total reported loans secured by multifamily and nonfarm nonresidential properties and loans for construction, land development, and other land of 300% or more of a bank’s total risk-based capital.

The Guidance also applies when a bank has a sharp increase in CRE loans or has significant concentrations of CRE secured by a particular property type.

Community Reinvestment Act. The Bank is subject to the provisions of the Community Reinvestment Act (CRA), which imposes a continuing and affirmative obligation, consistent with their safe and sound operation, to help meet the credit needs of entire communities where the bank accepts deposits, including low- and moderate-income neighborhoods. The FDIC’s assessment of the Bank’s CRA record is made available to the public. Further, a less than satisfactory CRA rating will slow, if not preclude, expansion of banking activities and prevent a company from becoming or remaining a financial holding company. Federal CRA regulations require, among other things, that evidence of discrimination against applicants on a prohibited basis, and illegal or abusive lending practices be considered in the CRA evaluation. The Bank has a rating of “Outstanding” in its most recent CRA evaluation.

On October 24, 2023, the OCC, Federal Reserve, and FDIC issued a final rule to modernize their respective CRA regulations (2023 CRA Final Rule). The revised rules would have substantially altered the methodology for assessing compliance with the CRA, with material aspects scheduled to take effect January 1, 2026, and revised data reporting requirements taking effect January 1, 2027. The 2023 CRA Final Rule has been subject to an injunction since March 29, 2024. On July 16, 2025, the Federal Reserve, OCC, and FDIC issued a joint proposal to rescind the 2023 CRA Final Rule. The agencies continue to apply the CRA rules as they existed before the 2023 modernization, considering the injunction and pending finalization of the rescission of the modernization rule.

Consumer Regulation. Activities of the Bank are subject to a variety of statutes and regulations designed to protect consumers. These laws and regulations include, among numerous other things, provisions that:

  • limit the interest and other charges collected or contracted for by the Bank, including rules respecting the terms of credit cards and of debit card overdrafts;
  • govern the Bank’s disclosures of credit terms to consumer borrowers;
  • require the Bank to provide information to enable the public and public officials to determine whether it is fulfilling its obligation to help meet the housing needs of the communities it serves;
  • prohibit the Bank from discriminating on the basis of race, creed or other prohibited factors when it makes decisions to extend credit;

Table of Contents

  • govern the manner in which the Bank may collect consumer debts; and
  • prohibit unfair, deceptive or abusive acts or practices in the provision of consumer financial products and services.

Mortgage Rules. Pursuant to rules adopted by the CFPB, banks that make residential mortgage loans are required to make a good faith determination that a borrower has the ability to repay a mortgage loan prior to extending such credit, require that certain mortgage loans contain escrow payments, obtain new appraisals under certain circumstances, comply with integrated mortgage disclosure rules, and follow specific rules regarding the compensation of loan originators and the servicing of residential mortgage loans.

Personal Financial Data Rights Rule. On October 22, 2024, the CFPB issued a final rule implementing section 1033 of the Dodd-Frank Act, providing consumers with more choices and direction of their own financial data. This rule aims to enhance fair competition, transparency, and accessibility in the markets for consumer financial products and services by requiring institutions that issue credit cards and hold transaction accounts, among others, to provide information about transactions, costs, charges and usage to consumers and authorized third parties in electronic form upon request. The rule mandates that financial institutions and providers allow consumers to access and transfer their financial data to other providers at no charge, which the CFPB believes will promote competition within the industry. Compliance with the rule will be phased in over a five-year period based on asset size for depository institutions, with an expected effective date of April 1, 2027 for our institution. However, this rule has been challenged in court and may be revised by the CFPB. On August 22, 2025, the CFPB released an Advance Notice of Proposed Rulemaking on Personal Financial Data Rights Reconsideration, seeking comments and data to inform its consideration of four issues related to implementation: (1) the proper understanding of who can serve as a “representative” making a request on behalf of the consumer; (2) the optimal approach to the assessment of fees to defray the costs incurred by a “covered person” in responding to a customer driven request; (3) the threat and cost-benefit pictures for data security associated with section 1033 compliance; and (4) the threat picture for data privacy associated with section 1033 compliance. The Bank continues to monitor the developments on this rule.

Privacy, Credit Reporting and Cybersecurity. The Bank is subject to federal and state banking regulations that limit its ability to disclose non-public information about consumers to non-affiliated third parties and prescribe standards for the protection of consumer information. These limitations require us to periodically disclose our privacy policies to consumers and allow consumers to prevent disclosure of certain personal information to a non-affiliated third party under certain circumstances. Consumers also have the option to direct banks and other financial institutions not to share information about transactions and experiences with affiliated companies for the purpose of marketing products or services. Banking institutions are required to implement a comprehensive information security program that includes administrative, technical, and physical safeguards to ensure the security and confidentiality of customer records and information, as well as maintain procedures for notifying customers in the event of a security breach. These security and privacy policies and procedures for the protection of confidential and personal information are in effect across our lines of business. The Company has adopted and implemented our Comprehensive Information Security Policy to comply with these federal requirements.

The Bank uses credit bureau data in underwriting activities. Use of such data is regulated under the Fair Credit Reporting Act and Regulation V on a uniform, nationwide basis, including credit reporting, prescreening, and sharing of information between affiliates and the use of credit data. The Fair and Accurate Credit Transactions Act, which amended the Fair Credit Reporting Act, permits states to enact identity theft laws that are not inconsistent with the conduct required by the provisions of that Act.

Furthermore, the federal banking regulators regularly issue guidance regarding cybersecurity intended to enhance cyber risk management. A financial institution is expected to implement multiple lines of defense against cyber-attacks and ensure that their risk management procedures address the risk posed by potential cyber threats. A financial institution is further expected to maintain procedures to effectively respond to a cyber-attack and resume operations following any such attack. The Company has adopted and implemented an Information Security Program to comply with the regulatory cybersecurity guidance. Effective April 1, 2022, the federal banking agencies implemented a rule that requires banks to notify their regulators within 36 hours of a “computer-security incident” that rises to the level of a “notification incident.” Refer to Part I, Item 1C. "Cybersecurity" for further discussion.

Risk-retention rules. Banks that sponsor the securitization of asset-backed securities are generally required to retain not less than 5% of the credit risk of any loan they securitize, except for residential mortgages that meet certain low-risk standards.

Table of Contents

Debit Interchange Fees. Interchange fees are fees that merchants pay to credit card companies and card-issuing banks such as the Bank for processing electronic payment transactions on their behalf. The maximum permissible interchange fee that an issuer may receive for an electronic debit transaction is the sum of 21 cents per transaction and 5 basis points multiplied by the value of the transaction, subject to an upward adjustment of 1 cent if an issuer certifies that it has implemented policies and procedures reasonably designed to achieve the fraud-prevention standards set forth by the Federal Reserve. In addition, the legislation prohibits card issuers and networks from entering into arrangements requiring that debit card transactions be processed on a single network or only two affiliated networks and allows merchants to determine transaction routing. On October 25, 2023, the FRB proposed to lower the maximum interchange fee that a large debit card issuer can receive for a debit card transaction. The proposal would also establish a regular process for updating the maximum amount every other year going forward. The proposal remains pending as of late 2025, largely due to ongoing litigation surrounding the underlying regulation. We continue to monitor the development of these proposed rule revisions.

Anti-Bribery Laws. Federal law prohibits offering or giving a bank official or any third party (or for the bank official to solicit or receive for himself or a third party) "anything of value" other than what is given or offered to the bank itself. Further, the Foreign Corrupt Practices Act makes it unlawful to make payments to foreign government officials to assist in obtaining or retaining business. The Company and the Bank have implemented a Code of Business Ethics that governs the behavior of its officers, employees, and directors.

Nonbanking Subsidiaries

The Company’s nonbanking subsidiaries may also be subject to a variety of state and federal laws. For example, Hancock Whitney Investment Services, Inc. is subject to supervision and regulation by the SEC, FINRA and the State of Mississippi.

Compensation

In June 2010, the federal banking agencies issued joint guidance on executive compensation designed to help ensure that a banking organization’s incentive compensation policies do not encourage imprudent risk taking and are consistent with the safety and soundness of the organization. In addition, in June 2012, the Commission issued final rules to implement the Dodd-Frank Act’s requirement that the Commission direct the national securities exchanges to adopt certain listing standards related to the compensation committee of a company’s board of directors as well as its compensation advisers.

In 2016, the Federal Reserve, FDIC and SEC proposed rules that would, depending upon the assets of the institution, directly regulate incentive compensation arrangements and would require enhanced oversight and recordkeeping. Although those interagency rules have not been finalized or implemented as of December 31, 2025, the SEC has since adopted final clawback rules under Section 954 of the Dodd‑Frank Act, and the NYSE and Nasdaq implemented related listing standards effective October 2, 2023. We have instituted measures so that our incentive compensation plans do not encourage inappropriate risks, consistent with three key principles—that incentive compensation arrangements should appropriately balance risk and financial rewards, be compatible with effective controls and risk management, and be supported by strong corporate governance.

Accounting and Controls

The Company is also required to file certain reports with, and otherwise comply with the rules and regulations of the SEC under federal securities laws. For example, we are required to comply with various corporate governance and financial reporting requirements under the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, as well as rules and regulations adopted by the SEC, the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board, and Nasdaq. In particular, we are required to include management and independent registered public accounting firm reports on internal controls over financial reporting as part of our Annual Report on Form 10‑K in order to comply with Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act. We have evaluated our controls, including compliance with the SEC rules on internal controls. The assessments of our financial reporting controls as of December 31, 2025 are included in this report under Item 9A. “Controls and Procedures.” Our failure to comply with these internal control rules may materially adversely affect our reputation, ability to obtain the necessary certifications for financial statements, and the value of our securities.

Effect of Governmental Monetary and Fiscal Policies

The difference between the interest rate paid on deposits and other borrowings and the interest rate received on loans and securities comprises most of a bank’s earnings.

The earnings and growth of a bank will be affected by both general economic conditions and the monetary and fiscal policy of the U.S. government and its agencies, particularly the Federal Reserve. The Federal Reserve sets national monetary policy to promote maximum employment, stable prices, and moderate long-term interest rates. This is accomplished by its open-market operations in U.S. government securities, adjustments in the amount of reserves that financial institutions are required to maintain and adjustments

Table of Contents

to the discount rates on borrowings and target rates for federal funds transactions. The actions of the Federal Reserve in these areas influence the growth of bank loans, investments and deposits and also affect interest rates on loans and deposits. The nature and timing of any future changes in monetary policies and their potential impact on the Company cannot be predicted.

INFORMATION ABOUT OUR EXECUTIVE OFFICERS

The names, ages, positions and business experience of our executive officers as of February 26, 2026 are as follows:

Name Age Position
John M. Hairston 62 President of the Company since 2014; Chief Executive Officer since 2008 and Chief Operating Officer from 2008 to 2014; Director since 2006.
Michael M. Achary 65 Senior Executive Vice President since 2017; Executive Vice President from 2008 to 2016; Chief Financial Officer since 2007; Principal Accounting Officer since 2022.
D. Shane Loper 60 President of Hancock Whitney Bank since 2024; Senior Executive Vice President since 2017; Executive Vice President from 2008 to 2016; Chief Operating Officer since 2014; Chief Administrative Officer from 2013 to 2014; Chief Risk Officer from 2012 to 2013; Chief Risk and Administrative Officer from 2010 to 2012.
Stacy J. Davis 53 Senior Executive Vice President since 2026; Executive Vice President from 2025 to 2026; Chief Human Resources Officer since 2025; Senior Executive Vice President and Chief Human Resources Officer, Stellar Bank from 2019 to 2025.
Juanita P. Kuhner 45 Senior Executive Vice President since 2026; Executive Vice President from 2024 to 2026; General Counsel and Corporate Secretary since 2024; Deputy General Counsel from 2022 to 2024; Senior Vice President from 2021 to 2024; Corporate Counsel from 2017 to 2022; Vice President from 2017 to 2021.
Michael Otero 59 Senior Executive Vice President since 2025; Executive Vice President from 2013 to 2025; Chief Risk Officer since 2020; Deputy Chief Risk Officer from 2018 to 2020; Chief Internal Auditor from 2013 to 2018.
Christopher S. Ziluca 64 Senior Executive Vice President since 2025; Executive Vice President from 2018 to 2025; Chief Credit Officer since 2018.
Emory L. Mayfield 52 Chief Banking Officer since 2026; Executive Vice President since 2022; Chief Consumer Banking Officer from 2022 to 2026; Regional President from 2019 to 2022; Market President from 2013 to 2019.

Table of Contents

ITEM 1A. RISK FACTORS

We face a number of material risks and uncertainties in connection with our operations. Our business, results of operations and financial condition could be materially adversely affected by the factors described below.

While we describe each risk separately, some of these risks are interrelated and certain risks could trigger the applicability of other risks described below. Also, the risks and uncertainties described below are not the only ones that we may face. Additional risks and uncertainties not presently known to us, or that we currently do not consider significant, could also potentially impair, and have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations, and financial condition.

Risks Related to Economic and Market Conditions

Current uncertain economic conditions pose challenges, and could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

We are operating in an uncertain economic environment. Our business and operations, which primarily consist of lending money to customers in the form of loans, borrowing money from customers in the form of deposits and investing in securities, are sensitive to general business and economic conditions in the U.S. Continued economic uncertainty and a recessionary or stagnant economy could result in financial stress on our borrowers, which could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations. Deteriorating conditions in the regional economies we serve, or in certain sectors of those economies, could drive losses beyond that which is provided for in our allowance for credit losses. We could also face the following risks with the following events:

  • market developments (both domestic and international), the value of the U.S. Dollar in relation to the currencies of other advanced and emerging market countries, inflation and economic stagnation or slowdown may affect consumer confidence levels and may cause adverse changes in payment patterns, resulting in increased delinquencies and default rates on loans and other credit facilities;
  • the processes we use to estimate the allowance for credit losses and other reserves may prove to be unreliable. Such estimates rely upon complex modeling inputs and judgments, including forecasts of economic conditions, which may be impaired during periods of heightened volatility or incomplete economic data reporting, and could therefore be rendered inaccurate and/or no longer subject to accurate forecasting;
  • our ability to assess the creditworthiness of our borrowers may be impaired if the models and approaches we use to select, manage, and underwrite loans become less predictive of future charge-offs;
  • the current administration may seek to implement a regulatory reform agenda that is significantly different than that of the prior administrations, impacting the rulemaking, supervision, examination and enforcement priorities of the federal banking agencies and potentially resulting in uncertainty, and, in addition, increased scrutiny of liquidity, interest‑rate risk management, digital‑asset‑related activities, and third‑party risk management could increase compliance costs or alter supervisory expectations;
  • ineffective monetary policy or other market conditions could cause rapid changes in interest rates and asset values that would have a materially adverse impact on our profitability and overall financial condition;
  • continued political gridlock or delays in federal budget appropriations could produce additional shutdowns that negatively affect household income, business activity, and the availability of timely federal economic reporting;
  • further erosion in the fiscal condition of the U.S. Treasury could lead to new taxes that would limit our ability to pursue growth and return profits to shareholders; and
  • the U.S. government’s decisions regarding its debt ceiling and the possibility that the U.S. could default on its debt obligations may cause further interest rate increases, disrupt access to capital markets and deepen recessionary conditions.

If these conditions or similar ones continue to exist or worsen, we could experience continuing or increased adverse effects on our financial condition.

We may be vulnerable to certain sectors of the economy and to economic conditions both generally and locally across the specific markets in which we operate.

Our financial performance may be adversely affected by macroeconomic factors that affect the U.S. economy. Unfavorable economic conditions, particularly in the Gulf South region, could significantly affect the demand for our loans and other products, the ability of borrowers to repay loans, and the value of collateral securing our outstanding loans. Such factors have and may continue to be caused by events that are difficult to predict with respect to nature, timing, duration and severity.

Table of Contents

Volatility in global financial markets, including, but not limited to inflation and governmental responses thereto, recessionary concerns, wars and other ongoing global conflicts, regime changes, tariffs and retaliatory tariffs, may continue to have a spillover effect that could ultimately impair the performance of the U.S. economy and, in turn, our results of operations and financial condition. In addition, geopolitical instability has contributed to supply‑chain disruptions, energy‑market volatility, and increased cyber‑security risks, any of which could adversely affect certain industry sectors within our lending footprint.

We are subject to lending concentration risk.

Our loan portfolio contains several industry, collateral and other concentrations including, but not limited to, commercial and residential real estate, healthcare, hospitality, shared national credits, and leveraged loans. Due to the exposure in these concentrations, disruptions in markets, economic conditions, including those resulting from heightened interest rates, inflation, supply chain disruptions, changes in laws or regulations or other events could significantly impact the ability of our borrowers to repay their loans and may have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

A substantial portion of our loan portfolio is secured by real estate. In weak economies, or in areas where real estate market conditions are distressed, we may experience a higher-than-normal level of nonperforming real estate loans. These risks may be exacerbated by heightened interest rates or tightening credit standards. The collateral value of the portfolio and the revenue stream from those loans could come under stress, and/or could be impacted by unforeseen events, such as pandemics, weather events, environmental contamination, among others, and additional provisions for the allowance for credit losses could be necessitated should actual and/or forecasted losses be in excess of our expectations. Our desire to foreclose on these properties given each circumstance and/or the ability to dispose of foreclosed real estate at prices at or above the respective carrying values could also be impaired, causing additional losses.

Certain changes in interest rates, loan origination, inflation, or the financial markets could affect our results of operations, demand for our products and our ability to deliver products efficiently.

Our assets and liabilities are primarily monetary in nature and we are subject to significant risks tied to changes in interest rates that are highly sensitive to many factors that are beyond our control. Inflation can influence the growth of total assets in the banking industry and the resulting level of capitalization. Inflation also affects the level of market interest rates, and therefore, the pricing of financial instruments. We believe the most significant potential impact of inflation on our financial results is our ability to manage the impact of changes in interest rates. Further, an increase in inflation could cause our and/or our customers' operating costs related to salaries and benefits, technology and supplies to increase at a faster pace than revenues.

Our ability to operate profitably is largely dependent upon net interest income. Net interest income is the primary component of our earnings and is affected by both local external factors such as economic conditions in the Gulf South and local competition for loans and deposits, as well as broader influences, such as federal monetary policy and market interest rates. Unexpected and/or significant movement in interest rates markedly changing the slope of the current yield curve could cause our and our customers’ net interest margins to decrease, subsequently reducing net interest income. In addition, such changes could adversely affect the valuation of our assets and liabilities.

In addition, loan originations, and potentially loan revenues, could be adversely impacted by sharply rising interest rates. Heightened interest rates have had and may continue to have adverse impacts on our borrowers and demand for our loan products. Continued heightened interest rates would increase debt service requirements for some of our borrowers; adversely affect those borrowers’ ability to pay us as contractually obligated; potentially reduce loan demand or result in additional delinquencies or charge-offs; and increase the cost of our deposits, which are a primary source of funding.

The fair market value of our securities portfolio and the investment income from these securities also fluctuate depending on general economic and market conditions. In addition, actual net investment income and/or cash flows from investments that carry prepayment risk, such as mortgage-backed and other asset-backed securities, may differ from those anticipated at the time of investment as a result of interest rate fluctuations. Changes in market values of investment securities classified as available for sale have impacted and may continue to negatively impact our other comprehensive income and equity levels through accumulated other comprehensive income, which includes net unrealized gains and losses on those securities. Further, such losses could be realized into earnings should liquidity and/or business strategy necessitate the sales of securities in a loss position.

An underperforming stock market could adversely affect wealth management fees associated with managed securities portfolios and could also reduce brokerage transactions, therefore reducing investment brokerage revenues.

Although management believes it has implemented an effective asset and liability management strategy to manage the potential effects of changes in interest rates, including the use of adjustable rate and/or short-term assets, and FHLB advances or longer term repurchase agreements, any substantial, unexpected change in market interest rates could have a material adverse effect on our

Table of Contents

financial condition and results of our operation and our strategies may not always be successful in managing the risks associated with changes in interest rates.

Changes in the policies of monetary authorities and other government action could adversely affect our profitability.

Interest rates and our financial performance are affected by credit policies of monetary authorities, particularly the Federal Reserve. The instruments of monetary policy employed by the Federal Reserve include open market transactions in U.S. government securities, changes in the discount rate or the federal funds rate on bank borrowings and changes in reserve requirements against bank deposits. In view of changing conditions in the national economy and in the money markets, we cannot predict the potential impact of future changes in interest rates, deposit levels, and loan demand on our business and earnings with certainty. Furthermore, the actions of the U.S. government and other governments have resulted, and in the future may result in currency fluctuations, exchange controls, market disruption, material decreases in the values of certain of our financial assets and other adverse effects. In addition, shifts in fiscal policy, geopolitical developments, civil unrest, or prolonged federal budget disruptions may further influence monetary‑policy decisions or impair overall market stability, and the potential erosion of Federal Reserve independence could negatively impact financial markets and impact our profitability.

Interest rate changes are dependent on the Federal Reserve’s assessment of economic data as it becomes available. Beginning in early 2022 and continuing into 2023, the Federal Reserve raised interest rates aggressively to combat inflation. Beginning in the third quarter of 2024, and continuing throughout 2025, the Federal Reserve slowly decreased interest rates, with future interest rate changes, either increases or decreases uncertain, and dependent on the Federal Reserve’s assessment of economic conditions and inflation. Market conditions have and may continue to require us to offer more attractive interest rates to depositors to compete for deposits, or pursue other sources of liquidity, such as wholesale funds. Further, when interest-bearing liabilities reprice or mature more quickly than interest-earning assets, an increase in interest rates generally results in a decrease in net interest income. Conversely, decreasing interest rates reduce our yield on our variable rate loans and on our new loans, which reduces our net interest income. In addition, lower interest rates may reduce our realized yields on investment securities which would reduce our net interest income and cause downward pressure on net interest margin in future periods. A significant reduction in our net interest income could have a material adverse impact on our capital, financial condition and results of operations.

Changes in monetary policy, including changes in interest rates, influence (i) the amount of interest we receive on loans and securities, (ii) the amount of interest we pay on deposits and borrowings, (iii) our ability to originate loans and obtain deposits, (iv) the fair value of our assets and liabilities, and (v) the reinvestment risk associated with changes in the duration of our mortgage-backed securities portfolio.

Changes in U.S. trade policies and other factors beyond the Company's control, including the imposition of tariffs and retaliatory tariffs, may adversely impact its business, financial condition and results of operations.

Changes to U.S. trade policies, legislation, treaties and tariffs, including trade policies and tariffs affecting other countries, including China, the European Union, Canada, Mexico, among others, and retaliatory tariffs by such countries may adversely impact our business, financial condition and results of operations. Tariffs, retaliatory tariffs or other trade restrictions on products and materials that the Company’s customers import or export, including among others, agricultural products, could cause the prices of our customers’ products to increase, could reduce demand for such products, or reduce our customers’ margins, and adversely impact their revenues, financial results and ability to service debt. Trade restrictions on products include export and import restrictions, such as those levied against Russia. In addition, expanded sanctions regimes, export‑control measures, and restrictions on technology‑related components may further disrupt supply chains, increase input costs for our commercial clients, reduce their competitiveness, or impair their ability to fulfill contractual obligations.

Geopolitical tensions, civil unrest, shifting U.S. foreign‑policy priorities, prolonged conflicts abroad, and heightened scrutiny of cross‑border business activity may also contribute to market volatility, reduced customer confidence, repricing of commodities or agricultural goods, and other economic pressures that could negatively affect our borrowers’ financial condition and credit performance.

Various modifications to U.S. tariffs have been announced, and further changes are expected to be made in the future, including in response to litigation. On February 20, 2026, the U.S. Supreme Court rendered a decision invalidating tariffs imposed under the International Emergency Economic Powers Act. This decision introduces uncertainty regarding potential refund processes and future trade policy actions and could affect the general economy, inflation, interest rates, supply chains, our customers, depositors, and third party service providers, and the results of our operations. The ultimate impact of tariffs and other trade policies on the Company’s business will depend on several factors, including future measures implemented by the U.S. government and the governments of other countries, the overall magnitude and duration of these measures, and the Company’s ability to mitigate effects.

Table of Contents

In addition, to the extent changes in the political environment have a negative impact on the Company or on the markets in which the Company operates its business, its results of operations and financial condition could be materially and adversely impacted.

The financial soundness and stability of other financial institutions could adversely affect us.

Our ability to engage in routine funding transactions could be adversely affected by the actions and financial soundness and stability of other financial institutions as a result of credit, trading, clearing or other relationships with such institutions. We routinely execute transactions with counterparties in the financial industry, including brokers and dealers, commercial banks and other institutional clients. As a result, defaults by, and even rumors regarding, other financial institutions, regional banks, or the financial services industry generally, could impair our ability to effect such transactions and could lead to losses or defaults by us. In addition, a number of our transactions expose us to credit risk in the event of default of a counterparty or client. Our credit risk may be increased if the collateral we hold in connection with such transactions cannot be realized or can only be liquidated at prices that are not sufficient to cover the full amount of our financial exposure. Any such losses could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

Further, bank failures, including the failures in the first half of 2023, have and may in the future diminish public confidence in small and regional banks’ abilities to safeguard deposits in excess of federally insured limits, which could prompt customers to maintain their deposits with larger financial institutions. Concerns over rapid, large-scale deposit movement have and could in the future heighten regulatory scrutiny surrounding liquidity and increase competition for deposits and the resulting cost of funding, which could create pressure on our net interest margin and results of operations. Events involving other regional or community banks, whether actual failures, regulatory interventions, or heightened market speculation, may trigger broader depositor or investor reactions, increased sensitivity to bank credit ratings, or unexpected shifts in deposit flows across the industry. In addition, bank failures have and could in the future prompt the FDIC to increase deposit insurance costs. Increases in funding, deposit insurance or other costs as a result of these types of events have and could in the future materially adversely affect our financial condition and results of operations. Moreover, disruption following such events generated, and may continue to generate, significant market volatility among publicly traded bank holding companies, particularly regional banks like Hancock Whitney Bank, potentially affecting our stock price, funding costs, liquidity position, and overall market perception.

Tax law and regulatory changes could adversely affect our financial condition and results of operations.

Changes to tax laws could significantly impact our business in the form of greater than expected income tax expense and taxes payable. Such changes may also negatively impact the financial condition of our customers and/or overall economic conditions. Further, future regulatory reforms that could include a heightened focus and scrutiny on BSA/AML-related compliance, expansion of consumer protections, the regulation of loan portfolios and credit concentrations to borrowers impacted by climate change, increased capital and liquidity requirements and limitations or additional taxes on share repurchases and dividends, could increase our costs and impact our business. Regulatory agencies may also alter examination priorities or enforcement approaches in light of recent market stresses, which could result in higher compliance burden, increased operational costs, or constraints on certain business activities.

Governmental responses to market disruptions and other events may be inadequate and may have unintended consequences.

Congress and financial regulators have and may continue to implement measures designed to stabilize financial markets, including in reaction to inflation. Potential future actions such as the proposed consumer credit card interest rate cap may lead to unprofitable products, especially for riskier borrowers, and could lead to cutting credit lines or eliminating cards, increased reliance on fees and increased debt burdens for those needing credit most, thereby having the potential to negatively impact bank asset quality. The overall impact of these and other efforts on the financial markets may be ineffective and could adversely affect our business. In addition, rapidly issued policy changes may create operational uncertainty, require accelerated compliance efforts, or result in market distortions that negatively affect our funding costs, deposit flows, loan demand, or securities valuations. There is also a risk that certain government interventions may create moral hazard, shift competitive dynamics, or produce uneven impacts across the banking industry.

We compete with a number of financial services companies that are not subject to the same degree of regulatory oversight. Further, our credit union competitors benefit from competitive advantages, including the credit union exemption from paying federal income tax and can, therefore, more aggressively price many products and services. The impact of the existing regulatory framework and any future changes to it could negatively affect our ability to compete with these institutions, which could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations and prospects.

We may need to rely on the financial markets to provide additional capital.

Our common stock is listed and traded on the NASDAQ Global Select Market. If our capital resources are inadequate to meet our capital requirements in the future, we may need to raise additional debt or equity capital. If conditions in the capital markets are not

Table of Contents

favorable, we may be constrained in raising capital. We maintain a consistent analyst following; therefore, downgrades in our prospects by one or more of our analysts may cause our stock price to fall and significantly limit our ability to access the markets for additional capital requirements. An inability to raise additional capital on acceptable terms when and if needed could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations.

The interest rates that we pay on our securities are also influenced by, among other things, the credit ratings that we, our affiliates and/or our securities receive from recognized rating agencies. Our credit ratings are based on a number of factors, including our financial strength and other factors not entirely within our control such as conditions affecting the financial services industry generally, and remain subject to change at any time. A downgrade to the credit rating of us or our affiliates could affect our ability to access the capital markets, increase our borrowing costs and negatively impact our profitability. A downgrade to us, our affiliates or our securities could create obligations or liabilities under the terms of our outstanding securities that could increase our costs or otherwise have a negative effect on our results of operations or financial condition. Additionally, a downgrade to the credit rating of any particular security issued by us or our affiliates could negatively affect the ability of the holders of that security to sell the securities and the prices at which any such securities may be sold.

Because our decision to incur debt and issue securities in future offerings will depend on market conditions and other factors beyond our control, we cannot predict or estimate the amount, timing or nature of our future offerings and debt financings. Further, market conditions could require us to accept less favorable terms for the issuance of our securities in the future. In addition, geopolitical and worldwide market conditions may cause disruption or volatility in the U.S. equity and debt markets, which could hinder our ability to issue debt and equity securities in the future on favorable terms.

Our investments in certain tax-advantaged projects may not generate returns as anticipated or at all and may have an adverse impact on our results of operations.

We invest in certain tax-advantaged investments that support qualified affordable housing projects and other community development initiatives. Our investments in these projects rely on the ability of the projects to generate a return primarily through the realization of federal and state income tax credits and other tax benefits. We face the risk that tax credits, which remain subject to recapture by taxing authorities based on compliance with relevant requirements at the project level, may not be able to be realized. The risk of not being able to realize the tax credits and other tax benefits associated with a particular project depends on many factors that are outside of our control. The project’s failure to maintain compliance impacts our ability to realize these tax credits and other tax benefits, which may have a negative impact on our investment, and as a result, on our financial condition and results of operations.

Risks Related to the Financial Services Industry

We must maintain adequate sources of funding and liquidity.

Effective liquidity management is essential for the operation of our business. We require sufficient liquidity to support our operations and fund outstanding liabilities, as well as to meet regulatory requirements. Our access to sources of liquidity in amounts adequate to fund our activities on terms that are acceptable to us could be impaired by factors that affect us specifically or the financial services industry or economy generally. Factors that could detrimentally impact our access to liquidity sources include an economic downturn that affects the geographic markets in which our loans and operations are concentrated, or any material deterioration of the credit markets.

Our operating results may also be negatively impacted by the value of our securities portfolio, if liquidity and/or business strategy necessitate the sales of securities in a loss position, and/or access to select sources of liquidity could be limited should unrealized losses continue to grow to exceed certain levels.

Our access to deposits may also be affected by the liquidity needs of our depositors and the loss of deposits to alternative institutions or investments. Although we have historically been successful in replacing maturing deposits and advances as necessary, we might not be able to duplicate that success in the future, especially if a large number of our depositors were to withdraw their amounts on deposit. A failure to maintain an adequate level of liquidity could materially and adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations. Conversely, liquidity in excess of current demand or operating needs may result in lower-earning assets that may adversely affect our results of operations.

Greater loan losses than expected may adversely affect our earnings.

We are exposed to the risk that our borrowers will be unable to repay their loans in accordance with their terms and that any collateral securing the payment of their loans may not be sufficient to ensure repayment. Credit risk is inherent in our business, and any material level of credit failure could have a material adverse effect on our operating results. Our credit risk with respect to our real estate and construction loan portfolios relates principally to the creditworthiness of our corporate borrowers and the value of the real estate pledged as security for the repayment of loans. Our credit risk with respect to our commercial and consumer loan portfolios depends on the general creditworthiness of businesses and individuals within our local markets.

Table of Contents

We make various assumptions and judgments about the collectability of our loan portfolio and provide an allowance for estimated credit losses based on a number of factors. This process requires subjective and complex judgments, including analysis of economic or market conditions that might impair the ability of borrowers to repay their loans. If our assumptions or judgments prove to be incorrect, the allowance for credit losses may not be sufficient to cover actual credit losses. We may have to increase our allowance in the future in response to the request of one of our primary banking regulators, to adjust for changing conditions and assumptions, to adjust for changes in resolution strategies, or as a result of any deterioration in the quality of our loan and lease portfolio. Losses in excess of the existing allowance or any provisions for loan losses taken to increase the allowance will reduce our net income and could materially adversely affect our financial condition and results of operations. Future provisions for loan losses may vary materially from the amounts of past provisions.

Further, we use quantitative models to help manage certain aspects of our business and to assist with certain business decisions, including estimating credit losses, grading loans and extending credit, estimating the effects of changing interest rates and other market measures on our financial condition and results of operations. Our modeling methodologies rely on many assumptions, historical analyses and correlations. These assumptions may be incorrect, particularly in times of market distress or volatility, and the historical correlations on which we rely may not continue to be relevant. As a result, our models may not capture or fully express the risks we face or may lead us to misjudge the business and economic environment in which we operate. If our models fail to produce reliable results on an ongoing basis, we may not make appropriate risk management or other business or financial decisions. Furthermore, strategies that we employ to manage and govern the risks associated with our use of models may not be effective or fully reliable, and as a result, we may realize losses or other lapses.

We depend on the accuracy and completeness of information about clients and counterparties.

In deciding whether to extend credit or enter into other transactions with clients and counterparties, we rely in substantial part on information furnished by or on behalf of clients and counterparties, including financial statements and other financial information. We also may rely on representations of clients and counterparties as to the accuracy and completeness of that information and, with respect to financial statements, on reports of independent auditors if made available. If this information is inaccurate, we may be subject to loan defaults, financial losses, regulatory action, reputational harm or other adverse effects with respect to our business, financial condition and results of operations.

We are subject to a variety of risks in connection with the sale of any loans.

From time to time, we may sell all or a portion of one or more loan portfolios, and in connection therewith we may make certain representations and warranties to the purchaser concerning the loans sold and the procedures under which those loans were originated and serviced. If any of these representations and warranties are incorrect, we may be required to indemnify the purchaser for any related losses, or we may be required to repurchase part or all of the affected loans. We may also be required to repurchase loans as a result of borrower fraud or in the event of early payment default by the borrower on a loan we have sold. If we are required to make any indemnity payments or repurchases and do not have a remedy available to us against a solvent counterparty to the loan or loans, we may not be able to recover our losses resulting from these indemnity payments and repurchases. Consequently, our results of operations may be adversely affected.

Risks Related to Our Operations

A failure in our operational systems or infrastructure, or those of third parties, could impair our liquidity, disrupt our businesses, result in the unauthorized disclosure of confidential information, damage our reputation and cause financial losses.

Our ability to adequately conduct and grow our business is dependent on our ability to create and maintain an appropriate operational and organizational control infrastructure. Operational risk can arise in numerous ways including employee fraud, theft or malfeasance; customer fraud; and control lapses in bank operations and information technology. Because the nature of the financial services business involves a high volume of transactions, certain errors in processing or recording transactions appropriately may be repeated or compounded before they are discovered. We have and plan to continue to make investments in technologies for sales and service, including mobile and online banking, as well as teller, customer service and loan origination platforms. These technologies and/or operational changes may lead to increased operational risk. Our dependence on our employees and automated systems, including the automated systems used by acquired entities and third parties, to record and process transactions may further increase the risk that technical failures or tampering of those systems will result in losses that are difficult to detect. We are also subject to disruptions of our operating systems arising from events that are wholly or partially beyond our control. In addition, products, services and processes are continually changing and we may not fully appreciate or identify new operational risks that may arise from such changes. Failure to maintain an appropriate operational infrastructure can lead to loss of service to customers, additional expenditures related to the detection and correction of operational failures, reputational damage and loss of customer confidence, legal actions, and noncompliance with various laws and regulations.

Table of Contents

We continuously monitor our operational and technological capabilities and make modifications and improvements when we believe it to be appropriate to do so. However, there are inherent limits to such capabilities. In some instances, we may build and maintain these capabilities ourselves. We also outsource some of these functions to third parties. These third parties may experience errors or disruptions that could adversely impact us and over which we may have limited control. Third parties may fail to properly perform services or comply with applicable laws and regulations, and replacing third-party providers could entail significant delay and expense. We also face risk from the integration of new infrastructure platforms and/or new third-party providers of such platforms into existing businesses.

Our operational and communications systems and infrastructure may fail or may be the subject of a security incident, breach, or cyber-attack that, if successful, could adversely affect our business and disrupt business continuity.

We depend on our ability to process, record and monitor a large number of client transactions and to communicate with clients and other institutions on a continuous basis. Our clients depend on us for access to their assets and account information.

Our online, business, financial, accounting, data processing, or other operating systems and facilities, or those of our third-party service providers, may stop operating properly or become disabled or damaged as a result of a number of factors, including events that are wholly or partially beyond our control. For example, there could be sudden increases in client transaction volume; electrical or telecommunications outages; natural disasters such as earthquakes, tornadoes, floods, and hurricanes; pandemics; events arising from local or larger scale political or social matters, including terrorist acts; occurrences of employee error, fraud, or malfeasance; and, as described below, cyber-attacks. Furthermore, for most financial institutions, transitioning from existing systems and software (or transitioning legacy systems and software) to a new provider is a significant and expensive undertaking and includes a number of risks, including crashes and system downtime, transition costs, decreased productivity, security risk, and legal and regulatory compliance risks.

Although we have response plans, business continuity plans and other safeguards in place, our operations and communications may be adversely affected by significant and widespread disruption to our systems and infrastructure that support our businesses and clients. While we continue to evolve and modify our response and business continuity plans, there can be no assurance in an escalating threat environment that they will be effective in avoiding disruption and business impacts. Our insurance may not be adequate to compensate us for all resulting losses, and the cost to obtain adequate coverage may continue to increase for us or the industry.

Security risks for financial institutions such as ours have dramatically increased in recent years, in part because of the proliferation of new technologies, included but not limited to AI, that may be used by threat actors to perpetuate cyberattacks, the use of the internet and telecommunications technologies to conduct financial transactions, and the increased sophistication, resources and activities of hackers, terrorists, activists, organized crime, and other external parties, including nation state actors. In addition, clients may use devices or software to access our products and services that are beyond our control environment, which may provide additional avenues for attackers to gain access to confidential information. Although we have information security procedures and controls in place, certain of our technologies, systems, networks, and clients’ devices and software have in the past and in the future likely will continue to be the target of cyber-attacks or information security incidents that could result in the unauthorized access, release, gathering, monitoring, use, loss, change or destruction of our or our clients’ confidential, proprietary and other information (including personal identifying information of individuals), or otherwise disrupt our or our clients’ or other third parties’ business operations. From time to time, we, like other financial institutions, become aware of information security vulnerabilities in software emanating from outside vendors and must take active steps to mitigate and prevent the potential exploitation of such vulnerabilities. Further, U.S. financial institutions and financial services companies will continue to face compromises in security of their websites or other systems, including ransomware attacks to shut down access to their networks and systems in an attempt to extract compensation from them to regain control. Financial institutions have also experienced, and will continue to be the target of, distributed denial-of-service attacks, a sophisticated and targeted attack intended to disable or degrade internet service or to sabotage systems.

We and others in our industry regularly are, and will continue to be, the subject of attempts by attackers to gain unauthorized access to our networks, systems, data and other infrastructure, or to obtain, change, or destroy confidential data (including personal identifying information of individuals) through a variety of means, including computer hacking, acts of vandalism or theft, malware, computer viruses or other malicious codes, phishing, brute force attacks, exploiting software vulnerabilities (including “zero-day attacks”), supply chain attacks, employee error or malfeasance, catastrophes, unforeseen events or other cyber-attacks. In the future, these attacks may result in unauthorized individuals obtaining access to our confidential information or that of our clients, or otherwise materially accessing, damaging, or disrupting our systems or infrastructure, or those of our third-party service providers.

To date, we have seen no material adverse impact on our business or operations from cyber-attacks or events. Any future significant compromise or breach of our data security, whether external or internal, or misuse of customer, associate, supplier or Company data, could result in significant disruption of our operations, reimbursement and other costs, lost sales, fines (which fines may not be covered by our insurance policies), lawsuits, regulatory scrutiny, and other legal exposure, a loss of trust in us on the part of our clients, vendors or other counterparties, client attrition and damage to our reputation. Any of these could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, our financial condition, and/or our share price. However, the ever-evolving threats mean we and our

Table of Contents

third-party service providers and vendors must continually evaluate and adapt our respective systems and processes and overall security environment, as well as those of any companies we acquire. We are continuously enhancing our controls, processes and practices designed to protect our networks, systems, data and other infrastructure from attack, damage or unauthorized access. This continued enhancement will require us to expend additional resources, including to investigate and remediate any information security vulnerabilities that may be detected. Despite our ongoing investments in security resources, talent, and business practices, there is no guarantee that these measures will be adequate to safeguard against all data security incidents, system compromises or misuses of data.

We rely on other companies to provide key components of our business infrastructure.

We rely on certain third parties to provide products and services necessary to maintain day-to-day operations, such as back-office support, data processing and storage, recording and monitoring transactions, online banking interfaces and services, internet connections, telecommunications, and network access. The failure of a third party to perform in accordance with the contracted arrangements under service level agreements as a result of changes in the third party’s organizational structure, financial condition, support for existing products and services, strategic focus, system interruption or breaches, or for any other reason, could be disruptive to our operations, which could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations. Our third-party applications may include confidential and proprietary data provided by vendors and by us, including personal employee and/or customer data. While we conduct due diligence prior to engaging with third-party vendors and perform ongoing monitoring of vendor controls, we do not control their operations. Further, while our third-party risk management policies and practices are designed to comply with current regulations, these policies and practices cannot eliminate this risk. Replacing these third parties could also create significant delays and expense. Transitioning services, integrating new platforms, or converting data from one provider to another can introduce operational complexity, require extensive testing, and temporarily disrupt customer service or internal workflows. Accordingly, use of such third parties creates an inherent risk to our business operations.

The continued development and use of artificial intelligence (AI) presents risks and challenges that may adversely impact our business.

The Company or its third-party (or fourth-party) vendors, clients or counterparties may develop or incorporate AI technology in certain business processes, services, or products. The development and use of AI presents a number of risks and challenges to the Company’s business. The legal and regulatory environment relating to AI is uncertain and rapidly evolving, both in the U.S. and internationally, and includes regulatory schemes targeted specifically at AI as well as provisions in intellectual property, privacy, cybersecurity, consumer protection, employment, and other laws applicable to the use of AI. These evolving laws and regulations could require changes in the Company’s implementation of AI technology and increase the Company’s compliance costs and the risk of non-compliance.

AI models, particularly generative AI models, may produce output or take action that is incorrect, that reflects biases included in the data on which they are trained, that results in the release of private, confidential, or proprietary information, that infringes on the intellectual property rights of others, or that is otherwise harmful. In addition, the complexity of many AI models makes it difficult to understand why they are generating particular outputs. This limited transparency increases the challenges associated with assessing the proper operation of AI models, understanding and monitoring the capabilities of the AI models, reducing erroneous output, eliminating bias, and complying with regulations that require documentation or explanation of the basis on which decisions are made. If these models fail to operate as intended, or if unintended outputs are relied upon for business decisions, we could experience operational errors, regulatory scrutiny, or reputational harm. Further, the Company may rely on AI models developed by third parties, and, to that extent, would be dependent in part on the manner in which those third parties develop and train their models, including risks arising from the inclusion of any unauthorized material in the training data for their models and the effectiveness of the steps these third parties have taken to limit the risks associated with the output of their models, matters over which the Company may have limited visibility. AI systems often rely on large volumes of data, including sensitive or proprietary information. The use, storage, and processing of such data could increase our exposure to cybersecurity, privacy, and data protection risks. Failure to properly safeguard data used in AI systems, or any real or perceived misuse of data, could result in unauthorized access, data compromises, regulatory actions, contractual liability, reputational harm, or loss of client trust. Additionally, limitations on our ability to access or use data, whether due to legal restrictions, contractual constraints, or changes in data availability, could impair the effectiveness of our AI tools. Any of these risks could expose the Company to liability or adverse legal or regulatory consequences and harm the Company’s reputation and the public perception of its business or the effectiveness of its security measures.

We are in the early stages of incorporating AI into our business activities to increase employee productivity. We have not yet deployed AI-driven systems in critical decision-making or client-facing processes. As noted above, our vendors or third parties may develop or incorporate AI technology in certain business processes, services, or products. Any reliance on AI presents a number of risks and challenges to our business. The legal and regulatory environment relating to AI is uncertain and rapidly evolving, both in the U.S. and internationally, and includes regulatory schemes targeted specifically at AI. On January 23, 2025, President Trump issued an executive order aimed at reducing barriers to AI innovation in the U.S. economy. The order requires relevant persons and bodies

Table of Contents

within the federal government to develop an AI action plan to carry out this objective and revokes prior AI-related executive orders, as well as all corresponding policies, regulations, order, directives, and other actions taken in response to such order. These evolving laws and regulations could require changes in our consideration and implementation of AI technology and increase our compliance costs and the risk of non-compliance.

We, or third parties from whom we license critical information technology systems, have in the past been, and in the future may be alleged to have infringed upon intellectual property rights owned by others.

Competitors or other third parties have in the past alleged, and in the future may allege that we, or consultants or other third parties retained or indemnified by us or from whom we license critical information technology systems, infringe on their intellectual property rights. Given the complex, rapidly changing and competitive technological and business environment in which we operate, and the potential risks and uncertainties of intellectual property-related litigation, an assertion of an infringement claim against us or our vendors may cause us to spend significant amounts to defend the claim (even if we ultimately prevail); to pay significant money damages; to lose significant revenues; to be prohibited from using the relevant systems, processes, technologies or other intellectual property; to cease offering certain products or services or to incur significant license, royalty or technology development expenses. Moreover, it has become common in recent years for individuals and groups to purchase intellectual property assets for the sole purpose of making claims of infringement and attempting to extract settlements from companies like ours. Even in instances where we believe that claims and allegations of intellectual property infringement against us are without merit, defending against such claims is time consuming and expensive and could result in the diversion of time and attention of our management and employees. In addition, although in some cases a third party may have agreed to indemnify us for such costs, such indemnifying party may refuse, or be unable, to uphold its contractual obligations.

Employee misconduct could expose us to significant legal liability and reputational harm.

We are vulnerable to reputational harm because we operate in an industry in which integrity and the confidence of our customers are of critical importance. Our employees could engage in fraudulent, illegal, wrongful or suspicious activities, improper use or disclosure of confidential information and/or activities resulting in consumer harm that adversely affects our customers and/or our business. Misconduct may include circumvention of internal controls, unauthorized transactions, manipulation or misuse of customer information, violations of laws or regulations, failure to follow Company policies, or errors in judgment arising from inadequate training or supervision. The precautions we take to detect and prevent such misconduct may not always be effective, particularly as schemes become more sophisticated and as remote‑work arrangements, digital‑banking channels, and AI‑enabled tools introduce new avenues for potential misuse or concealment of activity. We may be exposed to regulatory sanctions and/or penalties, and serious harm to our reputation, financial condition, customer relationships and ability to attract new customers.

Our business may be adversely affected by fraud.

As a financial institution, we are inherently exposed to risk in the form of theft and other fraudulent activities by customers, employees, or other third parties targeting us or our customers or data. Such activity may take many forms, including check fraud, electronic fraud, wire fraud, phishing, social engineering, spoofing, and other dishonest acts. Although we devote substantial resources to maintaining effective policies and internal controls to identify and prevent such incidents, given the increasing sophistication of possible perpetrators, we may experience financial losses or reputational harm as a result of fraud. Fraud schemes have also evolved to leverage advanced technologies, including AI, which may increase the difficulty of detecting and preventing fraudulent activity. Further, as a result of the increased sophistication of fraud activity, we continue to invest in systems, resources, and controls to detect and prevent fraud. This will result in continued ongoing investments in the future.

The value of our goodwill and other intangible assets may decline in the future.

A significant decline in our expected future cash flows, a significant adverse change in the business climate, slower growth rates or a significant and sustained decline in the price of our common stock may necessitate our taking charges in the future to reflect an impairment of our goodwill. Future regulatory actions and accounting changes could also have a material impact on assessments of goodwill for impairment.

Adverse events or circumstances could impact the recoverability of our intangible assets, including significant loss of core deposits and/or customer relationships acquired in our trust and asset management transactions, and increased competition or adverse changes in the economy related to these products. To the extent these intangible assets are deemed unrecoverable, a non-cash impairment charge would be recorded. While an impairment charge does not impact regulatory capital, it could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations.

Table of Contents

Risks Related to Our Business Strategy

We are subject to industry competition which may have an impact upon our success.

Our profitability depends on our ability to compete successfully in a highly competitive market for banking and financial services, and we expect such challenges to continue. Certain of our competitors are larger, have more resources than we do and may be perceived as better than regional banks at safeguarding deposits in excess of federally insured limits. We face competition in our regional market areas from other commercial banks, savings associations, credit unions, mortgage banking firms, securities brokerage firms, mutual funds and insurance companies, fintechs and other financial institutions that offer similar services. Some of our nonbank competitors are not subject to the same extensive supervision and regulation to which we or the Bank are subject and may, accordingly, have greater flexibility in competing for business. Over time, certain sectors of the financial services industry have become more concentrated, as institutions involved in a broad range of financial services have been acquired by other firms. These developments could result in our competitors gaining greater capital and other resources or being able to offer a broader range of products and services with more geographic range.

Our loan and deposit pricing may be negatively impacted by our competitive environment. If our fee structures are deemed less favorable than other financial services providers, we may be at a competitive disadvantage in attracting customers for certain fee producing products. Further, we may choose to implement changes to remain competitive that could adversely affect our operating results.

Another competitive factor is that the financial services market, including banking services, is undergoing rapid changes with frequent introductions of new technology-driven products and services, primarily as a result of the increased digitization of banking services. We compete with many forms of payments offered by both bank and non-bank providers, including a variety of new and evolving alternative payment mechanisms, systems and products, such as aggregators and web-based and wireless payment platforms or technologies, digital or “crypto” currencies, including but not limited to stablecoins, prepaid systems and payment services targeting users of social networks, communications platforms and online gaming. Our future success may depend, in part, on our ability to use technology competitively to offer products and services that provide convenience to customers and create additional efficiencies in our operations. The widespread adoption of new technologies has and will continue to require us to make substantial capital expenditures to modify or adapt our systems to remain competitive and offer new products and services. Our ability to effectively implement new technologies to improve our operations and systems will impact our competitive position in the financial services industry. Furthermore, we may not be successful in introducing new products and services in response to industry trends or developments in technology, or those new products may not be accepted by customers.

If we are unable to successfully compete with traditional competitors as well as the evolving landscape of fintech companies and other nontraditional competitors to attract and retain customers, our business, financial condition or results of operations may also be adversely affected, perhaps materially. In particular, if we experience an outflow of deposits as a result of our customers desiring to do business with our competitors, we may be forced to rely more heavily on borrowings and other sources of funding to operate our business and meet withdrawal demands, thereby adversely affecting our net interest margin.

The implementation of new lines of business or new products and services may subject us to additional risk.

We continuously evaluate our service offerings and may implement new lines of business or offer new products and services within existing lines of business in the future. There are substantial risks and uncertainties associated with these efforts. The development of new lines of business or new products and services often requires the commitment of significant resources that may not be recouped if not successful. Variables beyond our control or that we do not foresee may prevent the successful implementation of new lines of business, products or services. Initial timetables for the introduction and development of new lines of business and/or new products or services may not be achieved, and price and profitability targets may not prove feasible. External factors, such as compliance with regulations, competitive alternatives, and shifting market preferences, may also impact the successful implementation of a new line of business and/or a new product or service. Furthermore, any new line of business and/or new product or service could require the establishment of new key and other controls and have a significant impact on our existing system of internal controls. Failure to successfully manage these risks in the development and implementation of new lines of business and/or new products or services could have a material adverse effect on our business and, in turn, our financial condition and results of operations.

Table of Contents

We may not realize the expected benefits from our efficiency and growth initiatives, which could negatively impact our future profitability.

Operating costs must decrease or grow at a slower pace than overall revenue in order to thrive in the competitive banking environment. We have and will continue to implement strategies to grow our loan portfolio and increase noninterest income in order to realize earnings growth and to remain competitive with the other banks in the markets we serve. We are continuously focused on growth initiatives and strategies for expense reductions to increase efficiencies. While we have had success in cost-savings and revenue growth in the past, there is no guarantee that these initiatives will be successful in the future. In addition, while expense control continues to be a top focus for us, management also expects to continue to make strategic investments in technology and other revenue-generating initiatives that are expected to improve our customer experience and support future growth, which will require an increase in expenditures. These investments may take longer than anticipated to implement, may not generate expected efficiencies or revenue opportunities, or may require additional spending to address unforeseen challenges such as system integration issues, vendor performance, or regulatory expectations. There can be no assurance that we will ultimately realize the anticipated benefits of our expense reduction and growth strategies, which may impair our earnings growth. Further, we may not be able to realize cost savings or revenue benefits in the time period expected and/or be able to sustain success in such items at targeted levels, which could negatively affect our near-term profitability.

Our future growth and financial performance may be negatively affected if we are unable to successfully execute our growth plans, which may include acquisitions and de novo branching.

We may not be able to continue our organic or internal growth, which depends upon economic conditions, our ability to identify appropriate markets for expansion, our ability to recruit and retain qualified personnel, our ability to fund growth at a reasonable cost, sufficient capital to support our growth initiatives, competitive factors, banking laws, and other factors.

We may seek to supplement our internal growth through acquisitions. We cannot predict the number, size or timing of acquisitions, or whether any such acquisition will occur at all. Our acquisition efforts have traditionally focused on targeted banking entities in markets in which we currently operate and markets in which we believe we can compete effectively. However, as consolidation of the financial services industry continues, the competition for suitable acquisition candidates may increase and, as the number of appropriate targets decreases, the prices for potential acquisitions could increase, which could reduce our potential returns and reduce the attractiveness of these opportunities to us. In addition, we have and expect to continue to seek to acquire other businesses or segments of business that may support or add to existing product lines, such as trust and asset management services. We may compete with other financial services companies for acquisition opportunities, and many of these competitors have greater financial resources than we do and may be able to pay more for an acquisition than we are able or willing to pay.

We also may be required to use a substantial amount of our available cash and other liquid assets, or seek additional debt or equity financing, to fund future acquisitions. Such events could make us more susceptible to economic downturns and competitive pressures, and additional debt service requirements may impose a significant burden on our results of operations and financial condition. If we are unable to locate suitable acquisition candidates willing to sell on terms acceptable to us, or we are otherwise unable to obtain additional debt or equity financing necessary for us to continue making acquisitions, we would be required to find other methods to grow our business and we may not grow at the same rate we have in the past, or at all.

We must generally satisfy several conditions, including receiving federal regulatory approval, in order to execute most acquisition transactions. In determining whether to approve a proposed bank acquisition, federal bank regulators will consider, among other factors, the effect of the acquisition on competition, financial condition, and future prospects. The regulators also review current and projected capital ratios and levels; the competence, experience, and integrity of management and its record of compliance with laws and regulations; the convenience and needs of the communities to be served (including the acquiring institution’s record of compliance under the Community Reinvestment Act) and the effectiveness of the acquiring institution in combating money laundering activities. We cannot be certain when or if, or on what terms and conditions, any required regulatory approvals will be granted. We may also be required to sell banks or branches as a condition to receiving regulatory approval, which condition may not be acceptable to us or, if acceptable to us, may reduce the benefit of any acquisition. Additionally, federal and/or state regulators may charge us with regulatory and compliance failures of an acquired business that occurred prior to the date of acquisition, and such failures may result in the imposition of formal or informal enforcement actions.

We cannot provide assurance that we will be able to successfully consolidate any business or assets we acquire with our existing business. The integration of acquired operations and assets may require substantial management effort, time and resources and may divert management’s focus from other strategic opportunities and operational matters. Acquisitions may not perform as expected when the transaction was consummated and may be dilutive to our overall operating results and stockholders’ equity per share of common stock. Specifically, acquisitions could result in higher-than-expected deposit attrition, loss of key employees or other consequences that could adversely affect our ability to maintain relationships with customers and employees. We may also sell or consider selling one or more of our businesses. Such a sale would generally be subject to certain federal and/or state regulatory approvals, and may not be able to generate gains on sale or related increases in stockholders’ equity commensurate with desirable levels.

Table of Contents

In addition to the acquisition of existing financial institutions, as opportunities arise, we are currently and may continue to explore de novo branching as a part of our internal growth strategy and enter into new markets through de novo branching. De novo branching and any acquisition carry numerous risks, including the following:

  • the inability to obtain all required regulatory approvals;
  • significant costs and anticipated operating losses associated with establishing a de novo branch or a new bank;
  • the inability to secure the services of qualified senior management;
  • the failure of the local market to accept the services of a new bank owned and managed by a bank holding company headquartered outside of the market area of the new bank;
  • economic downturns in the new market;
  • the inability to obtain attractive locations within a new market at a reasonable cost; and
  • the additional strain on management resources and internal systems and controls.

We have experienced, to some extent, many of these risks with our de novo branching to date.

Changes in retail distribution strategies and consumer behavior may adversely impact our investments in bank premises, equipment, technology and other assets and may lead to increased expenditures to change our retail distribution channel.

We have significant investments in bank premises and equipment for our branch network. Advances in technology such as e-commerce, telephone, internet and mobile banking, and in-branch self-service technologies including automated teller machines and other equipment, as well as an increasing customer preference for these other methods of accessing our products and services, could decrease the value of our branch network, technology, or other retail distribution physical assets. Such advances may also cause us to change our retail distribution strategy, close and/or sell certain branches or parcels of land held for development and restructure or reduce our remaining branches and work force. Such actions in the future could lead to losses on disposition of such assets or could adversely impact the carrying value of any long-lived assets and may lead to increased expenditures to renovate, reconfigure or close a number of our remaining branches or to otherwise reform our retail distribution channel.

Risks Related to the Legal and Regulatory Environment

We are subject to regulation by various federal and state entities.

We are subject to the regulations of the Commission, the Federal Reserve, the FDIC, the CFPB and the MDBCF. New regulations issued by these or other agencies may adversely affect our ability to carry on our business activities. We are subject to various federal and state laws, and certain changes in these laws and regulations may adversely affect our operations. Other than the federal securities laws, the laws and regulations governing our business are intended primarily for the protection of our depositors, our customers, the financial system and the FDIC insurance fund, not our shareholders or other creditors. Further, we must obtain approval from our regulators before engaging in certain activities, and our regulators have the ability to compel us to, or restrict us from, taking certain actions entirely, such as increasing dividends, entering into merger or acquisition transactions, acquiring or establishing new branches, and entering into certain new businesses. Noncompliance with certain of these regulations may impact our business plans, including our ability to branch, offer certain products, or execute existing or planned business strategies.

For additional information regarding laws and regulations to which our business is subject, see “Supervision and Regulation.”

Any of the laws or regulations to which we are subject, including tax laws, regulations or their interpretations, may be modified or changed from time to time, and we cannot be assured that such modifications or changes will not adversely affect us. Failure to appropriately comply with any such laws or regulations could result in sanctions by regulatory authorities, civil monetary penalties or damage to our reputation, all of which could adversely affect our business, financial condition or results of operations. Further, implementation of new rules could require additional cost and negatively impact operating results. Changes in supervisory expectations may also require us to modify internal controls, policies, systems, or reporting processes, increasing compliance and operational costs.

In addition, as the regulatory environment related to information security, data collection and use, and privacy becomes increasingly rigorous, with new and constantly changing requirements applicable to our business, compliance with those requirements could also result in additional costs. Evolving requirements related to data governance, cyber‑resiliency, customer‑data access, and incident‑reporting obligations may require significant investments in technology, personnel, and processes. Failure to meet these expectations could result in enforcement actions, operational limitations, or reputational harm.

Table of Contents

We and other financial institutions have been the subject of litigation, investigations and other proceedings which could result in legal liability and damage to our reputation.

We and certain of our directors, officers and subsidiaries are named from time to time as defendants in various class actions and other litigation relating to our business and activities. Past, present and future litigation has included or could include claims for substantial compensatory and/or punitive damages or claims for indeterminate amounts of damages. We are also involved from time to time in other reviews, investigations and proceedings (both formal and informal) by governmental, law enforcement and self-regulatory agencies regarding our business. These matters could result in adverse judgments, settlements, fines, penalties, injunctions, amendments and/or restatements of our Commission filings and/or financial statements, determinations of material weaknesses in our disclosure controls and procedures or other relief. Substantial legal liability or significant regulatory action against us, as well as matters in which we are involved that are ultimately determined in our favor, could materially adversely affect our business, financial condition or results of operations, cause significant reputational harm to our business, divert management attention from the operation of our business and/or result in additional litigation.

In addition, in recent years, a number of judicial decisions have upheld the right of borrowers to sue lending institutions on the basis of various evolving legal theories, collectively termed “lender liability.” We have been and in the future could become subject to claims based on this or other evolving legal theories. Further, banking institutions are also increasingly the target of class action lawsuits, including claims alleging deceptive practices or violations of account terms in connection with non-sufficient funds or overdraft charges and violations of the Fair Labor Standards Act (FLSA). Banks have also faced growing litigation related to fees, payment‑processing practices, data privacy issues, employment matters, debanking, and digital‑banking disclosures, any of which could result in monetary losses, mandated changes to business practices, or reputational harm. We manage these risks through internal controls, personnel training, insurance, litigation management, our compliance and ethics processes, and other means. However, the commencement, outcome, and magnitude of litigation cannot be predicted or controlled with any certainty.

Risks Related to Our Common Stock

Future issuances of equity securities could dilute the interests of holders of our common stock, and our common stock ranks junior to indebtedness.

Our common stock ranks junior to all of our existing and future indebtedness with respect to distributions and liquidation. In addition, future issuances of equity securities, including pursuant to outstanding share-based payment arrangements, could dilute the interests of our existing shareholders, including you, and could cause the market price of our common stock to decline. Moreover, to the extent that we issue restricted stock units, phantom shares, stock appreciation rights, options or warrants to purchase our common stock in the future and those stock appreciation rights, options or warrants are exercised or as the restricted stock units vest, our shareholders may experience further dilution.

Holders of our shares of common stock do not have preemptive rights. Additionally, sales of a substantial number of shares of our common stock in public markets and the availability of those shares for sale could adversely affect the market price of our common stock.

Our ability to deliver and pay dividends depends primarily upon the results of operations of our subsidiary Bank, and we may not pay, or be permitted to pay, dividends in the future.

We are a bank holding company that conducts substantially all of our operations through our subsidiary Bank. As a result, our ability to make dividend payments on our common stock will depend primarily upon the receipt of dividends and other distributions from the Bank.

The ability of the Bank to pay dividends or make other payments to us, as well as our ability to pay dividends on our common stock, is limited by the Bank’s obligation to maintain sufficient capital and by other general regulatory restrictions on its dividends, which have tightened since the financial crisis. The Federal Reserve has stated that bank holding companies should not pay dividends from sources other than current earnings. If these requirements are not satisfied, we may be unable to pay dividends on our common stock.

We may also decide to limit the payment of dividends even when we have the legal ability to pay them in order to retain earnings for use in our business, which could adversely affect the market value of our common stock. There can be no assurance of whether or when we may pay dividends in the future.

Mississippi law, and anti-takeover provisions in our articles of incorporation and bylaws could make a third-party acquisition of us difficult and may adversely affect share value.

Our articles of incorporation and bylaws contain provisions that make it more difficult for a third party to acquire us (even if doing so might be beneficial to our shareholders) and for holders of our securities to receive any related takeover premium for their securities.

Table of Contents

We are also subject to certain provisions of state and federal law and our articles of incorporation that may make it more difficult for someone to acquire control of us. Under federal law, subject to certain exemptions, a person, entity, or group must notify the federal banking agencies before acquiring 10% or more of the outstanding voting stock of a bank holding company, including shares of our common stock. Banking agencies review the acquisition to determine if it will result in a change of control. The banking agencies have 60 days to act on the notice, and take into account several factors, including the resources of the acquirer and the antitrust effects of the acquisition. Additionally, a bank holding company must obtain the prior approval of the Federal Reserve before, among other things, acquiring direct or indirect ownership or control of more than 5% of the voting shares of any bank. There are also Mississippi statutory provisions and provisions in our articles of incorporation that may be used to delay or block a takeover attempt. As a result, these statutory provisions and provisions in our articles of incorporation could result in our being less attractive to a potential acquirer and limit the price that investors might be willing to pay in the future for shares of our common stock.

Shares of our common stock are not insured deposits and may lose value.

Shares of our common stock are not savings accounts, deposits or other obligations of any depository institution and are not insured or guaranteed by the FDIC or any other governmental agency or instrumentality, any other deposit insurance fund or by any other public or private entity, and are subject to investment risk, including the possible loss of principal.

General Risk Factors

We must attract and retain skilled personnel.

Our success depends, in substantial part, on our ability to attract and retain skilled, experienced personnel in key positions within the organization. Competition for qualified candidates in the activities and markets that we serve is intense. If we are not able to hire, adequately compensate, or retain these key individuals, we may be unable to execute our business strategies and may suffer adverse consequences to our business, financial condition and results of operations. Labor shortages have and may continue to restrict our ability to attract and retain personnel and increase related costs.

Natural and man-made disasters could affect our ability to operate.

Our market areas are often impacted by hurricanes and flooding. Natural disasters, such as hurricanes, flooding, tornados, freezes and other natural and man-made disasters, such as oil spills, can disrupt our operations, result in significant damage to our properties or properties and businesses of our borrowers, including property pledged as collateral, interrupt our ability to conduct business, negatively affect the local economies in which we operate, and increase circumstances leading to litigation.

We cannot predict whether or to what extent damage caused by future hurricanes and other disasters will affect our operations or the economies in our market areas, but such events could cause a decline in loan originations, a decline in the value or destruction of properties securing the loans and an increase in the risk of delinquencies, foreclosures, loan losses and litigation. Climate change may increase the nature, severity and frequency of adverse weather conditions in our footprint, making the impact from these types of natural disasters on us or our customers worse.

We and our customers rely on the existence of, and ability of private and public insurance programs to provide coverage for these types of events. Cost for insurance coverage under these programs has and may continue to increase, negatively impacting our business costs and our customers’ levels of liquidity and the ability to service their debt. The unavailability of these types of coverage or the inability of these entities to perform could also have a materially adverse impact on our operations. Further, our business, financial condition, and results of operations may be adversely affected by potential changes in federal emergency response, disaster relief, and recovery policies, including, but not limited to, actions by the Federal Emergency Management Agency or reductions in federal disaster funding. Delays or changes in governmental support programs, rebuilding assistance, flood‑insurance availability, or disaster‑recovery rules could slow economic recovery in affected areas, impact collateral values, and adversely affect borrower repayment capacity.

Increased scrutiny and evolving expectations from stakeholders with respect to sustainability practices may impose additional costs on us or expose us to new or additional risks.

As a regulated financial institution and a publicly traded company, we are facing increasing public, investor, activist, legislative and regulatory scrutiny related to sustainability practices, disclosures and developments. Regulators, politicians, investor advocacy groups, investment funds, and influential investors are increasingly focused on these practices, especially as they relate to climate risk, hiring practices, diversity, health and safety and human rights. Failure to adapt to or comply with regulatory requirements or regulatory, investor or stakeholder expectations and standards could negatively impact the Company’s reputation, ability to do business with certain partners, and stock price. Ongoing legislative or regulatory uncertainties, divergence and changes regarding sustainability may result in higher compliance, credit and reputational risks and costs. To the extent that we or our customers experience increases in

Table of Contents

costs, including with respect to compliance with any additional regulatory or disclosure requirements or expectations, reductions in the value of assets, constraints on operations or similar concerns driven by changes in sustainability oversight and regulation, our results of operations, financial condition, and business could be adversely affected.

We are exposed to reputational risk.

Negative public opinion can result from our actual or alleged improper activities, such as lending practices, data security breaches, corporate governance policies and decisions, and acquisitions, any of which may damage our reputation. Reputational harm can be amplified quickly through traditional media, online platforms, and social media channels, regardless of the accuracy or context of the underlying issue. Even unfounded allegations can spread rapidly and require significant resources to address. Negative public opinion can also result from action or inaction related to environmental, social and corporate governance matters. Additionally, actions taken by government regulators and community organizations may also damage our reputation. Negative public opinion could adversely affect our ability to attract and retain customers or expose us to litigation and regulatory action.

Changes in accounting policies or in accounting standards could materially affect how we report our financial condition and results of operations.

The preparation of consolidated financial statements in conformity with U.S generally accepted accounting principles (“GAAP”), including the accounting rules and regulations of the Commission and the FASB, requires management to make significant estimates and assumptions that impact our financial statements by affecting the value of our assets or liabilities and results of operations. Some of our accounting policies are critical because they require management to make difficult, subjective and complex judgments about matters that are inherently uncertain and because materially different amounts may be reported if different estimates or assumptions are used. If such estimates or assumptions underlying our financial statements are incorrect, our financial condition and results of operations could be adversely affected.

From time to time, the FASB and the Commission change the financial accounting and reporting standards or the interpretation of such standards that govern the preparation of our external financial statements. These changes are beyond our control, can be difficult to predict, may require extraordinary efforts or additional costs to implement and could materially impact how we report our financial condition and results of operations. Additionally, we may be required to apply a new or revised standard retrospectively, resulting in the restatement of prior period financial statements in material amounts.

Table of Contents

ITEM 1B. UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS

None.

ITEM 1C. CYBERSECURITY

Cybersecurity Risk Management and Strategy

The Company’s information security program is designed to protect the security, availability, integrity, and confidentiality of our computer systems, networks, software and information assets, including client and other sensitive data. The program is comprised of policies, guidelines, and procedures. These policies, guidelines, and procedures are intended to align with regulatory guidance, the ISO Code of Practice for Information Security Controls, and common industry practices. Assessing, identifying and managing cybersecurity related risks are integrated into our overall enterprise risk management process.

The Company expects each associate to be responsible for the security and confidentiality of client information. We communicate this responsibility to associates upon hiring and regularly throughout their employment. We require each associate to complete training to protect the confidentiality of client information at the time of hire and during each year of employment. Associates must successfully pass a test to demonstrate understanding of these requirements and provide acknowledgement of their responsibilities.

Additionally, we regularly provide associates with information security awareness training covering the recognition and appropriate handling of potential phishing emails, which can introduce malware to a company’s network, result in the theft of user credentials and, ultimately, place client or employee data, or other sensitive company data, and information at risk. The Company employs a number of technical controls to mitigate the risk of phishing emails. We regularly test associates to determine their susceptibility to phishing emails. We require susceptible associates to take additional training and provide regular reports to management. We additionally maintain procedures for the safe storage and handling and secure disposal of sensitive information.

The Company protects its network and information assets with industry-tested security products and processes. Our teams actively monitor company networks and systems to detect suspicious or malicious events. The Company evaluates potential cyber risks, as appropriate, in its regular risk assessments. The Company also conducts vulnerability scans, and contracts with third-party vendors to perform penetration tests against the Company’s network. In addition, the Company’s Cyber Defense Center team monitors threat intelligence sources to anticipate and research evolving threats, investigates their potential impact to financial services companies, examines the Company’s controls to detect and defend against those threats, and proactively adjusts the Company’s defenses against those threats. The Company also engages expert cyber consultants, as necessary and appropriate.

Before engaging third-party service providers who may have access to the Company’s, customer, employee or other sensitive data, or to the Company’s systems, we perform due diligence in order to identify and evaluate their cyber risks, which includes self-attestation questionnaires (developed using Service Organization Controls (SOC) reports). This process is led by the Third-Party Risk Management team and includes participation of dedicated information security resources. Third-party service providers processing sensitive data are contractually required to meet applicable legal and regulatory obligations to protect sensitive data against cybersecurity threats and unauthorized access to the sensitive data. After contract executions, third-party service providers deemed critical by our Third-Party Risk Management team undergo ongoing monitoring to ensure they continue to meet their security obligations and other potential cybersecurity threats.

As part of our information security program, we have adopted an Information and Cybersecurity Incident Response Plan (Incident Response Plan), which is administered by our Chief Information Security Officer (CISO) in close collaboration with our Director of Enterprise IT Risk. The Incident Response Plan describes the Company’s processes, procedures, and responsibilities for responding to cybersecurity incidents. The Incident Response Plan is intended to proceed on parallel paths in the event of a cybersecurity incident, including implementation of (i) forensic and containment, eradication, and remediation actions by information technology and security personnel and (ii) operational response actions by business, communications, and risk personnel. Our incident response team annually performs exercises to simulate responses to cybersecurity events.

The Incident Response Plan includes procedures for timely escalation and reporting of potentially significant cybersecurity incidents to the Company’s Chief Operating Officer, Chief Financial Officer, Chief Risk Officer, our Board Risk Committee, law enforcement, government agencies and impacted parties, as needed.

Impacts of Cybersecurity Incidents

To date, the Company has no knowledge that we have experienced a cybersecurity incident or breach that has or is reasonably likely to have a material impact on our business strategy, results of operations, or financial condition. Despite our efforts, there can be no assurance that our cybersecurity risk management processes and measures described will be fully implemented, complied with, or effective in protecting our systems and information. We face risks from certain cybersecurity threats that, if realized, are reasonably

Table of Contents

likely to materially affect our business strategy, results of operations or financial condition. See Item 1A. “Risk Factors” in this document for further discussion of the risks associated with an interruption or breach in our information systems or infrastructure.

Cybersecurity Governance

Our Board of Directors is responsible for overseeing the Company’s business and affairs, including risks associated with cybersecurity threats. The Board oversees the Company’s corporate risk governance processes primarily through its committees, and oversight of cybersecurity threats is delegated primarily to our Board Risk Committee. The Board also periodically designates directors as its cybersecurity contact points. Our Chief Operating Officer facilitates the involvement of these designated directors in oversight of potentially significant cybersecurity incidents. The current directors designated as cybersecurity contacts are Chairman Jerry Levens, Board Risk Committee Chair Frank Bertucci, and Suzette Kent.

The Risk Committee oversees the management process associated with cybersecurity risk. Cybersecurity matters and assessments are regularly included in Board Risk Committee meetings. The Board Risk Committee has primary responsibility for overseeing the Company’s comprehensive Enterprise Risk Management program. The Enterprise Risk Management program assists senior management in identifying, assessing, monitoring, and managing risk, including cybersecurity risk, in a rapidly changing environment. The Board Risk Committee provides reports to the full Board on the Company’s information security program on an annual basis.

The Company’s CISO directs our information security program, supported by a team of dedicated security professionals that examine risks to the Company’s information systems and assets, design and implement security solutions, monitor the environment and provide immediate responses to threats. In this role, the CISO manages the Company’s information technology governance, risk, and compliance program, cybersecurity operations, business continuity, crisis management and supports the information security and technology risk oversight responsibilities of the Board and its committees. The CISO is a member of the Company’s Corporate Operations group and reports to our Chief Information Officer, who reports to our Head of Operations, Technology and Products, who in turn reports to our Chief Operating Officer. The CISO regularly attends Board Risk Committee meetings and sits in executive session with the Committee members at least annually to update committee members on material cybersecurity and other information security developments and risks. The CISO also provides an annual information security program summary report to the Board, outlining the overall status of our information security program and the Company’s compliance with regulatory guidelines. The IT Risk Governance Subcommittee, a management level subcommittee of our Operations Committee, also addresses information security and is responsible for overseeing the protection of the integrity, security, safety and resiliency of corporate information systems and assets. The IT Risk Governance Committee meets quarterly to review the development of the program and provide recommendations. The subcommittee provides regular reports to the Operations Committee and, ultimately, the Board Risk Committee through the CISO. Our CISO leads the Company’s IT Risk Governance Committee.

Our Board of Directors oversees the Company’s use of Artificial Intelligence (AI). Management has established an AI Working Group, which includes representatives from Legal, Compliance, Risk, and Information Technology. This Working Group reports to the IT Risk Governance Committee and is responsible for the approval of AI use cases, ensuring alignment with our Company’s core values and for the evolving risks around AI. Our cybersecurity program tracks AI-driven threats while also leveraging AI tools to enhance our security posture.

Our CISO has cybersecurity experience spanning more than two decades. Prior experience includes senior security roles in large government agencies and Fortune 200 companies. He has spoken at area colleges and various industry events about information security. He holds a degree in electrical engineering, is a graduate of banking school, and maintains several industry certifications.

Table of Contents

ITEM 2. PROPERTIES

The Company’s main office, which is the headquarters of the holding company, is located at Hancock Whitney Plaza, in Gulfport, Mississippi. The Bank makes portions of the main office facilities and certain other facilities available for lease to third parties, although such incidental leasing activity is not material to the Company’s overall operations.

The Company operates 180 full-service banking and financial services offices and 221 automated teller machines across our market, primarily in the Gulf south corridor, including southern and central Mississippi; southern and central Alabama; southern, central and northwest Louisiana; the northern, central, and panhandle regions of Florida; and certain areas of east and northeast Texas. Additionally, the Company operates combined loan and deposit production offices in the metropolitan areas of Nashville, Tennessee and Atlanta, Georgia. The Company owns over 70% of these facilities, and the remaining banking facilities are subject to leases, each of which we consider reasonable and appropriate for its location. We ensure that all properties, whether owned or leased, are maintained in suitable condition. We also evaluate our banking facilities on an ongoing basis to identify possible under-utilization and to determine the need for functional improvements, relocations, closures or possible sales. The Bank and its subsidiaries hold a variety of property interests acquired in settlement of loans. Some of these properties were acquired in transactions before 1979 and are carried at nominal amounts on our balance sheet and reflected net income of $0.6 million in our 2025 operating results.

ITEM 3. LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

We and our subsidiaries are party to various legal proceedings arising in the ordinary course of business. We do not believe that loss contingencies, if any, arising from pending litigation and regulatory matters will have a material adverse effect on our consolidated financial position or liquidity.

ITEM 4. MINE SAFETY DISCLOSURES

Not applicable.

Table of Contents

PART II

ITEM 5. MARKET FOR THE REGISTRANT’S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS AND ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES

Market Information

The Company’s common stock trades on the Nasdaq Global Select Market under the ticker symbol “HWC.” There were 6,583 active holders of record of the Company’s common stock at January 31, 2026 and 81,662,941 shares outstanding.

Stock Performance Graph

The following performance graph and related information are neither “soliciting material” nor “filed” with the SEC, nor shall such information be incorporated by reference into any future filings under the Securities Act of 1933 or the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, each as amended, except to the extent the Company specifically incorporates it by reference into such filing.

The performance graph compares the cumulative five-year shareholder return on the Company’s common stock, assuming an investment of $100 on December 31, 2020 and the reinvestment of dividends thereafter, to that of the common stocks of United States companies reported in the Nasdaq Total Return Index and the common stocks of the KBW Regional Banks Total Return Index. The KBW Regional Banks Total Return Index is a proprietary stock index of Keefe, Bruyette & Woods, Inc., that tracks the returns of approximately 50 regional banking companies throughout the United States.

img50714284_0.jpg

Table of Contents

Equity Compensation Plan Information

The following table provides information as of December 31, 2025 with respect to shares of common stock that may be issued under the Company’s equity compensation plans.

Number of Securities to<br>be Issued Upon Exercise<br>of Outstanding Options,<br>Warrants and Rights Weighted-Average Exercise<br>Price of Outstanding<br>Options, Warrants<br>and Rights Number of Securities<br>Remaining Available for<br>Future Issuance Under<br>Equity Compensation Plans<br>(Excluding Securities<br>Reflected in Column (a))
Plan Category (a) (b) (c)
Equity compensation plans approved by<br>   security holders 1,635,004 (1) $ N/A 2,218,891
Equity compensation plans not approved by<br>   security holders
Total 1,635,004 2,218,891
  • Includes 46,026 shares potentially issuable upon the vesting of outstanding restricted share units and 41,968 shares potentially issuable upon the vesting of outstanding performance share units that represent awards deferred into the Company’s Nonqualified Deferred Compensation Plan. Also includes 444,690 performance share awards. Performance share awards and units are stated in amounts that would be issuable if the highest level of performance conditions are met.

Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

The Company had in place a stock buyback program approved by the Board of Directors whereby the Company was authorized to repurchase up to 4,306,200 shares of its common stock through the program’s expiration date of December 31, 2026. The program allowed the Company to repurchase its common shares in the open market, by block purchase, through accelerated share repurchase programs, in privately negotiated transactions, or otherwise, in one or more transactions in accordance with the rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission. The Company was not obligated to purchase any shares under this program and the repurchase authorization could have been terminated or amended by the Board at any time prior to the expiration date. The Company completed this buyback program by repurchasing all of the shares authorized during the year ended December 31, 2025. On December 10, 2025, the Company announced that the Board of Directors approved a new plan with similar terms effective January 1, 2026 and expiring on December 31, 2026.

Common stock repurchase activity during the fourth quarter of 2025 was as follows:

Total Number of<br>Shares of Units<br>Purchased (a) Average Price Paid<br>Per Share (b) Total Number of<br>Shares Purchased as<br>a Part of Publicly<br>Announced Plans<br>or Programs Maximum Number<br>of Shares That May<br>Yet Be Purchased<br>Under Plans or<br>Programs
Oct 1, 2025 - Oct 31, 2025 1,100,081 $ 56.69 1,100,000 1,443,700
Nov 1, 2025 - Nov 30, 2025 1,470,180 $ 58.35 1,443,700
Dec 1, 2025 - Dec 31, 2025 26 $ 65.62
Total 2,570,287 $ 57.64 2,543,700
  • Includes common stock purchased in connection with our share-based payment plans related shares used to cover payroll tax withholding requirements. See Note 19 – Share-Based Payment Arrangements in Part II, Item 8 of this Form 10-K, which includes additional information regarding our share-based incentive plans.
  • Average price paid does not include the one percent excise tax charged on public company net share repurchases.

ITEM 6.

Reserved.

Table of Contents

ITEM 7. MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

The objective of this discussion and analysis is to provide material information relevant to the assessment of the financial condition and results of operations of Hancock Whitney Corporation and its subsidiaries during the year ended December 31, 2025 and selected prior periods, including an evaluation of the amounts and certainty of cash flows from operations and outside sources. This discussion and analysis is intended to highlight and supplement financial and operating data and information presented elsewhere in this report, including the consolidated financial statements and related notes. The discussion contains forward-looking statements, which are subject to risks and uncertainties. Should one or more of these risks or uncertainties materialize, our actual results may differ from those expressed or implied by the forward-looking statements. See Forward-Looking Statements in Part I of this Annual Report.

Non-GAAP Financial Measures

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations include non-GAAP measures used to describe our performance. A reconciliation of those measures to GAAP measures are provided in Table 1 “Consolidated Financial Results” and Table 31 “Quarterly Consolidated Financial Results” of this section. The following is an overview of the non-GAAP measures used and the reasons why management believes they are useful and important in understanding the Company’s financial condition and results of operations included below.

Consistent with the provisions of Subpart 229.1400 of Regulation S-K, “Disclosures by Bank and Savings and Loan Registrants,” we present net interest income, net interest margin and efficiency ratios on a fully taxable equivalent (te) basis. The te basis adjusts for the tax-favored status of interest income from certain loans and investments using the statutory federal tax rate (21% for all periods presented) to increase tax-exempt interest income to a taxable-equivalent basis. This measure is the preferred industry measurement of net interest income and it enhances comparability of net interest income arising from taxable and tax-exempt sources.

We present certain additional non-GAAP financial measures to assist the reader with a better understanding of the Company’s performance period over period, as well as to provide investors with assistance in understanding the success management has experienced in executing its strategic initiatives. The Company highlights certain items that are outside of our principal business and/or are not indicative of forward-looking trends in supplemental disclosure items below our GAAP financial data and presents certain “Adjusted” ratios that exclude these disclosed items. These adjusted ratios provide management and the reader with a measure that may be more indicative of forward-looking trends in our business, as well as demonstrates the effects of significant gains or losses and changes.

We define Adjusted Pre-Provision Net Revenue as net income excluding provision expense and income tax expense, plus the taxable equivalent adjustment (as defined above), less supplemental disclosure items (as defined above). Management believes that adjusted pre-provision net revenue is a useful financial measure because it enables investors and others to assess the Company’s ability to generate capital to cover credit losses through a credit cycle. We define Adjusted Revenue as net interest income (te) and noninterest income less supplemental disclosure items. We define Adjusted Noninterest Expense as noninterest expense less supplemental disclosure items. We define our Efficiency Ratio as noninterest expense to total net interest income (te) and noninterest income, excluding amortization of purchased intangibles and supplemental disclosure items, if applicable. Management believes adjusted revenue, adjusted noninterest expense and the efficiency ratio are useful measures as they provide a greater understanding of ongoing operations and enhance comparability with prior periods.

EXECUTIVE OVERVIEW

The discussions and analyses that follow provide insight into the impact of macroeconomic and industry trends on our performance in the most recent fiscal year, and our outlook for the near term.

Acquisition

On May 2, 2025, we completed the acquisition of Sabal Trust Company (“Sabal”). Based in St. Petersburg, Florida, with three additional locations in the Central Florida region, Sabal was the largest independent, employee-owned non-depository trust company in Florida. The transaction added assets under management and administration of approximately $3 billion to our existing trust and asset management business and provides the opportunity to develop relationships and offer other private banking, wholesale and retail products and services in high-growth markets. For additional information on this transaction, refer to Note 2 – "Acquisition" in the notes to our consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this document.

Table of Contents

Subsequent Event

In January 2026, we executed a restructuring of our available for sale securities portfolio whereby we sold securities with an amortized cost of $1.5 billion and average yield of 2.49% and reinvested the $1.4 billion of proceeds with the purchase of securities with an average yield of 4.35%. We anticipate a 50 month payback period to cover the $98.5 million pre-tax loss associated with the sale, or approximately $0.93 per diluted share after tax, that will be reflected in our first quarter 2026 operating results. The restructure is expected to contribute approximately $23.8 million to net interest income, or $0.23 per diluted share, resulting in increases of 32 basis points (bps) to the securities portfolio yield and 7 bps to net interest margin on an annual basis.

Current Economic Environment

The year ended December 31, 2025 began with notable economic shifts as the new presidential administration swiftly began implementing its second-term agenda. The impacts of tariffs, tax reform, deportations, and deregulation each carried distinct economic and market implications. Tariffs quickly became the most influential factor, creating cost pressures across supply chains. Further, concerns over the pace and scale of tariffs created increased uncertainty as to near and long term effects that led to significant volatility in equity markets in the early part of the year. As policy clarity improved, markets successfully rebounded from the steep descent and remained strong for the duration of the year.

Labor market statistics continued to indicate weakening that stemmed from policy uncertainty, labor force impacts of deportation efforts and the increasing use of artificial intelligence. Job gains decelerated substantially compared to 2024, and the unemployment rate rose to 4.4% in December 2025 compared to 4.1% a year earlier. Despite deterioration in the labor market, consumer spending remained resilient and real gross domestic product (GDP) displayed growth of approximately 2.2% for 2025, rebounding from a net decline in the first quarter. The Federal Reserve held monetary policy steady for most of the year amid the difficult crosswinds. By September, some stabilization in inflation markers and sustained weakening in the labor market led to a 25 basis point interest rate cut. Operational disruptions and negative economic impacts of the 43-day government shutdown that followed shortly thereafter further clouded the economic picture, but the Federal Reserve subsequently issued two additional 25 basis point cuts in the fourth quarter of 2025, with the expectation that the adjusted rates will allow stabilization in the labor market and the resumption of downward trends in inflationary conditions.

A number of headwinds that have burdened the financial services industry in recent years continued to ease, with many institutions benefiting from recent interest rate movement, robust capital markets, deregulation and credit quality stabilization. Within our markets, loan demand gained momentum and deposit cost pressures eased amid the falling interest rate environment, contributing favorably to net interest margin and profitability.

Economic Outlook

We utilize economic forecasts produced by Moody’s Analytics (Moody’s) that provide various scenarios to assist in the development of our economic outlook. This outlook discussion utilizes the December 2025 Moody’s forecast, the most current available at December 31, 2025. The forecasts are anchored on a baseline forecast scenario, which Moody’s defines as the “most likely outcome” of where the economy is headed based on current conditions. Several upside and downside scenarios are produced that are derived from the baseline scenario and incorporate varying degrees of favorable and unfavorable adjustments to economic indicators and circumstances as compared to the baseline. The macroeconomic variables underlying the December 2025 economic scenarios differ in many respects from the comparable forecasts available at December 31, 2024 given the shift in economic circumstances and risks.

The baseline economic scenario acknowledges that economic policy under the current administration is rapidly shifting. Key assumptions within the December 2025 baseline forecast include the following: (1) the effective tariff rate will rise from just over 2% at the start of 2025 to approximately 12% by early 2026 before gradually falling late in the decade; (2) while the unemployment rate is still relatively low at 4.4%, it will continue to rise to a peak of 4.8% in late 2026 before gradually returning to near 4% in 2029; (3) GDP growth will begin to decelerate, displaying modest annual below-trend growth in the coming years of 2.1% in 2026, 1.9% in 2027 and 2.1% in 2028; (4) the 10-year U.S. Treasury yield will remain elevated near its current rate through the end of the decade as a result of elevated inflation and a deteriorating fiscal outlook; and (5) the soft economy and a struggling job market will prompt the Federal Reserve to continue to cut its benchmark rate until it reaches 2.75% in early 2027 before a return to its neutral level of 3% in 2028. The scenario further assumes that, with these rate cuts, the recent acceleration in inflation will prove temporary as it is largely due to a one-time price increase caused by higher tariffs.

The S-2 scenario presents a downside alternative to the baseline. The S-2 scenario assumes the impacts of the current administration's tariffs and deportations on the economy are worse than expected, still-elevated interest rates weaken credit-sensitive spending more than anticipated, and there is longer and farther-reaching disturbance from geopolitical conflict. The effective tariff rate is forecasted to increase to 15% and remain elevated through the end of 2028. Further, the S-2 scenario assumes that the unemployment rate will increase considerably to 6.6% in 2026 (peaking at 7.2% in the fourth quarter) before gradually improving to 4.2% in 2029. As a result of these pressures, the U.S. falls into a mild recession beginning in the first quarter of 2026 that lasts for three quarters, with the stock

Table of Contents

market contracting 22% and a peak-to-trough decline in GDP of 1%. The combination of a recession and rising inflation causes the Federal Reserve to lower its benchmark rate moderately over the course of a few quarters; as the recession persists and inflation subsides, the Federal Reserve subsequently reduces the rate more significantly.

Management has deemed certain assumptions underlying the S-2 scenario to be as likely to occur in the near term than those underlying the baseline scenario, and as such, the baseline scenario and the S-2 scenario were each given probability weightings of 50% in the calculation of our allowance for credit losses calculation at December 31, 2025.

The credit loss outlook for our portfolio as a whole has not changed materially since December 31, 2024. We continue to closely monitor our portfolio for customers that are sensitive to prolonged inflation, the elevated interest rate environment, tariffs, labor market conditions and/or other economic circumstances that may impact credit quality.

Rapidly evolving changes in fiscal and other policies of the current administration have created heightened uncertainty as to the impact on the U.S and global economies. The effects of continued elevated inflation, a softening labor market, and the Federal Reserve’s actions to counter those effects, as well as to respond to other economic concerns, could reduce economic growth in the near term. The full extent of the impact of these and other influential factors are uncertain and may have an adverse effect on the U.S. economy, including the possibility of an economic recession or slower growth in the near or midterm.

Highlights of 2025 Financial Results

Net income for the year ended December 31, 2025 was $486.1 million, or $5.67 per diluted common share, compared to $460.8 million, or $5.28 per diluted common share in 2024. Included in the results of the year ended December 31, 2025 is a charge of $5.9 million (pre-tax), or $0.05 per share after tax, attributable to costs associated with the acquisition of Sabal. Included in the results of the year ended December 31, 2024 is a charge of $3.8 million, or $0.03 per diluted share after-tax, supplemental disclosure item attributable to a revision of the FDIC special assessment. The following is an overview of financial results for the year ended December 31, 2025 compared to December 31, 2024:

  • Net income of $486.1 million, or $5.67 per diluted common share, up from $460.8 million, or $5.28 per diluted share
  • Adjusted pre-provision net revenue, a non-GAAP measure, totaled $679.9 million, up $38.8 million
  • Provision for credit losses of $51.2 million in 2025, compared to $52.2 million in 2024; allowance for credit losses to total loans remains strong at 1.43% at December 31, 2025, down 4 basis points
  • Loans of $24.0 billion, up $659.0 million, or 3%
  • Deposits of $29.3 billion, down $213.1 million, or 1%
  • Tangible common equity ratio of 10.06%, up 59 bps; common equity tier 1 capital ratio of 13.65%, down 49 bps, reflecting the return of capital through our share repurchase program and an increase in shareholder dividends
  • Credit metrics remain relatively stable, with criticized commercial loans down $87.7 million, or 14%, and nonaccrual loans up $9.5 million, or 10%; the net charge-off ratio was 0.22% compared to 0.19%
  • Net interest margin expanded 10 bps to 3.47%
  • Efficiency ratio (a non-GAAP measure) improved to 54.78%, compared to 55.36%

The year ended December 31, 2025 was an outstanding year for our company. Net interest margin expanded ten basis points, adjusted pre-provision net revenue and return on assets grew, efficiency ratio improved, and credit quality remained stable. We deployed capital through the repurchase of 4.3 million shares of our common stock, increasing our quarterly shareholder dividends, and funding both organic and inorganic growth, including the acquisition of Sabal Trust Company on May 2, 2025. The Sabal acquisition expanded our trust and asset management business in Central Florida and provides opportunities to build relationships in that region. We experienced loan growth of 3% across our footprint and in most business segments, driven by increased demand and progress on our multi-year growth plan. We remain committed to continuing to fulfill our organic growth initiatives while maintaining operational efficiency and proactively managing capital to enhance shareholder value.

The table that follows presents our consolidated financial results. Additional information related to our results and outlook are included in the discussions that follow.

Table of Contents

Table 1. Consolidated Financial Results

(in thousands, except per share data) 2025 2024 2023
Income Statement:
Interest income (a) $ 1,614,620 $ 1,692,991 $ 1,620,497
Interest income (te) (b) 1,624,998 1,704,077 1,631,604
Interest expense 505,848 611,070 522,898
Net interest income (te) 1,119,150 1,093,007 1,108,706
Provision for credit losses 51,183 52,167 59,103
Noninterest income 406,447 364,129 288,480
Noninterest expense 851,641 819,910 836,848
Income before income taxes 612,395 573,973 490,128
Income tax expense 126,322 113,158 97,526
Net income $ 486,073 $ 460,815 $ 392,602
Supplemental disclosure items - included above, pre-tax
Included in noninterest income:
Loss on securities portfolio restructure $ $ $ (65,380 )
Gain on sale of parking facility 16,126
Included in noninterest expense:
Sabal Trust Company acquisition expense 5,911
FDIC special assessment 3,800 26,123
Balance Sheet Data:
Period end balance sheet data:
Loans $ 23,958,440 $ 23,299,447 $ 23,921,917
Earning assets 32,218,663 31,857,841 32,175,097
Total assets 35,472,762 35,081,785 35,578,573
Noninterest-bearing deposits 10,374,991 10,597,461 11,030,515
Total deposits 29,279,774 29,492,851 29,690,059
Stockholders' equity 4,460,117 4,127,636 3,803,661
Average balance sheet data:
Loans $ 23,366,808 $ 23,630,743 $ 23,594,579
Earning assets 32,230,774 32,422,554 33,160,791
Total assets 34,717,808 34,912,199 35,633,442
Noninterest-bearing deposits 10,191,859 10,491,504 11,919,234
Total deposits 28,677,400 29,168,855 29,478,481
Stockholders' equity 4,314,183 3,951,871 3,528,911
Common Shares Data:
Earnings per share - basic $ 5.70 $ 5.30 $ 4.51
Earnings per share - diluted 5.67 5.28 4.50
Cash dividends per common share 1.80 1.50 1.20
Book value per share (period end) 54.22 47.93 44.05
Tangible book value per share (period end) 42.16 37.58 33.63
Weighted average number of shares - diluted 85,440 86,648 86,423
Period end number of shares 82,259 86,124 86,345
Performance and other data:
Return on average assets 1.40 % 1.32 % 1.10 %
Return on average common equity 11.27 % 11.66 % 11.13 %
Return on average tangible common equity 14.49 % 15.08 % 14.97 %
Tangible common equity (c) 10.06 % 9.47 % 8.37 %
Tier 1 common equity 13.65 % 14.14 % 12.33 %
Net interest margin (te) 3.47 % 3.37 % 3.34 %
Noninterest income as a percentage of total revenue (te) 26.64 % 24.99 % 20.65 %
Efficiency ratio (d) 54.78 % 55.36 % 55.25 %
Allowance for loan loss as a percentage of total loans 1.28 % 1.37 % 1.29 %
Allowance for credit loss as a percentage of total loans 1.43 % 1.47 % 1.41 %
Annualized net charge-offs to average loans 0.22 % 0.19 % 0.27 %
Nonaccrual assets as a percentage of loans, ORE and foreclosed assets 0.51 % 0.54 % 0.26 %
Full time equivalent headcount 3,627 3,476 3,591

Table of Contents

($ in thousands) 2025 2024 2023
Reconciliation of pre-provision net revenue (te) and adjusted pre-provision net revenue (te) (non-GAAP measures) (e)
Net income (GAAP) $ 486,073 $ 460,815 $ 392,602
Provision for credit losses 51,183 52,167 59,103
Income tax expense 126,322 113,158 97,526
Pre-provision net revenue 663,578 626,140 549,231
Taxable equivalent adjustment 10,378 11,086 11,107
Pre-provision net revenue (te) 673,956 637,226 560,338
Adjustments from supplemental disclosure items
Sabal Trust Company acquisition expense 5,911
Loss on securities portfolio restructure 65,380
Gain on sale of parking facility (16,126 )
FDIC special assessment 3,800 26,123
Adjusted pre-provision net revenue (te) $ 679,867 $ 641,026 $ 635,715
Reconciliation of revenue (te), adjusted revenue (te) and efficiency ratio (non-GAAP measures) (e)
Net interest income $ 1,108,772 $ 1,081,921 $ 1,097,599
Noninterest income 406,447 364,129 288,480
Total GAAP revenue 1,515,219 1,446,050 1,386,079
Taxable equivalent adjustment 10,378 11,086 11,107
Total revenue (te) 1,525,597 1,457,136 1,397,186
Adjustments from supplemental disclosure items
Loss on securities portfolio restructure 65,380
Gain on sale of parking facility (16,126 )
Adjusted revenue $ 1,525,597 $ 1,457,136 $ 1,446,440
GAAP noninterest expense $ 851,641 $ 819,910 $ 836,848
Amortization of intangibles (9,953 ) (9,413 ) (11,556 )
Adjustments from supplemental disclosure items
Sabal Trust Company acquisition expense (5,911 )
FDIC special assessment (3,800 ) (26,123 )
Adjusted noninterest expense $ 835,777 $ 806,697 $ 799,169
Efficiency ratio (d) 54.78 % 55.36 % 55.25 %

(a) Interest income includes the net impact of discount accretion and premium amortization arising from business combinations. Net purchase accounting discount accretion totaled $2.1 million and $2.4 million the years ended December 31, 2024, and 2023. There was no net purchase accounting discount accretion included in interest income in 2025.

(b) For analytical purposes, management adjusts interest income and net interest income for tax-exempt items to a taxable equivalent basis using a federal income tax rate of 21%.

(c) The tangible common equity ratio is common stockholders’ equity less intangible assets divided by total assets less intangible assets.

(d) The efficiency ratio (a non-GAAP measure) is noninterest expense to total net interest (te) and noninterest income, excluding amortization of purchased intangibles and supplemental disclosure items.

(e) See non-GAAP financial measures section of this analysis for a discussion of these measures.

Table of Contents

RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

The following is a discussion of results from operations for the year ended December 31, 2025 compared to the year ended December 31, 2024. Refer to previously filed Annual Reports on Form 10-K Item 7, “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” for discussion of prior year variances.

Net Interest Income

For the year ended December 31, 2025, net interest income was $1.1 billion, up $26.9 million, or 2%, from 2024. Net interest income is the primary component of our earnings and represents the difference, or spread, between revenue generated from interest-earning assets and the interest expense related to funding those assets. For analytical purposes, net interest income is adjusted to a taxable equivalent basis (te) using the statutory federal tax rate of 21% on tax exempt items (primarily interest on municipal securities and loans). Net interest income (te) was $1.1 billion in 2025, up $26.1 million, or 2%, from 2024, comprised of a decrease in interest income (te) of $79.1 million that was more than offset by a decrease of $105.2 million in interest expense. The increase in net interest income (te) was largely interest rate driven, as the decline in prevailing rates on interest-bearing liabilities and an increase in securities yields outpaced lower yields on loans; it is also reflective of the impact of favorable changes in average balance of and mix within interest-bearing liabilities that was partially offset by the impact of a decline in average loans. Net interest margin, the ratio of net interest income (te) to average earning assets, increased 10 bps to 3.47% in 2025 from 3.37% in 2024.

The $79.1 million decrease in interest income (te) was largely attributable to a decrease in both loan yields and average balances, partially offset by increases in securities yields and average balances. The yield on earning assets (te) was down 22 bps to 5.04%, driven primarily by a 34 bp decline in the loan yield that reflects the impact of the new and repricing loans in the current interest rate environment. The yield on investment securities was up 25 bps to 2.88% as new investments and reinvestments were made at higher yields, and also reflecting the favorable impact of certain fair value hedges that became effective in 2025.

The $105.2 million decrease in interest expense was largely driven by the impact of the falling interest rate environment on interest-bearing liabilities, particularly in interest-bearing deposit cost, volume and mix. Compared to the prior year, average interest-bearing deposits were down $191.8 million in 2025, and the mix therein saw a shift from higher-cost time deposits to transaction and savings deposits as instruments matured. Average other short-term borrowings, consisting primarily of FHLB advances, were up $104.4 million in 2025 compared to 2024, largely as a function of funding needs. Our total cost of funds decreased 31 bps to 1.57% in 2025, largely driven by a 54 bp decline in the cost of interest-bearing deposits.

Though interest rates remain elevated, the Federal Reserve issued a series of cuts to its benchmark rate between September 2024 and December 2025 totaling 175 bps. Our loan and interest-bearing deposits betas for the current down rate cycle were 34% and 48%, respectively, contributing to expansion in our net interest margin.

Discussions of Asset/Liability Management and Net Interest Income at Risk later in this item provide additional information regarding our management of interest rate risk and the potential impact from changes in interest rates, respectively.

Table of Contents

TABLE 2. Summary of Average Balances, Interest and Rates (te) (a)

Years Ended December 31,
2025 2024 2023
($ in millions) Average <br>Balance Interest<br>(d) Rate Average <br>Balance Interest<br>(d) Rate Average <br>Balance Interest<br>(d) Rate
Assets
Interest-Earnings Assets:
Commercial & real estate loans (te) (a) $ 17,998.9 $ 1,093.4 6.07 % $ 18,263.7 $ 1,179.0 6.46 % $ 18,556.2 $ 1,131.8 6.10 %
Residential mortgage loans 4,031.5 160.9 3.99 3,982.1 152.8 3.84 3,541.2 128.3 3.62
Consumer loans 1,336.4 109.3 8.18 1,384.9 121.5 8.78 1,497.2 124.0 8.28
Loan fees & late charges (1.6 ) 5.5 1.3
Loans (te) (b) 23,366.8 1,362.0 5.83 23,630.7 1,458.8 6.17 23,594.6 1,385.4 5.87
Loans held for sale 25.5 1.7 6.49 22.0 1.6 7.44 26.0 1.7 6.63
Investment securities:
U.S. Treasury and government<br>   agency securities 631.0 20.0 3.17 549.9 15.8 2.87 567.2 15.3 2.70
Mortgage-backed securities and<br>   collateralized mortgage obligations 6,942.4 197.7 2.85 6,805.2 175.0 2.57 7,423.9 170.4 2.30
Municipals (te) 755.0 22.4 2.97 843.4 25.0 2.96 887.0 26.5 2.98
Other securities 17.7 0.6 3.73 23.5 0.9 3.77 23.5 0.8 3.51
Total investment securities (te) (c) 8,346.1 240.7 2.88 8,222.0 216.7 2.63 8,901.6 213.0 2.39
Short-term investments 492.4 20.6 4.18 547.8 27.0 4.93 638.6 31.5 4.93
Total earning assets (te) 32,230.8 1,625.0 5.04 % 32,422.5 1,704.1 5.26 % 33,160.8 1,631.6 4.92 %
Nonearning assets:
Other assets 2,806.9 2,805.4 2,783.5
Allowance for loan losses (319.9 ) (315.7 ) (310.9 )
Total assets $ 34,717.8 $ 34,912.2 $ 35,633.4
Liabilities and Stockholders' Equity
Interest-bearing Liabilities:
Interest-bearing transaction and<br>   savings deposits $ 11,533.4 $ 240.0 2.08 % $ 10,891.8 $ 248.2 2.28 % $ 10,598.6 $ 176.9 1.67 %
Time deposits 3,985.9 143.0 3.59 4,846.9 223.3 4.61 3,989.1 166.5 4.17
Public funds 2,966.2 87.3 2.94 2,938.7 102.9 3.50 2,971.6 100.5 3.38
Total interest-bearing deposits 18,485.5 470.3 2.54 18,677.4 574.4 3.08 17,559.3 443.9 2.53
Repurchase agreements 613.7 8.4 1.36 639.9 10.6 1.65 513.3 7.0 1.36
Other short-term borrowings 355.9 15.3 4.31 251.5 13.8 5.49 1,180.1 59.7 5.06
Long-term debt 211.4 11.8 5.59 234.2 12.3 5.23 239.1 12.3 5.15
Total interest-bearing liabilities 19,666.5 505.8 2.57 % 19,803.0 611.1 3.09 % 19,491.8 522.9 2.68 %
Noninterest-bearing:
Noninterest-bearing deposits 10,191.9 10,491.5 11,919.2
Other liabilities 545.2 665.8 693.5
Stockholders' equity 4,314.2 3,951.9 3,528.9
Total liabilities and stockholders' equity $ 34,717.8 $ 34,912.2 $ 35,633.4
Net interest income (te) and margin $ 1,119.2 3.47 $ 1,093.0 3.37 $ 1,108.7 3.34
Net earning assets and spread $ 12,564.3 2.47 $ 12,619.5 2.17 $ 13,669.0 2.24
Interest cost of funding earning assets 1.57 % 1.88 % 1.58 %
  • Taxable equivalent (te) amounts are calculated using federal income tax rate of 21%.
  • Includes nonaccrual loans.
  • Average securities do not include unrealized holding gains or losses on available for sale securities.
  • Included in interest income is net purchase accounting accretion of $2.1 million and $2.4 million for the years ended December 31, 2024, and 2023, respectively. There was no purchase accounting accretion in 2025.

Table of Contents

TABLE 3. Summary of Changes in Net Interest Income (te) (a) (b)

2025 Compared to 2024 2024 Compared to 2023
Due to Total Due to Total
Change in Increase Change in Increase
($ in thousands) Volume Rate (Decrease) Volume Rate (Decrease)
Interest Income (te)
Commercial & real estate loans (te) (a) $ (16,854 ) $ (68,739 ) $ (85,593 ) $ (18,062 ) $ 65,233 $ 47,171
Residential mortgage loans 1,913 6,128 8,041 16,613 7,917 24,530
Consumer loans (3,494 ) (8,777 ) (12,271 ) (8,059 ) 5,572 (2,487 )
Loan fees & late charges (6,986 ) (6,986 ) 4,146 4,146
Loans (te) (c) (18,435 ) (78,374 ) (96,809 ) (9,508 ) 82,868 73,360
Loans held for sale 237 (224 ) 13 (280 ) 197 (83 )
Investment securities:
U.S. Treasury and government agency securities 2,707 1,505 4,212 (350 ) 828 478
Mortgage-backed securities and collateralized mortgage obligations 3,649 19,109 22,758 (14,862 ) 19,443 4,581
Municipals (2,622 ) 33 (2,589 ) (1,292 ) (158 ) (1,450 )
Other securities (217 ) (10 ) (227 ) (1 ) 62 61
Total investment in securities (te) (d) 3,517 20,637 24,154 (16,505 ) 20,175 3,670
Short-term investments (2,561 ) (3,875 ) (6,436 ) (4,476 ) 2 (4,474 )
Total earning assets (te) (17,242 ) (61,836 ) (79,078 ) (30,769 ) 103,242 72,473
Interest-bearing deposits:
Interest-bearing transaction and savings deposits 14,087 (22,221 ) (8,134 ) 5,020 66,306 71,326
Time deposits (35,709 ) (44,625 ) (80,334 ) 38,313 18,531 56,844
Public funds 952 (16,576 ) (15,624 ) (1,122 ) 3,469 2,347
Total interest-bearing deposits (20,670 ) (83,422 ) (104,092 ) 42,211 88,306 130,517
Repurchase agreements (419 ) (1,806 ) (2,225 ) 1,915 1,701 3,616
Other short-term borrowings 4,909 (3,369 ) 1,540 (50,496 ) 4,595 (45,901 )
Long-term debt (1,240 ) 795 (445 ) (257 ) 197 (60 )
Total interest expense (17,420 ) (87,802 ) (105,222 ) (6,627 ) 94,799 88,172
Net interest income (te) variance $ 178 $ 25,966 $ 26,144 $ (24,142 ) $ 8,443 $ (15,699 )
  • Taxable equivalent (te) amounts are calculated using a federal income tax rate of 21%.
  • Amounts shown as due to changes in either volume or rate includes an allocation of the amount that reflects the interaction of volume and rate changes. This allocation is based on the absolute dollar amounts of change due solely to changes in volume or rate.
  • Includes nonaccrual loans.
  • Average securities do not include unrealized holding gains or losses on available for sale securities.

Provision for Credit Losses

During the year ended December 31, 2025, we recorded a provision for credit losses of $51.2 million, compared to $52.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2024. The provision for credit losses recorded in 2025 included net charge-offs of $52.5 million and a $1.3 million reserve release. The provision for credit losses recorded in 2024 included net charge-offs of $46.0 million and a reserve build of $6.1 million. The modest reserve release in 2025 reflects our relatively consistent economic outlook and stable credit metrics.

Net charge-offs for the year ended December 31, 2025 totaled $52.5 million, or 0.22% of average loans outstanding, comprised of net charge-offs of $39.4 million in the commercial portfolio, $0.1 million in the residential mortgage portfolio and $13.0 million in the consumer portfolio. Net charge-offs for the year ended December 31, 2024 totaled $46.0 million, or 0.19% of average loans outstanding, comprised of net charge-offs of $31.3 million in the commercial portfolio and $14.9 million in the consumer portfolio, partially offset by net recoveries of $0.2 million in the residential mortgage portfolio. The increase in net charge-offs compared to the prior year was due to lower recoveries of $16.0 million compared to $27.1 million in 2024. Gross charge-offs for 2025 were down $4.6 million, at $68.5 million compared to $73.1 million in 2024.

Item 7. “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Balance Sheet Analysis—Allowance for Credit Losses” provides additional information on changes in the allowance for credit losses and general credit quality.

Table of Contents

Noninterest Income

Noninterest income for the year ended December 31, 2025 totaled $406.4 million, a $42.3 million, or 12%, increase from 2024. The increase in noninterest income from the year ended December 31, 2024 is attributable in part to the Sabal acquisition, as well as growth in most revenue lines, partially offset by declines in gains on sales of assets and other miscellaneous income. Noninterest income variances are discussed in more detail below.

Table 4 presents, for each of the three years ended December 31, 2025, 2024 and 2023, the components of noninterest income, along with the percentage changes between years. Table 5 presents supplemental disclosure items included in noninterest income (Table 4) by component for the same periods.

TABLE 4. Noninterest Income

($ in thousands) 2025 % Change 2024 % Change 2023
Service charges on deposit accounts $ 99,180 9 % $ 91,105 6 % $ 86,020
Trust fees 89,630 25 71,734 6 67,565
Bank card and ATM fees 86,135 1 85,491 3 82,966
Investment and annuity fees and insurance commissions 49,162 13 43,424 18 36,714
Secondary mortgage market operations 14,769 19 12,374 35 9,159
Securities transactions, net (11 ) n/m (100 ) (65,380 )
Income from bank-owned life insurance 21,348 26 16,944 10 15,454
Credit-related fees 11,273 (6 ) 12,036 (4 ) 12,557
Income (loss) from derivatives 5,819 254 (3,790 ) n/m 420
Net gains on sales of premises, equipment and other assets 6,119 (22 ) 7,820 (60 ) 19,388
Other miscellaneous income 23,023 (15 ) 26,991 14 23,617
Total noninterest income $ 406,447 12 % $ 364,129 26 % $ 288,480

n/m – not meaningful

TABLE 5. Supplemental Disclosure Items Included in Noninterest Income

( in thousands)
Securities transactions:
Loss on securities portfolio restructure (65,380 )
Other miscellaneous income:
Gain on sale of parking facility 16,126
Total supplemental disclosure items in noninterest income (49,254 )

All values are in US Dollars.

Service charges on deposit accounts include consumer, business, and corporate deposit account servicing fees, as well as nonsufficient funds fees on non-consumer accounts, overdraft and overdraft protection fees, and other customer transaction-related fees. Service charges on deposit accounts were $99.2 million, up $8.1 million, or 9%, from 2024. The increase from 2024 was largely attributable to increases of $4.1 million in consumer overdraft fees and service charges, and $4.3 million in analysis fees and overdraft fees on business accounts.

Trust fee income represents revenue generated from asset management services provided to individuals, businesses and institutions. Trust fees totaled $89.6 million, up $17.9 million, or 25%, from 2024. The increase reflects $14.5 million in personal trust fees as a result of the Sabal acquisition and growth in our legacy personal and corporate trust fees, partially offset by a decline in employee benefits trust revenue. Trust assets under management increased to $14.0 billion at December 31, 2025, inclusive of $2.7 billion attributable to the Sabal transaction, compared to $10.2 billion at December 31, 2024.

Bank card and ATM fees include income from credit and debit card transactions, fees earned from processing card transactions for merchants, and fees earned from ATM transactions. Bank card and ATM fees totaled $86.1 million, up $0.6 million, or 1%, with increases in purchasing card and debit card processing fees largely offset by declines in business credit card processing fees and ATM fees.

Investment and annuity fees and insurance commissions, which include both fees earned from sales of annuity and insurance products as well as managed account fees, totaled $49.2 million, a $5.7 million, or 13%, increase from 2024, largely attributable to increases of $2.0 million in investment management fees and $1.9 million in fixed income trading fees and also reflects increases in annuity fees, corporate underwriting fees and insurance commissions.

Table of Contents

Income from secondary mortgage market operations is comprised of income produced from the origination and sales of residential mortgage loans in the secondary market. We offer a full range of mortgage products to our customers and typically sell longer-term fixed rate loans, while retaining the majority of adjustable-rate loans and mortgage loans generated through programs to support customer relationships. Income from secondary mortgage market operations totaled $14.8 million, an increase of $2.4 million, or 19%, from 2024. The increase was attributable to higher mortgage loans production compared to the prior year. Secondary mortgage market operations income will vary based on application volume and the percentage of loans closed and ultimately sold.

Losses on sales of securities totaled less than $0.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2025. There were no gains or losses on sales of securities during the year ended December 31, 2024.

Income from bank-owned life insurance (BOLI) is generated through insurance benefit proceeds as well as the growth of the cash surrender value of insurance contracts held. BOLI income totaled $21.3 million in 2025, an increase of $4.4 million, or 26%, from 2024. The increase was attributable to an increase in income from changes in cash surrender value of $3.0 million and an increase in mortality gains of $1.4 million.

Credit-related fees include fees assessed on letters of credit and unused portions of loan commitments. Credit-related fees were $11.3 million in 2025, down $0.8 million, or 6%, from 2024, driven primarily by a decrease in unused commitment fees. Income from these products will vary based on letters of credit issued, credit line utilization and prevailing assessment rates.

Income from derivatives, largely resulting from our customer interest rate derivative program, totaled $5.8 million in 2025, compared to a loss of $3.8 million in 2024. The year-over-year increase was due largely to higher income of $6.5 million associated with our customer interest rate derivative program, driven mostly by favorable market conditions. In addition, losses resulting from assumption changes to the Visa Class B derivative liability was down $2.5 million. The remaining year-over-year increase is largely attributable to the lower holding costs related to derivative collateral. Derivative income or loss can be volatile and is dependent upon the composition of the portfolio, volume and mix of sales activity and market value adjustments due to market interest rate movement.

Net gains on sales of premises, equipment and other assets consists primarily of net revenue earned from sales of excess bank owned facilities and equipment no longer in use, gains on sales of Small Business Administration and other non-residential mortgage loans, and leases and other assets associated with the equipment finance line of business. Net gains on sales of premises, equipment and other assets totaled $6.1 million in 2025, compared to $7.8 million in 2024, down $1.7 million, as the comparative period included a $1.5 million gain on the sale of a former branch property.

Other miscellaneous income is comprised of various items, including dividends on FHLB stock, income from small business investment companies (SBICs), and syndication fees, among others. Other miscellaneous income for the year ended December 31, 2025 was $23.0 million, down $4.0 million, or 15%, from 2024, driven primarily by a decrease of $6.6 million in dividends on FHLB stock, reflecting a decline in the level of stock owned and the yield, partially offset by an increase of $2.9 million in syndication fees.

Noninterest Expense

Noninterest expense for the year ended December 31, 2025 totaled $851.6 million, a $31.7 million, or 4%, increase from the year ended December 31, 2024. Included in noninterest expense for year ended December 31, 2025 were supplemental disclosure items totaling $5.9 million attributable to costs associated with the acquisition of Sabal. Included in noninterest expense for the year ended December 31, 2024 is a supplemental disclosure item of $3.8 million attributable to an adjustment to the special assessment by the FDIC in connection with the protection of uninsured depositors under the systemic risk exception. Excluding the supplemental disclosure items for both periods, noninterest expense totaled $845.7 million, up $29.6 million, or 4%, from 2024. Noninterest expense variances are discussed in more detail below.

Table 6 presents, for each of the three years ended December 31, 2025, 2024 and 2023, noninterest expense, along with the percentage changes between years. Table 7 presents supplemental disclosure items included in noninterest expense (Table 6) by component for the same periods.

Table of Contents

TABLE 6. Noninterest Expense

($ in thousands) 2025 % Change 2024 % Change 2023
Compensation expense $ 385,660 1 % $ 380,591 1 % $ 376,055
Employee benefits 89,731 1 88,786 5 84,740
Personnel expense 475,391 1 469,377 2 460,795
Net occupancy expense 55,871 4 53,650 4 51,573
Equipment expense 17,020 (2 ) 17,432 (8 ) 18,852
Data processing expense 127,227 4 121,880 4 117,694
Professional services expense 57,080 36 41,935 9 38,331
Amortization of intangibles 9,953 6 9,413 (19 ) 11,556
Deposit insurance and regulatory fees 17,992 (26 ) 24,209 (52 ) 49,979
Other real estate and foreclosed assets expense (income) 3,091 (225 ) (2,469 ) 296 (624 )
Corporate value and franchise taxes 17,272 (9 ) 19,002 (7 ) 20,355
Advertising 14,261 7 13,298 (1 ) 13,454
Telecommunication and postage 10,134 6 9,519 (12 ) 10,773
Entertainment and contributions 12,900 9 11,849 11 10,664
Tax credit investment amortization 4,258 (32 ) 6,250 8 5,791
Travel expenses 7,115 19 5,965 9 5,469
Printing and supplies 3,981 1 3,939 (3 ) 4,073
Other retirement expense (16,172 ) (11 ) (18,112 ) 35 (13,460 )
Other miscellaneous expense 34,267 5 32,773 4 31,573
Total noninterest expense $ 851,641 4 % $ 819,910 (2 ) % $ 836,848

n/m - not meaningful

TABLE 7. Supplemental Disclosure Items Included in Noninterest Expense

($ in thousands) 2025 2024 2023
Sabal Trust Company acquisition expense:
Personnel expense $ 1,422 $ $
Data processing expense 1,976
Professional services expense 1,550
Printing and supplies 210
Other 753
$ 5,911 $ $
FDIC deposit insurance special assessment:
Deposit insurance and regulatory fees $ $ 3,800 $ 26,123
Total supplemental disclosure items included in noninterest expense $ 5,911 $ 3,800 $ 26,123

Personnel expense consists of salaries, incentive compensation, long-term incentives, payroll taxes, and other employee benefits such as 401(k), pension, and medical, life and disability insurance. Personnel expense totaled $475.4 million in 2025, up $6.0 million, or 1% from 2024. The year ended December 31, 2025 included $1.4 million of Sabal acquisition costs highlighted as supplemental disclosure items. Excluding these acquisition costs, personnel expense was up $4.6 million, or 1%. The increase was driven largely by increases in salary, bonus and stock-based compensation expenses, reflecting merit increases and higher headcount, as well as an increase in associate acquisition expenses. These increases were partially offset by a favorable impact from salary deferrals associated with lending activities, and decreases in commissions, incentives expense and retirement and health benefits expense. Personnel expense associated with ongoing Sabal operations contributed $5.9 million to the variance compared to the prior year.

Occupancy and equipment expenses are primarily composed of lease expenses, depreciation, maintenance and repairs, rent, taxes, and other equipment expenses. Occupancy and equipment expenses totaled $72.9 million in 2025, up $1.8 million, or 3%, from 2024, largely driven by building and equipment maintenance and leased facility expense that were partially offset by decreases in depreciation and amortization and building insurance costs.

Data processing expense includes expenses related to third party technology processing and servicing costs, technology project costs and fees associated with bank card and ATM transactions. Data processing expense totaled $127.2 million in 2025, up $5.3 million, or 4%, from 2024. Included in the year ended December 31, 2025 was $2.0 million of Sabal acquisition costs highlighted as

Table of Contents

supplemental disclosure items. Excluding these acquisition costs, data processing expense was up $3.4 million, or 3%. The increase was largely attributable to increases in certain technology processing, licensing and maintenance totaling $5.1 million, increases in activity-based fees, including card processing, credit card rewards expense and ATM servicing totaling $2.7 million, partially offset by a decrease in amortization and maintenance on data processing software of $4.4 million. Data processing expense can vary from period to period, depending on business needs and technology enhancement initiatives.

Professional services expense includes accounting and audit, legal, consulting and certain outsourced service expense. Professional services expense totaled $57.1 million in 2025, up $15.1 million, or 36%, from 2024. Included in the year ended December 31, 2025 was $1.5 million of Sabal acquisition costs highlighted as supplemental disclosure items. Excluding these acquisition costs, professional services expense was up $13.6 million, or 32%, largely attributable to costs associated with consulting and other professional services for stand-alone engagements, including process improvement projects, and to legal fees and expense for certain outsourced initiatives. Professional services expense may vary from period to period, generally related to the timing of external service needs.

Amortization of intangibles totaled $10.0 million in 2025, up $0.5 million, or 6%, from 2024 as a result of amortization of intangible assets acquired in the Sabal transaction.

Deposit insurance and regulatory fees totaled $18.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2025, down $6.2 million, or 26%, from 2024. Included in the year ended December 31, 2024 is the supplemental disclosure item of $3.8 million described above attributable to a special assessment made by the FDIC. Excluding the supplemental disclosure item, deposit insurance and regulatory fees were down $2.4 million, or 12%, from 2024, mostly reflective of changes in our risk-based assessment calculation as well as less significant quarterly adjustments to the special assessment based on quarterly updates from the FDIC.

The FDIC special assessment expense recorded to date is management's estimate of our portion of the cost attributable to the systemic risk exception based on information from the FDIC. However, the loss estimates resulting from the failures of Silicon Valley Bank and Signature Bank may be subject to further change pending the projected and actual outcome of loss share agreements, joint ventures, and outstanding litigation. The exact amount of losses incurred will not be determined until the FDIC terminates the receiverships of these banks; therefore, the exact exposure to the Company remains unknown.

Net loss on other real estate and foreclosed assets totaled $3.1 million in 2025, compared to a net gain of $2.5 million in 2024. The level of net income or losses associated with holding and maintaining the other real estate owned portfolio can vary depending on sales activity, valuation adjustments and income or expense associated with operating and maintaining foreclosed property. Gains or losses on the sale of other real estate and foreclosed assets may occur periodically and are dependent on the number and type of assets for sale and current market conditions.

Corporate value, franchise taxes, and other non-income taxes totaled $17.3 million in 2025, down $1.7 million, or 9%, from 2024, largely driven by decreases in both bank share tax and franchise tax. Bank share tax, the largest component of this line item, is based on multiple variables, including average quarterly assets, earnings and stockholders’ equity to determine the taxable assessment value.

Business development-related expenses (including advertising, travel, entertainment and contributions) totaled $34.3 million in 2025, up $3.2 million, or 10%, from 2024, largely driven by increases in digital media advertising, sponsorships, travel expense and charitable contributions.

Other retirement expense includes costs associated with pension and other post-retirement plan expense. Noninterest expense in each of the years ended December 31, 2025 and 2024 was reduced by a net credit in other retirement expense totaling $16.2 million and $18.1 million, respectively. The decrease in the net credit in 2025 was largely driven by changes in actuarial assumptions for the current plan year.

All other expenses totaled $52.6 million in 2025, relatively flat compared to 2024. Included in the year ended December 31, 2025 was approximately $1.0 million of Sabal acquisition costs highlighted as supplemental disclosure items. Excluding these acquisition costs, other expenses were down $0.8 million, or 2%.

Income Taxes

We recorded income tax expense at an effective rate of 20.6% in 2025, compared to 19.7% in 2024. The comparability of the effective tax rate between 2025 and 2024 is affected by higher pre-tax book income in 2025 that decreased the relative impact of net tax benefits related to tax credit investments, tax-exempt interest income and bank-owned life insurance. Our effective tax rate has historically varied from the federal statutory rate primarily due to tax-exempt income and tax credits. Interest income on bonds issued

Table of Contents

by or loans to state and municipal governments and authorities, and earnings from the bank-owned life insurance contract program are the major components of tax-exempt income.

Table 8 reconciles reported income tax expense to that computed at the statutory tax rate of 21% for the years ended December 31, 2025, 2024 and 2023.

TABLE 8. Income Taxes

($ in thousands) 2025 2024 2023
Taxes computed at statutory rate $ 128,603 $ 120,534 $ 102,927
Tax credits:
QZAB/QSCB (785 ) (908 ) (1,114 )
NMTC - Federal and State (5,058 ) (7,521 ) (7,177 )
LIHTC and other tax credits (4,754 ) (4,751 ) (4,884 )
LIHTC amortization 3,741 3,727 3,732
Total tax credits (6,856 ) (9,453 ) (9,443 )
State income taxes, net of federal income tax benefit 13,819 12,640 10,323
Tax-exempt interest (7,773 ) (8,443 ) (8,755 )
Life insurance contracts (5,882 ) (6,017 ) (4,020 )
Employee share-based compensation (1,556 ) (1,514 ) (505 )
FDIC assessment disallowance 2,385 2,466 2,893
Impact of deferred tax asset re-measurement (435 )
Other, net 3,582 3,380 4,106
Income tax expense $ 126,322 $ 113,158 $ 97,526

The main source of tax credits has been investments in tax-advantage securities and tax credit projects. These investments are made primarily in the markets we serve and directed at tax credits issued under the Federal and State New Market Tax Credit (NMTC), Low-Income Housing Tax Credit (LIHTC) and pre-2018 Qualified Zone Academy Bonds (QZAB) and Qualified School Construction Bonds (QSCB) programs. The investments generate tax credits which reduce current and future taxes and are recognized when earned as a benefit in the provision for income taxes. Additionally, the amortization of the LIHTC investment cost will be recognized as a component of income tax expense in proportion to the tax credits recognized over the 10-year credit period of each project.

We have invested in NMTC projects through investments in our own CDEs, as well as other unrelated CDEs. Federal tax credits from NMTC investments are recognized over a seven-year period, while recognition of the benefits from state tax credits varies from three to five years.

Based only on tax credit investments that have been made through 2025, we expect to realize benefits from federal and state tax credits over the next three years totaling $8.2 million, $8.0 million and $5.5 million for 2026, 2027 and 2028, respectively. We intend to continue making investments in tax credit projects. However, our ability to access new credits will depend upon, among other factors, federal and state tax policies and the level of competition for such credits.

At December 31, 2025, we had a net deferred tax asset of $55.8 million, which is comprised of $218.9 million in deferred tax assets (net of valuation allowance), offset by $163.1 million of deferred tax liabilities. Several factors are considered in determining the recoverability of the deferred tax asset components, such as the history of taxable earnings, reversal of taxable temporary differences, future taxable income and tax planning strategies. Based on our review of these factors, we have established a $3.7 million valuation allowance for state net operating losses and $2.3 million valuation allowance for deferred executive compensation.

BALANCE SHEET ANALYSIS

Short-Term Investments

Short-term liquidity assets are held to ensure funds are available to meet the cash flow needs of both borrowers and depositors. At December 31, 2025, short-term liquidity investments, including interest-bearing bank deposits and federal funds sold, totaled $132.3 million, a decrease of $807.4 million from December 31, 2024. Average short-term investments for 2025 totaled $492.4 million, down $55.4 million from $547.8 million in 2024. Typically, these balances will change on a daily basis depending upon movement in customer loan and deposit accounts.

Table of Contents

Investment Securities

The purpose of the securities portfolio is to increase profitability, mitigate interest rate risk, provide liquidity and comply with regulatory pledging requirements. Our securities portfolio includes securities categorized as available for sale and held to maturity. Available for sale securities are carried at fair value and may be sold prior to maturity. Unrealized gains or losses on available for sale securities, net of deferred taxes, are recorded as accumulated other comprehensive income or loss in stockholders' equity.

Our investment in securities totaled $8.1 billion at December 31, 2025, up $497.6 million from December 31, 2024. The investment securities portfolio is managed by ALCO to assist in the management of interest rate risk and liquidity while providing an acceptable rate of return. At December 31, 2025, the amortized cost of securities available for sale totaled $6.3 billion and securities held to maturity totaled $2.1 billion, compared to $5.8 billion and $2.4 billion, respectively, at December 31, 2024. The year over year changes in each of the portfolios is largely reflective of maturities and paydowns from both portfolios reinvested in the available for sale portfolio.

Our securities portfolio consists mainly of residential and commercial mortgage-backed securities that are issued or guaranteed by U.S. government agencies. We invest only in high quality investment grade securities and manage the investment portfolio duration generally between two and five and a half years. At December 31, 2025, the average expected maturity of the portfolio was 5.58 years with an effective duration of 3.89 years and a nominal weighted-average yield of 2.87%. Under an immediate, parallel rate shock of 100 bp and 200 bp increases, the effective duration would be 3.95 years and 3.94 years, respectively. At December 31, 2024, the average expected maturity of the portfolio was 5.58 years with an effective duration of 4.12 years and a nominal weighted-average yield of 2.66%. The change in expected maturity, effective duration, and nominal weighted-average yield is primarily attributable to both portfolio reinvestment activity and growth in 2025.

We have in place fair value hedges on certain fixed-rate commercial mortgage-backed securities. As of December 31, 2025, we had approximately $397.5 million in notional amount of forward-starting fixed payer swaps that convert the latter portion of the term of these available for sale securities to a floating rate. These derivative instruments are designated as fair value hedges of interest rate risk. This strategy provides a fixed-rate coupon during the front-end unhedged tenor of the bonds and results in a floating-rate security during the back-end hedged tenor. During the year ended December 31, 2025, $248.5 million of fair value hedges became effective, with the net earnings recorded in interest income. Once effective, fair value hedges synthetically convert the notional amount of the hedged asset over the life of the hedge to a variable rate instrument that is indexed to the federal funds effective rate.

At the end of each reporting period, we evaluate the securities portfolio for credit loss. Based on our assessments, expected credit loss was negligible for all reporting periods in 2025 and 2024, and therefore no allowance for credit loss was recorded.

There were no investments in securities of a single issuer, other than U.S. Treasury and U.S. government agency securities and mortgage-backed securities issued or guaranteed by U.S. government agencies that exceeded 10% of stockholders’ equity. We do not invest in subprime or “Alt A” home mortgage-backed securities. Investments classified as available for sale are carried at fair value, while held to maturity securities are carried at amortized cost. Unrealized holding gains (losses) on available for sale securities are excluded from net income and are recognized, net of tax, in other comprehensive income and in accumulated other comprehensive income, a separate component of stockholders’ equity.

Table of Contents

The following table presents the amortized cost of debt securities by type at December 31, 2025 and 2024.

TABLE 9. Debt Securities by Type

($ in thousands) 2025 2024
Available for sale securities
U.S. Treasury and government agency securities $ 266,825 $ 185,827
Municipal obligations 191,754 200,272
Residential mortgage-backed securities 2,620,980 2,482,109
Commercial mortgage-backed securities 3,217,663 2,849,372
Collateralized mortgage obligations 27,100 37,553
Corporate debt securities 17,000 19,000
Total Available for sale Securities $ 6,341,322 $ 5,774,133
Held to maturity securities
U.S. Treasury and government agency securities $ 373,605 $ 394,689
Municipal obligations 511,516 623,907
Residential mortgage-backed securities 497,338 573,057
Commercial mortgage-backed securities 731,329 818,604
Collateralized mortgage obligations 19,094 25,406
Total Held to maturity securities $ 2,132,882 $ 2,435,663

The amortized cost, fair value and yield of debt securities at December 31, 2025, by final contractual maturity, are presented in the following table. Securities are classified according to their final contractual maturities without consideration of scheduled and unscheduled principal amortization, potential prepayments or call options. Accordingly, actual maturities will differ from their reported contractual maturities. The expected average maturity years presented in the table includes scheduled principal payments and assumptions for prepayments. The yield calculation does not include adjustments to amortized cost of available for sale securities for active fair value hedges.

TABLE 10. Debt Securities Maturities by Type

($ in thousands) One Year<br>or Less Over One<br>Year<br>Through<br>Five Years Over Five<br>Years<br>Through<br>Ten Years Over<br>Ten<br>Years Total Fair<br>Value Weighted<br>Average<br>Yield (te) Expected<br>Average<br>Maturity<br>Years
Available for sale
U.S. Treasury and government<br>   agency securities $ 30,137 $ 20,189 $ $ 216,499 $ 266,825 $ 269,332 4.76 % 7.0
Municipal obligations 78,265 113,312 177 191,754 191,328 3.44 % 0.6
Residential mortgage-backed<br>   securities 1,465 22,602 108,549 2,488,364 2,620,980 2,375,629 2.89 % 6.3
Commercial mortgage-backed<br>   securities 394 1,643,313 1,573,956 3,217,663 3,083,325 3.01 % 5.2
Collateralized mortgage obligations 18,565 8,535 27,100 25,946 1.92 % 2.1
Other debt securities 2,000 15,000 17,000 16,357 4.11 % 1.7
Total debt securities $ 31,996 $ 1,766,369 $ 1,829,382 $ 2,713,575 $ 6,341,322 $ 5,961,917 3.04 % 5.6
Fair Value $ 32,084 $ 1,711,795 $ 1,743,201 $ 2,474,837 $ 5,961,917
Weighted-Average Yield (te) 3.92 % 3.11 % 2.92 % 3.07 % 3.04 %
Held to maturity
U.S. Treasury and government<br>   agency securities $ $ 134,662 $ $ 238,943 $ 373,605 $ 343,710 2.33 % 5.1
Municipal obligations 56,954 130,331 323,543 688 511,516 500,769 3.27 % 1.7
Residential mortgage-backed<br>   securities 20,052 477,286 497,338 463,099 2.32 % 4.9
Commercial mortgage-backed<br>   securities 84,170 401,321 119,713 126,125 731,329 684,874 2.49 % 4.6
Collateralized mortgage obligations 12,288 6,806 19,094 18,574 2.62 % 2.0
Total debt securities $ 141,124 $ 666,314 $ 475,596 $ 849,848 $ 2,132,882 $ 2,011,026 2.61 % 4.1
Fair Value $ 140,203 $ 648,904 $ 452,476 $ 769,443 $ 2,011,026
Weighted-Average Yield (te) 2.78 % 2.58 % 2.90 % 2.44 % 2.61 %

Table of Contents

In January 2026, we executed a restructuring of our available for sale securities portfolio whereby we sold securities with an amortized cost of $1.5 billion and average yield of 2.49% and reinvested the $1.4 billion of proceeds with the purchase of securities with an average yield of 4.35%. Management deemed the restructure an effective way of utilizing capital to enhance future net interest income. For further information on the restructure, refer to the “Subsequent Event” section that appears earlier in this analysis.

Loan Portfolio

Total loans at December 31, 2025 were $24.0 billion, up $659.0 million, or 3%, from December 31, 2024. The increase is reflective of increased loan demand, including strong net production in owner occupied and investor commercial real estate and equipment finance loans.

Our commercial customer base is diversified over a range of industries. We lend mainly to middle-market and smaller commercial entities, although we do participate in larger shared-credit loan facilities generally with businesses/sponsors operating in our market areas that are well known to the relationship officers. The funded balance of our shared national credits portfolio at December 31, 2025 totaled approximately $2.0 billion, or 9% of total loans, compared to $2.3 billion, or 10% of total loans at December 31, 2024. At December 31, 2025, our largest industry concentrations in shared national credit include approximately $324.4 million in real estate, rental and leasing, $303.6 million in finance and insurance, $234.6 million in manufacturing, and $234.4 million in information, with the remaining of the balance in other diverse industries.

The following table shows the composition of our loan portfolio at December 31, 2025 and 2024.

TABLE 11. Loans Outstanding by Type

($ in thousands) 2025 2024
Commercial non-real estate $ 9,809,011 $ 9,876,592
Commercial real estate - owner occupied 3,270,080 3,011,955
Total commercial & industrial 13,079,091 12,888,547
Commercial real estate - income producing 4,283,168 3,798,612
Construction and land development 1,239,086 1,281,115
Residential mortgages 4,016,917 3,961,328
Consumer 1,340,178 1,369,845
Total loans $ 23,958,440 $ 23,299,447

The commercial and industrial (“C&I”) loan portfolio includes both commercial non-real estate and commercial real estate – owner occupied loans. C&I loans totaled $13.1 billion, or 55% of the total loan portfolio at December 31, 2025, an increase of $190.5 million, or 1%, from December 31, 2024. The year over year growth in this portfolio reflects increased demand with strong production in the owner occupied commercial real estate and equipment finance loans, and is net of a $255.7 million decrease in shared national credits. The decrease in shared national credits is the result of a strategic decision to reduce exposure in that portfolio as we focus on originating more granular loans in our markets with more opportunities for a full-service relationship.

Our C&I loan portfolio is well diversified by product, client, and geography throughout our footprint. Nevertheless, we may be exposed to certain concentrations of credit risk which exist in relation to different borrowers or groups of borrowers, specific types of collateral and industries.

The following table provides detail of the more significant industry concentrations for our C&I loan portfolio, which is based on NAICS codes for all industries, with the exception of energy, which is based on the borrower’s source of revenue (i.e. manufacturer whose income is derived from energy-related business is reported as energy).

Table of Contents

TABLE 12. Commercial & Industrial Loans by Industry Concentration

2025 2024
Pct of Pct of
($ in thousands) Balance Total Balance Total
Retail trade $ 1,419,299 11 % $ 1,283,203 10 %
Health care and social assistance 1,306,170 10 1,447,349 11
Real estate and rental and leasing 1,234,527 9 1,189,727 9
Manufacturing 1,226,962 9 1,191,781 9
Construction 1,122,921 9 989,313 8
Wholesale trade 1,081,854 8 1,148,034 9
Transportation and warehousing 945,011 7 965,893 7
Professional, scientific, and technical services 852,169 7 756,573 6
Accommodation, food services and entertainment 818,599 6 772,721 6
Finance and insurance 646,171 5 683,401 5
Information 465,971 4 410,284 3
Other services (except public administration) 415,429 3 414,514 3
Public administration 348,545 3 402,872 3
Admin, support, waste management, remediation services 338,693 3 326,385 3
Educational services 236,273 2 240,096 2
Energy 169,700 1 197,317 2
Other 450,797 3 469,084 4
Total commercial & industrial loans $ 13,079,091 100 % $ 12,888,547 100 %

Commercial real estate – income producing loans totaled $4.3 billion at December 31, 2025, up $484.6 million, or 13%, from December 31, 2024, reflective of robust demand in this space. Construction and land development loans totaled approximately $1.2 billion at December 31, 2025, down $42.0 million, or 3%, from December 31, 2024. The decrease reflects loans converting to permanent financing outpacing the funding of new and existing loans.

The following table details the end of period aggregated commercial real estate – income producing and construction loan balances by property type. Loans reflected in 1-4 Family Residential Construction include both loans to construction builders as well as single-family borrowers.

TABLE 13. Commercial Real Estate– Income Producing and Construction by Property Type Concentration

2025 2024
Pct of Pct of
($ in thousands) Balance Total Balance Total
Multifamily $ 1,438,509 26 % $ 1,343,544 26 %
Retail 907,611 16 773,621 15
Healthcare related properties 812,712 15 658,067 13
Industrial 739,009 14 698,520 14
Office 506,581 9 506,690 10
Hotel, motel and restaurants 430,007 8 424,866 8
1-4 family residential construction 213,733 4 235,745 5
Other land loans 181,170 3 192,919 4
Other 292,922 5 245,755 5
Total commercial real estate - income producing and construction loans $ 5,522,254 100 % $ 5,079,727 100 %

Residential mortgages totaled $4.0 billion at December 31, 2025, up $55.6 million, or 1%, from December 31, 2024. Consumer loans totaled $1.3 billion at December 31, 2025, down $29.7 million, or 2%, compared to December 31, 2024. Approximately $14.3 million of the decline in consumer loans is in the indirect automobile lending portfolio, a business that we exited and the existing portfolio in runoff.

Table of Contents

The following table shows average loans by category, the effective taxable equivalent yield and the percentage of total loans for each of the preceding three years.

TABLE 14. Average Loans

2025 2024 2023
Yield Pct of Yield Pct of Yield Pct of
($ in thousands) Balance (te) Total Balance (te) Total Balance (te) Total
Commercial & real estate loans $ 17,998,935 6.07 % 77 % $ 18,263,676 6.46 % 77 % $ 18,556,175 6.10 % 79 %
Residential mortgages 4,031,508 3.99 % 17 % 3,982,122 3.84 % 17 % 3,541,245 3.62 % 15 %
Consumer 1,336,365 8.18 % 6 % 1,384,945 8.78 % 6 % 1,497,159 8.28 % 6 %
Total loans $ 23,366,808 5.83 % 100 % $ 23,630,743 6.17 % 100 % $ 23,594,579 5.87 % 100 %

The following table sets forth the contractual maturity by portfolio segment at December 31, 2025.

TABLE 15. Loan Maturities by Type

December 31, 2025 Maturity Range
($ in thousands) Within<br>One Year After One<br>Through<br>Five Years After Five<br>Through<br>Fifteen Years After Fifteen <br>Years Total
Commercial non-real estate $ 2,596,984 $ 5,578,548 $ 1,532,309 $ 101,170 $ 9,809,011
Commercial real estate - owner occupied 250,970 1,403,331 1,568,857 46,922 3,270,080
Total commercial & industrial 2,847,954 6,981,879 3,101,166 148,092 13,079,091
Commercial real estate - income producing 1,118,934 2,556,562 594,017 13,655 4,283,168
Construction and land development 340,689 652,001 197,136 49,260 1,239,086
Residential mortgages 34,786 32,592 319,267 3,630,272 4,016,917
Consumer 78,592 293,152 79,094 889,340 1,340,178
Total loans $ 4,420,955 $ 10,516,186 $ 4,290,680 $ 4,730,619 $ 23,958,440

The sensitivity to interest rate changes for the portion of our loan portfolio that matures after one year is shown below.

TABLE 16. Loan Sensitivity to Changes in Interest Rates for Loans that Mature After One Year

December 31, 2025
($ in thousands) Fixed Rate Floating Rate Total
Commercial non-real estate $ 3,245,331 $ 3,966,696 $ 7,212,027
Commercial real estate - owner occupied 2,019,057 1,000,053 3,019,110
Total commercial & industrial 5,264,388 4,966,749 10,231,137
Commercial real estate - income producing 1,070,486 2,093,748 3,164,234
Construction and land development 295,102 603,295 898,397
Residential mortgages 2,349,482 1,632,649 3,982,131
Consumer 112,596 1,148,990 1,261,586
Total loans $ 9,092,054 $ 10,445,431 $ 19,537,485

Table of Contents

Asset Quality

The following table sets forth, for the periods indicated, nonaccrual loans and reportable loans modified or restructured loans, by type, and foreclosed and surplus ORE and other foreclosed assets. Loans past due 90 days or more and still accruing are also disclosed.

TABLE 17. Nonaccrual loans, loans modified or restructured, and ORE and foreclosed assets

December 31,
($ in thousands) 2025 2024
Loans accounted for on a nonaccrual basis:
Commercial non-real estate $ 29,678 $ 14,172
Commercial non-real estate - modified 4,847 19,246
Total commercial non-real estate 34,525 33,418
Commercial real estate - owner occupied 6,482 2,727
Commercial real estate - owner-occupied - modified 241
Total commercial real estate - owner-occupied 6,723 2,727
Commercial real estate - income producing 4,760 356
Commercial real estate - income producing - modified
Total commercial real estate - income producing 4,760 356
Construction and land development 3,173 5,561
Construction and land development - modified
Total construction and land development 3,173 5,561
Residential mortgage 46,399 43,157
Residential mortgage - modified 587 929
Total residential mortgage 46,986 44,086
Consumer 10,555 11,187
Consumer - modified 148
Total consumer 10,703 11,187
Total nonaccrual loans $ 106,870 $ 97,335
ORE and foreclosed assets 14,788 27,797
Total nonaccrual loans and ORE and foreclosed assets $ 121,658 $ 125,132
Modified loans - still accruing:
Commercial non-real estate $ 98,468 $ 74,211
Commercial real estate - owner occupied 28,698
Commercial real estate - income producing 14,914 2,741
Construction and land development 147
Residential mortgage 14,572 2,241
Consumer 227 131
Total modified loans - still accruing $ 157,026 $ 79,324
Total reportable modified loans $ 162,849 $ 99,499
Loans 90 days past due still accruing $ 28,798 $ 21,852
Ratios:
Nonaccrual loans to total loans 0.45 % 0.42 %
Nonaccrual loans plus ORE and foreclosed assets to loans plus ORE<br> and foreclosed assets 0.51 % 0.54 %
Allowance for loan losses to nonaccrual loans 287.95 % 327.61 %
Allowance for loan losses to nonaccrual loans and accruing loans 90 days past due 226.83 % 267.55 %
Loans 90 days past due still accruing to loans 0.12 % 0.09 %

Nonaccrual loans plus ORE and foreclosed assets totaled $121.7 million at December 31, 2025, down $3.5 million from December 31, 2024. Nonaccrual loans totaled $106.9 million, up $9.5 million from December 31, 2024. Nonaccrual loans as a percentage of the loan portfolio increased to 0.45% in 2025, compared to 0.42% in 2024. ORE and foreclosed assets were $14.8 million at December 31, 2025, down $13.0 million from December 31, 2024, largely attributable the sale of a foreclosed property from one commercial borrower.

Reportable modified loans to borrowers experiencing financial difficulty totaled $162.8 million at December 31, 2025 and includes $5.8 million of nonaccrual loans. Modified loans to borrowers experiencing financial difficulty totaled $99.5 million at December 31, 2024 and included $20.2 million of nonaccrual loans. These reportable modifications are granted as a part of our loss mitigation

Table of Contents

strategy to maximize expected payments. The increase in reportable modified loans reflects the continued stress on certain borrowers resulting from prolonged elevated interest rates, inflation, insurance costs, and other market conditions.

Criticized commercial loans totaled $535.4 million at December 31, 2025, down $87.6 million, or 14%, from $623.0 million at December 31, 2024. Criticized loans are defined as those having potential or well-defined weaknesses that deserve management’s close attention (risk-rated special mention, substandard and doubtful), including both accruing and nonaccruing loans. Criticized commercial loans comprised 2.88% of that portfolio at December 31, 2025, down from 3.47% at December 31, 2024. We remain focused on identifying specific and broader risk indicators that may be impacting certain segments in our portfolio, and we have not seen signs of significant weakening in any particular industry, sector or geographic segment beyond what we believe has been experienced by the banking industry as a whole. Our criticized commercial loans at December 31, 2025 are spread across many industries, with the largest concentrations as follows: $96.4 million real estate, rental and leasing, $67.5 million in hospitality, $63.9 million in transportation and warehousing, $62.9 million healthcare and social assistance, $57.4 million in retail trade, $54.4 million in construction and $51.1 million in wholesale trade. Commercial loans risk rated pass-watch totaled $614.8 million at December 31, 2025, compared to $521.4 million at December 31, 2024. The pass-watch risk rating includes credits with negative performance trends that reflect sufficient risk to cause concern, but have not risen to the level of criticized.

Allowance for Credit Losses

At December 31, 2025, the allowance for credit losses was $341.7 million, comprised of $307.8 million in allowance for loan losses and $33.9 million in the reserve for unfunded lending commitments. The allowance for credit losses decreased $1.3 million from $342.9 million at December 31, 2024, which was comprised of $318.9 million in allowance for loan losses and $24.1 million in the reserve for unfunded lending commitments. The $11.2 million decrease in the funded allowance was largely due to a reduction in reserves on commercial real estate – income producing loans, a portfolio where credit metrics have been improving. The $9.9 million increase in the reserve for unfunded lending commitments was largely volume driven.

Our allowance for credit losses coverage to total loans decreased to 1.43% at December 31, 2025, compared to 1.47% at December 31, 2024. The allowance for credit losses on the commercial portfolio totaled $272.0 million, or 1.46% of that portfolio, at December 31, 2025, down from $272.5 million, or 1.52%, at December 31, 2024. The allowance for credit losses on the residential mortgage portfolio totaled $42.8 million, or 1.07% of that portfolio, at December 31, 2025, relatively flat compared to $42.4 million, or 1.07%, at December 31, 2024. The allowance for credit losses on the consumer portfolio totaled $26.8 million, or 2.00% of that portfolio, at December 31, 2025, down from $28.0 million, or 2.04%, at December 31, 2024.

The $1.3 million net decrease in the allowance for credit losses from December 31, 2024 includes a decrease of $2.2 million in individually evaluated reserves (generally used for nonperforming loans), partially offset by an increase of $0.9 million in collectively evaluated reserves. We utilized the December 2025 Moody’s economic scenarios to inform our allowance for credit losses at December 31, 2025. After considering the variables underlying each of the Moody’s economic scenarios, management probability-weighted the baseline scenario at 50% and the downside S-2 mild recessionary scenario at 50% in the estimation of the allowance for credit losses at December 31, 2025, compared to probability weighting of the baseline scenario at 40% and the downside S-2 mild recessionary scenario at 60% in the estimation of the allowance for credit losses at December 31, 2024. The change in probability weightings from those used at December 31, 2024, does not indicate a significant shift in our overall credit loss outlook, but rather reflects a shift in the assumptions underlying the forecasts. Each of the scenarios considered have varying degrees of severity and duration of impacts to forecasted market conditions, economic indicators, monetary and other governmental policies and geopolitical conditions, among other variables. Refer to the Economic Outlook section of this discussion and analysis for further information on the Moody’s scenarios and our weighting assumptions.

Table of Contents

The following table sets forth activity in the allowance for loan losses for the periods indicated.

TABLE 18. Summary of Activity in the Allowance for Credit Losses

December 31,
($ in thousands) 2025 2024 2023
Provision and Allowance for Credit Losses
Allowance for Loan Losses:
Allowance for loan losses at beginning of period $ 318,882 $ 307,907 $ 307,789
Loans charged-off:
Commercial non real estate 45,564 45,488 59,830
Commercial real estate - owner occupied 4,626 143
Total commercial & industrial 50,190 45,631 59,830
Commercial real estate - income producing 34 8,822 73
Construction and land development 1,314 264 72
Total Commercial 51,538 54,717 59,975
Residential mortgages 922 380 55
Consumer 16,006 17,987 15,393
Total charge-offs 68,466 73,084 75,423
Recoveries of loans previously charged-off:
Commercial non real estate 11,332 22,292 6,152
Commercial real estate - owner occupied 686 1,036 957
Total commercial & industrial 12,018 23,328 7,109
Commercial real estate - income producing 49 7 14
Construction and land development 123 64 11
Total commercial 12,190 23,399 7,134
Residential mortgages 841 595 1,278
Consumer 2,976 3,057 3,611
Total recoveries 16,007 27,051 12,023
Total net charge-offs 52,459 46,033 63,400
Provision for loan losses 41,308 57,008 63,518
Allowance for loan losses at end of period $ 307,731 $ 318,882 $ 307,907
Reserve for Unfunded Lending Commitments:
Reserve for unfunded lending commitments at beginning of period 24,053 28,894 33,309
Provision for losses on unfunded lending commitments 9,875 (4,841 ) (4,415 )
Reserve for unfunded lending commitments at end of period $ 33,928 $ 24,053 $ 28,894
Total Allowance for Credit Losses $ 341,659 $ 342,935 $ 336,801
Total Provision for Credit Losses $ 51,183 $ 52,167 $ 59,103
Coverage ratios:
Allowance for loan losses to period end loans 1.28 % 1.37 % 1.29 %
Allowance for credit loss to period end loans 1.43 % 1.47 % 1.41 %
Charge-offs ratios
Gross charge-offs to average loans 0.29 % 0.31 % 0.32 %
Recoveries to average loans 0.07 % 0.11 % 0.05 %
Net charge-offs to average loans 0.22 % 0.19 % 0.27 %
Net Charge-offs to average loans by portfolio:
Commercial non real estate 0.35 % 0.24 % 0.54 %
Commercial real estate - owner occupied 0.13 % (0.03 )% (0.03 )%
Total commercial & industrial 0.30 % 0.17 % 0.40 %
Commercial real estate - income producing (0.00 )% 0.22 % 0.00 %
Construction and land development 0.10 % 0.01 % 0.00 %
Total Commercial 0.22 % 0.17 % 0.28 %
Residential mortgages 0.00 % (0.01 )% (0.03 )%
Consumer 0.98 % 1.08 % 0.79 %

Table of Contents

An allocation of the loan loss allowance by major loan category is set forth in the following table for the periods indicated.

TABLE 19. Allocation of Allowance for Loan Losses by Category

December 31,
2025 2024
($ in thousands) Allowance for<br> Loan Losses % of Total<br>Allowance Allowance for<br> Loan Losses % of Total<br>Allowance
Commercial non-real estate $ 121,439 40 % $ 121,090 38 %
Commercial real estate - owner occupied 40,695 13 36,264 11
Total commercial & industrial 162,134 53 157,354 49
Commercial real estate - income producing 60,475 19 71,975 23
Construction and land development 17,450 6 21,158 7
Residential mortgages 42,834 14 42,445 13
Consumer 24,838 8 25,950 8
Total $ 307,731 100 % $ 318,882 100 %

Deposits

Deposits provide the most significant source of funding for our interest earning assets. Generally, our ability to compete for market share depends on our deposit pricing and our wide range of products and services that are focused on customer needs, among other factors. We offer high-quality banking services with convenient delivery channels, including online and mobile banking. We provide specialized services to our commercial customers to promote commercial deposit growth. These services include treasury management, industry expertise and lockbox services.

Lack of diversity in concentration within a deposit base may increase the risk of events or trends that could prompt a larger-scale demand for deposits outflow. Concerns over a financial institution’s ability to protect deposit balances in excess of the federally insured limit may increase the risk of a deposit run. We consider our deposit base to be seasoned, stable and well-diversified. We also offer our customers an insured cash sweep product (ICS) that allows customers to secure deposits above FDIC insured limits. The ICS product totaled $322.2 million at December 31, 2025, compared to $359.7 million at December 31, 2024. At December 31, 2025, we have calculated our average deposit account size by dividing period-end deposits by the population of accounts with balances to be approximately $37,700, which includes $197,700 in our commercial and small business lines (excluding public funds), $122,900 in our wealth management business line, and $18,100 in our consumer business line.

Further, at December 31, 2025, our sources of liquidity exceed uninsured deposits. We have estimated the Bank’s amount of uninsured deposits using the methodologies and assumptions required for FDIC regulatory reporting to be approximately $14.8 billion at December 31, 2025, compared to $14.6 billion at December 31, 2024. Our uninsured deposit total at December 31, 2025 includes approximately $3.6 billion of public funds that have pledged securities as collateral, leaving approximately $11.3 billion of noncollateralized, uninsured deposits compared to total liquidity of $18.9 billion. Our ratio of noncollateralized, uninsured deposits to total deposits was approximately 38.6% at December 31, 2025, compared to 37.3% at December 31, 2024.

Total deposits were $29.3 billion at December 31, 2025, down $213.1 million, or 1%, from December 31, 2024. Deposit levels and composition in 2025 were influenced in part by the falling interest rate environment. Average deposits for the year ended December 31, 2025 were $28.7 billion, down $491.5 million, or 2%, from 2024.

Table of Contents

The following table shows the composition of our deposits at December 31, 2025 and 2024 is as follows:

TABLE 20. Deposits

December 31,
($ in thousands) 2025 2024
Noninterest-bearing deposits $ 10,374,991 $ 10,597,461
Interest-bearing retail transaction and savings deposits 11,998,892 11,327,725
Interest-bearing public fund deposits:
Public fund transaction and savings deposits 3,120,389 3,127,427
Public fund time deposits 96,925 85,072
Total interest-bearing public fund deposits 3,217,314 3,212,499
Retail time deposits 3,688,577 4,348,265
Brokered time deposits 6,901
Total interest-bearing deposits 18,904,783 18,895,390
Total deposits $ 29,279,774 $ 29,492,851

At December 31, 2025, noninterest-bearing demand deposits totaled $10.4 billion, down $222.5 million, or 2%, from December 31, 2024. Noninterest-bearing demand deposits comprised 35% of total deposits at December 31, 2025 and 36% at December 31, 2024.

Interest-bearing transaction and savings accounts totaled $12.0 billion at December 31, 2025, up $671.2 million, or 6%, from December 31, 2024. Retail time deposits totaled $3.7 billion at December 31, 2025, down $659.7 million, or 15%, from December 31, 2024. The shift within the mix of these products is largely reflective of the falling interest rate environment, as time deposits maturing at lower rates prompted some shift to transaction and savings deposits.

Interest-bearing public fund deposits totaled $3.2 billion at December 31, 2025, up $4.8 million, or less than 1%, from December 31, 2024. Seasonal cash inflows from public entities in the fourth quarter of each year typically results in higher balances than at other times during the year with subsequent reductions in the first quarter of the following year. There were no brokered deposits at December 31, 2025, compared to $6.9 million at December 31, 2024.

Table 21 sets forth average balances and weighted-average rates paid on deposits for each year in the three-year period ended December 31, 2025, as well as the percentage of total deposits for each category. Table 22 sets forth the maturities of time certificates of deposit greater than $250,000 at December 31, 2025.

TABLE 21. Average Deposits

2025 2024 2023
($ in millions) Balance Rate Mix Balance Rate Mix Balance Rate Mix
Interest-bearing deposits:
Interest-bearing transaction deposits $ 2,901.4 1.36 % 10.1 % $ 2,686.1 1.55 % 9.2 % $ 2,429.5 0.93 % 8.2 %
Money market deposits 6,510.5 2.83 % 22.7 % 6,136.1 3.25 % 21.0 % 5,762.9 2.67 % 19.6 %
Savings deposits 2,139.2 0.77 % 7.5 % 2,082.8 0.34 % 7.1 % 2,424.9 0.02 % 8.2 %
Time deposits 3,968.2 3.60 % 13.8 % 4,833.7 4.62 % 16.6 % 3,970.4 4.17 % 13.5 %
Public Funds 2,966.2 2.94 % 10.3 % 2,938.7 3.50 % 10.1 % 2,971.6 3.38 % 10.1 %
Total interest-bearing deposits 18,485.5 2.54 % 64.4 % 18,677.4 3.08 % 64.0 % 17,559.3 2.53 % 59.6 %
Noninterest bearing demand deposits 10,191.9 35.6 % 10,491.5 36.0 % 11,919.2 40.4 %
Total deposits $ 28,677.4 100.0 % $ 29,168.9 100.0 % $ 29,478.5 100.0 %

TABLE 22. Maturity of Time Deposit greater than or equal to $250,000*

December 31,
($ in thousands) 2025
Three months $ 726,225
Over three months through six months 500,612
Over six months through one year 231,533
Over one year 9,686
Total $ 1,468,056

* Includes public fund time deposits

Table of Contents

Short-Term Borrowings

Short-term borrowings totaled $1.0 billion at December 31, 2025, up $378.3 million, or 59%, from December 31, 2024. Average short-term borrowings for the year ended December 31, 2025 totaled $969.6 million, up $78.1 million, or 9%, from 2024. Short-term borrowings are a core portion of the Company’s funding strategy, the balance of which can fluctuate depending on our funding needs and the sources utilized.

Table 23 sets forth balances of short-term borrowings for each of the past three years. Short-term borrowings consist of federal funds purchased, securities sold under agreements to repurchase and borrowings from the FHLB. Customer repurchase agreements are a source of customer funding. These agreements are offered mainly to commercial customers to assist them with their ongoing cash management strategies or to provide a temporary investment vehicle for their excess liquidity pending redeployment for corporate or investment purposes. While customer repurchase agreements provide a recurring source of funds to the Bank, the amounts available over time will vary.

TABLE 23. Short-Term Borrowings

($ in thousands) 2025 2024 2023
Federal funds purchased:
Amount outstanding at period end $ 70,400 $ 300 $ 350
Average amount outstanding during period 16,879 12,935 7,525
Maximum amount at any month end during period 110,300 200,275 100,350
Weighted-average interest rate at period end 3.74 % 3.90 % 4.90 %
Weighted-average interest rate during period 4.84 % 5.61 % 5.70 %
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase:
Amount outstanding at period end $ 546,892 $ 638,715 $ 454,479
Average amount outstanding during period 613,630 639,912 513,306
Maximum amount at any month end during period 734,288 792,589 625,773
Weighted-average interest rate at period end 1.18 % 0.95 % 1.16 %
Weighted-average interest rate during period 1.36 % 1.65 % 1.36 %
FHLB borrowings:
Amount outstanding at period end $ 400,000 $ $ 700,000
Average amount outstanding during period 339,044 238,593 1,172,603
Maximum amount at any month end during period 1,275,000 650,000 3,100,000
Weighted-average interest rate at period end 3.62 % 5.58 %
Weighted-average interest rate during period 4.28 % 5.48 % 5.05 %

Long-Term Debt

Long-term debt totaled $199.4 million at December 31, 2025, down $11.1 million from December 31, 2024, due to tax credit fund activity.

Long-term debt at December 31, 2025 includes subordinated notes payable with an aggregate principal amount of $172.5 million, a fixed rate of 6.25% per annum and a stated maturity of June 15, 2060. Subject to prior approval by the Federal Reserve, the Company may redeem the notes in whole or in part on any interest payment date. This debt qualifies as tier 2 capital in the calculation of certain regulatory capital ratios.

Table of Contents

LOAN COMMITMENTS AND LETTERS OF CREDIT

In the normal course of business, the Bank enters into financial instruments, such as commitments to extend credit and letters of credit, to meet the financing needs of its customers. Such instruments are not reflected in the accompanying consolidated financial statements until they are funded, although they expose the Bank to varying degrees of credit risk and interest rate risk in much the same way as funded loans.

Commitments to extend credit totaled $9.7 billion at December 31, 2025 and include revolving commercial credit lines, non-revolving loan commitments issued mainly to finance the acquisition and development of construction of real property or equipment, and credit card and personal credit lines. The availability of funds under commercial credit lines and loan commitments generally depends on whether the borrower continues to meet credit standards established in the underlying contract, which may include the maintenance of sufficient collateral coverage levels, payment and financial performance, and compliance with other contractual conditions. Loan commitments generally have fixed expiration dates or other termination clauses and may require payment of a fee by the borrower. Credit card and personal credit lines are generally subject to adjustment or cancellation if the borrower’s credit quality deteriorates. A number of commercial and personal credit lines are used only partially or, in some cases, not at all before they expire, and the total commitment amounts do not necessarily represent our future cash requirements.

Letters of credit totaled $409.0 million at December 31, 2025. A substantial majority of the letters of credit are standby agreements that obligate the Bank to fulfill a customer’s financial commitments to a third party if the customer is unable to perform. The Bank issues standby letters of credit primarily to provide credit enhancement to customers’ other commercial or public financing arrangements and to help them demonstrate financial capacity to vendors of essential goods and services.

The contract amounts of these instruments reflect our exposure to credit risk. The Bank undertakes the same credit evaluation in making loan commitments and assuming conditional obligations as it does for on-balance sheet instruments and may require collateral or other credit support. At December 31, 2025, the Company had a reserve for unfunded lending commitments of $33.9 million.

The following table shows the commitments to extend credit and letters of credit at December 31, 2025 and 2024 according to expiration date.

TABLE 24. Loan Commitments and Letters of Credit

Expiration Date
($ in thousands) Total Less Than <br>1 Year 1-3<br>Years 3-5<br>Years More Than<br>5 Years
December 31, 2025
Commitments to extend credit $ 9,650,197 $ 4,184,857 $ 2,449,822 $ 2,250,883 $ 764,635
Letters of credit 409,010 337,198 67,238 4,574
Total $ 10,059,207 $ 4,522,055 $ 2,517,060 $ 2,255,457 $ 764,635
Expiration Date
--- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- ---
( in thousands) Less Than <br>1 Year 1-3<br>Years 3-5<br>Years More Than<br>5 Years
December 31, 2024
Commitments to extend credit 9,249,468 $ 3,894,217 $ 2,344,538 $ 2,236,744 $ 773,969
Letters of credit 420,614 1,134 387,121 32,359
Total 9,670,082 $ 3,895,351 $ 2,731,659 $ 2,269,103 $ 773,969

All values are in US Dollars.

ENTERPRISE RISK MANAGEMENT

We proactively manage risks to capture opportunities and maximize shareholder value. We balance revenue generation and profitability with the inherent risks of our business activities. Enterprise risk management helps protect shareholder value by assessing, monitoring, and managing the risks associated with our businesses. Strong risk management practices enhance decision-making, facilitate successful implementation of new initiatives, and where appropriate, support undertaking greater levels of well-managed risk to drive growth and achieve strategic objectives. Our risk management culture integrates a board-approved risk appetite with senior management direction and governance to facilitate the execution of the Company’s strategic plan. This integration ensures the daily management of risks by product types and continuous corporate monitoring of the levels of risk across the Company. We make changes to our enterprise risk management program and risk governance framework as described here at the direction of senior management and the Board of Directors to capture opportunities and to respond to changes in strategic, business, and operational environments.

Table of Contents

Risk Categories and Definitions

Consistent with other participants in the financial services industry, the primary risk exposures of the Company are credit, market, liquidity, operational, legal, reputational, and strategic. We have adopted the six risk categories as outlined by the Federal Reserve Board and other bank regulators to govern the risk management of banks and bank holding companies. Oversight responsibility for our categories is assigned within our risk committee governance structure:

  • Credit risk arises from the potential that a borrower or counterparty will fail to perform on an obligation.
  • Market risk is a financial institution’s condition resulting from adverse movements in market rates or prices, such as interest rates, foreign exchange rates, or equity prices.
  • Liquidity risk is the potential that an institution will be unable to meet its obligations as they come due because of an inability to liquidate assets or obtain adequate funding (referred to as “funding liquidity risk”) or that it cannot easily unwind or offset specific exposures without significantly lowering market prices because of inadequate market depth or market disruptions ("market liquidity risk").
  • Operational risk is the potential that inadequate information systems, operational problems, breaches in internal controls, breaches in customer data, fraud, or unforeseen catastrophes will result in unexpected losses. Consistently and interchangeably for the Company, Basel II defines this risk as the risk of loss resulting from inadequate or failed internal processes, people and systems, or from external events. The Company assesses compliance risk, the risk to current or anticipated earnings or capital arising from violations of laws, rules or regulations, or from non-conformance with prescribed practices, internal policies and procedures or ethical standards, as a subcategory of operational risk.
  • Legal risk is the potential that unenforceable contracts, lawsuits, or adverse judgments can disrupt or otherwise negatively affect the operations or condition of a banking organization.
  • Strategic risk is the risk to current or anticipated earnings, capital, or franchise or enterprise value arising from adverse business decisions, poor implementation of business decisions, or lack of responsiveness to changes in the competitive landscape of banking and financial services industries and operating environment.

While no longer part of the Federal Reserve Board examination program, the Company also considers reputational risk. Reputational risk is the potential that negative publicity regarding an institution’s business practices, whether true or not, will cause a decline in the customer base, costly litigation, or revenue reductions. The Company also recognizes its reputation with shareholders and associates is an important factor of reputational risk.

Risk Committee Governance Structure

Effective risk management governance requires active oversight, participation, and interaction by senior management and the Board of Directors. Our enterprise risk management framework uses a tiered risk/reward committee structure to facilitate the timely discussion of significant risks, issues and risk mitigation strategies to inform management and the Board’s decision making. Additionally, the committee structure provides ongoing oversight and facilitates escalation within assigned risk committees. Following is a summary of our risk governance structure and related responsibilities:

  • Board risk committees. The Company’s Board of Directors has established a Board Risk Committee and Credit Risk Management Subcommittee of the Board Risk Committee to oversee the effective establishment of a risk governance framework, provide for an independent Credit Review assurance function, ensure the overall corporate risk profile is within its risk appetite, and direct changes or make recommendations to the Board of Directors when deemed necessary. Additionally, the Board of Directors has established an Audit Committee to provide independent oversight on the effectiveness of these matters and the Company’s internal control and regulatory environment. The Board Risk Committee is chaired by an independent director. The Board has designated Ms. Joanie Teofilo, Ms. Sonia Pérez and Mr. Moses Feagin, independent directors who serve on the Board Risk Committee, as risk management experts. Other committees of the Board of Directors oversee certain risks that overlap with the Board Risk Committee’s enterprise risk management oversight, including the Compensation Committee, which evaluates and manages any risk posed by compensation and benefits programs and oversees human capital efforts, and the Corporate Governance and Nominating Committee, which provides oversight on a broad range of issues surrounding the composition and operation of the Board of Directors.
  • Governance committees. The Capital Committee (CAPCO) of the Company serves as the senior level management risk/reward committee and oversees the business strategy, organizational structure, capital planning, and liquidity strategies for the Company. CAPCO directly oversees the strategic and reputation risk categories, which include litigation strategy and the development of capital stress testing within the Company’s risk governance framework. CAPCO drives business strategy development and execution, provides corporate financial oversight, and is responsible for portfolio risk

Table of Contents

  • committee oversight. CAPCO provides oversight of the portfolio risk/reward committees to ensure tactics to address business strategy changes are properly vetted and adopted, and protect the Company’s reputation.
  • Portfolio committees. The Company has three portfolio risk/reward committees focusing on credit (CREDCO), market and liquidity through asset/liability management (ALCO), and operational, legal and compliance (OPCO) risk categories. These committees review and monitor the risk categories in a portfolio context so that risk assessment and management processes are being effectively executed to identify and manage risk, direct changes, and escalate issues to CAPCO and Board Risk Committees when needed. The committees also monitor the risk portfolios for changes to the Company’s risk profile as well as to assess whether the risk portfolio is performing within the board-approved risk appetite. Portfolio committees report to CAPCO. In addition, the Company has established a Corporate Responsibility Council, which includes members of senior management, that develops, monitors and assesses the strategies related to corporate responsibility and sustainability.

Risk Leadership and Organization

The risk management function of the Company is led by our Chief Risk Officer. The Chief Risk Officer, who reports directly to the CEO, provides overall vision, direction and leadership regarding our enterprise risk management program. The Chief Risk Officer exercises independent judgment and reporting of risk through a direct working relationship with the Board Risk Committee, and the Chief Credit Officer has the same role with the Credit Risk Management Subcommittee. The functional areas reporting to the Chief Risk Officer are the enterprise risk management, operational risk management, model risk management, data governance, compliance, credit review (administrative only), corporate insurance, regulatory relations, and financial crimes programs. The Chief Risk Officer also works closely with the Chief Internal Auditor to provide assurance to the Board and senior management regarding risk management controls and their effectiveness. The Chief Internal Auditor reports to the Board’s Audit Committee to assure independence of the internal audit function. Another risk management function reporting to the CEO is the Chief Credit Officer.

Credit Risk

The Bank’s primary lending focus is to provide commercial, consumer, and real estate loans to consumers, to small and middle market businesses, to larger corporate clients in their respective market areas, and to state, county, parish and municipal government entities. Diversification in the loan portfolio is a means to reduce the risks associated with economic fluctuations. The Bank has no significant concentrations of loans to individual borrowers or foreign entities.

Our commercial and industrial portfolio, which includes commercial non-real estate and owner occupied commercial real estate lending is diverse across various industries. We continuously manage our exposure to improve our cross-industry diversification, and proactively manage potential impacts to earnings.

Real estate loan levels are monitored throughout the year, and the bank currently does not have a commercial real estate concentration as defined by interagency guidelines.

Monitoring collateral is also an essential component of managing the Bank’s real estate and non-real estate related credit risk exposure. For real estate-secured loans, third-party valuations are obtained at the time of origination, and updated if it is determined that the collateral value has deteriorated or if the loan is deemed to be a problem loan. Property valuations are ordered through, and reviewed by, the Bank’s appraisal department, which is independent of the loan origination and approval process. When deemed necessary, third-party valuations may also be obtained for non-real estate collateral based on the same criteria as real estate secured loans. Collateral valuations, along with anticipated selling costs, are used to assess the need for an appropriate allowance allocation and/or full or partial charge-off when it is probable that the borrower will be unable to meet payment obligations as they become due.

The Bank maintains a Credit Review function so that developing credit concerns are identified and addressed in a timely manner. Credit Review is managed by our Director of Credit Review who reports to the Credit Risk Management Subcommittee, a subcommittee of the Board Risk Committee. Further, an active watch list review process is in place as part of the Bank’s problem loan management strategy, and a list of loans 90 days past due and still accruing is reviewed with management (including the Chief Credit Officer) at least monthly. Recommendations flow from all of the above activities with the goal of recognizing nonperforming loans and determining the appropriate accrual status.

Asset/Liability Management

Asset/Liability Management consists of quantifying, analyzing, and controlling interest rate risk (IRR) to maintain stability in net interest income under varying interest rate environments. The principal objective of asset/liability management is to maximize net interest income while operating within acceptable interest rate risk limits and maintaining adequate levels of liquidity. Our net earnings are materially dependent on our net interest income.

Table of Contents

IRR inherent in the Company’s balance sheet consists of reprice, option, yield curve, and basis risks. Reprice risk results from differences in the maturity or repricing of asset and liability portfolios. Option risk arises from “embedded options” present in many financial instruments such as loan prepayment options, deposit early withdrawal options, and interest rate options. These options allow customers opportunities to benefit when market interest rates change, which typically results in higher costs or lower revenue for the Company. Yield curve risk refers to the risk resulting from unequal changes in the spread between two or more rates for different maturities for the same instrument. Basis risk refers to the potential for changes in the underlying relationship between market rates and indices, which subsequently results in changes to the profit spread on an earning asset or liability. Basis risk is also present in administered rate liabilities, such as savings accounts, negotiable order of withdrawal accounts, and money market accounts where historical pricing relationships to market rates may change due to the level or directional change in market interest rates.

ALCO manages our IRR exposures through proactive measurement, monitoring, and management actions. ALCO is responsible for maintaining levels of IRR within limits approved by the Board of Directors by adhering to a risk management policy that is designed to promote a stable net interest margin in periods of interest rate fluctuation. Accordingly, the Company’s interest rate sensitivity and liquidity are monitored on an ongoing basis by ALCO, which oversees market risk management and establishes risk measures, limits and policy guidelines for managing the amount of interest rate risk and its effect on net interest income and capital. A variety of measures are used to provide for a comprehensive view of the magnitude of interest rate risk, the distribution of risk, the level of risk over time and the exposure to changes in certain interest rate relationships.

The Company utilizes an asset/liability model as the primary quantitative tool in measuring the amount of IRR associated with changing market rates. The model is used to perform net interest income, economic value of equity (EVE), stochastic, and gap analyses. When performing net interest income at risk analysis, the model is used to quantify the effects of various interest rate scenarios on projected net interest income and projected net income over the next 12-month and 24-month periods. The model measures the impact on net interest income relative to a base case scenario given hypothetical fluctuations in interest rates over the next 24 months. Regarding EVE analysis, the model is used to assess the change in theoretical equity market value that would occur in response to instantaneous and sustained parallel shifts in market interest rates. EVE analysis is primarily used to identify long-term structural mismatches in the balance sheet as market rates move, while net interest income analysis assesses the impact of market rate movements over a short time horizon. Net interest income simulations incorporate assumptions regarding balance sheet growth and mix as well as the pricing, repricing, and maturity characteristics of the existing and projected balance sheet. The impact of interest rate derivatives, such as interest rate swaps, caps and floors, is also included in the model. Other interest rate-related risks such as prepayment, basis, and option risk are also considered.

Net Interest Income at Risk

Our primary market risk is interest rate risk that stems from uncertainty with respect to the absolute and relative levels of future market interest rates that affect our financial products and services. In an attempt to manage our exposure to interest rate risk, management measures the sensitivity of our net interest income and cash flows under various market interest rate scenarios, establishes interest rate risk management policies and implements asset/liability management strategies designed to promote a relatively stable net interest margin under varying rate environments.

The following table presents an analysis of our interest rate risk as measured by the estimated changes in net interest income resulting from an instantaneous and sustained parallel shift in rates at December 31, 2025. Shifts are measured in 100 basis point increments in a range from -500 to +500 basis points from base case, with -300 through +300 basis points presented in Table 25. Our interest rate sensitivity modeling incorporates a number of assumptions including loan and deposit repricing characteristics, the rate of loan prepayments and other factors. The base scenario assumes that balance sheet composition and the current interest rate environment is held constant over a 24-month forecast period and is the scenario to which all others are compared in order to measure the change in net interest income. Policy limits on the change in net interest income under a variety of interest rate scenarios are approved by the Board of Directors. All policy scenarios assume a static volume forecast where the balance sheet is held constant, although other scenarios are modeled.

Table of Contents

TABLE 25. Net Interest Income (te) at Risk

Estimated Increase<br>in NII
Change in Interest Rates Year 1 Year 2
(basis points)
- 300 (5.21)% (13.91)%
- 200 (4.13)% (10.16)%
- 100 (1.94)% (4.76)%
+ 100 1.49% 3.93%
+ 200 2.80% 7.50%
+ 300 4.07% 10.97%

The results indicate a general asset sensitivity across most scenarios driven primarily by repricing of cash flows in the investment and loan portfolios. As short-term rates remained relatively elevated over the year, the funding mix has shifted to more rate sensitive deposits and wholesale sources, resulting in lower overall net interest income at risk as deposit repricing is expected to offset rate adjustments in the floating rate loan book. Furthermore, due to the shift in funding mix, the Bank is currently less sensitive to changes in short-term rate movements with interest rate risk being driven more by changes in the mid to long-term segment of the yield curve. When deemed prudent, management has taken actions to mitigate exposure to interest rate risk with on-or off-balance sheet financial instruments and intends to do so in the future. Possible actions include, but are not limited to, changes in the pricing of loan and deposit products, modifying the composition of earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities, and adding to, modifying or terminating existing interest rate swap agreements or other financial instruments used for interest rate risk management purposes.

Even if interest rates change in the designated amounts, there can be no assurance that our assets and liabilities would perform as anticipated. Additionally, a change in the U.S. Treasury rates in the designated amounts accompanied by a change in the shape of the U.S. Treasury yield curve would cause significantly different changes to net interest income than indicated above. Strategic management of our balance sheet and earnings is fluid and would be adjusted to accommodate these movements. As with any method of measuring interest rate risk, certain shortcomings are inherent in the methods of analysis presented above. For example, although certain assets and liabilities may have similar maturities or periods to repricing, they may react in different degrees to changes in market interest rates. Also, the interest rates on certain types of assets and liabilities may fluctuate in advance of changes in market interest rates, while interest rates on other types may lag behind changes in market rates. Certain assets such as adjustable-rate loans have features which restrict changes in interest rates on a short-term basis and over the life of the asset. Also, the ability of many borrowers to service their debt may decrease in the event of an interest rate increase. All of these factors are considered in monitoring exposure to interest rate risk.

Economic Value of Equity (EVE)

EVE simulation involves calculating the present value of all future cash flows from assets and subtracting the present value of all future cash outflows from liabilities including the impact of off-balance sheet items such as interest rate hedges. This analysis results in a theoretical market value of the bank’s equity or EVE. Management’s focus on EVE analysis is not on the resulting calculation of EVE itself, but instead on the sensitivity of EVE to changes in market rates. Policy limits on the change in EVE under a variety of interest rate scenarios are approved by the Board of Directors. The following table presents an analysis of the change in the Bank’s EVE resulting from instantaneous and parallel shifts in rates as of December 31, 2025. Shifts are measured in 100 basis point increments ranging from -500 to +500 basis points from base case, with -300 through +300 basis points presented in Table 26.

TABLE 26. Economic Value of Equity

Estimated Change<br>in EVE at
Change in Interest Rates December 31, 2025
(basis points)
- 300 2.79%
- 200 2.57%
- 100 1.77%
+ 100 (2.63)%
+ 200 (5.72)%
+ 300 (8.95)%

The net changes in EVE presented in the preceding table are within the parameters approved by the Board of Directors. Because EVE measures the present value of cash flows over the estimated lives of instruments, the change in EVE does not directly correlate to the

Table of Contents

degree that earnings would be impacted over a shorter time horizon (i.e., the current year). Further, EVE does not consider factors such as future balance sheet growth, changes in product mix, changes in yield curve relationships, possible hedging activities, or changing product spreads, each of which could mitigate the adverse impact of changes in interest rates.

Operational Risk Management

Operational risk is the risk of loss resulting from inadequate or failed internal controls and processes, people and systems, or from external events, including fraud, litigation and data security incidents. We depend on the ability of our employees and systems to process, record and monitor a large number of transactions on an on-going basis. As operational risk remains elevated and as customer and regulatory expectations regarding information security have increased, the Company continues to enhance its controls, processes and systems in order to protect the Company’s networks, computers, software and data from attack, damage or unauthorized access.

The Board Risk Committee has primary responsibility for the oversight of operational risk. In this capacity, the Board Risk Committee oversees the Company’s processes for identifying, assessing, monitoring and managing cybersecurity risk. In addition, individual business lines have direct and primary responsibility and accountability for identifying, controlling, and monitoring operational risks embedded in their business activities.

See Item 1A. “Risk Factors” for further discussion of the risks associated with an interruption or incidents in our information systems or infrastructure and Item 1C. “Cybersecurity” for additional disclosures on cybersecurity and related risk management strategy and governance.

LIQUIDITY AND CAPITAL RESOURCES

Liquidity

Liquidity management ensures that funds are available to meet the cash flow requirements of our depositors and borrowers, while also meeting the operating, capital and strategic cash flow needs of the Company, the Bank and other subsidiaries. As part of the overall asset and liability management process, liquidity management strategies and measurements have been developed to manage and monitor liquidity risk. The following table summarizes available liquidity at December 31, 2025.

TABLE 27. Net Available Sources of Funds

December 31, 2025
( in thousands) Total <br>Available Amount <br>Used Net <br>Availability
Available Sources of Funding:
Internal Sources
Free securities 4,153,209 $ $ 4,153,209
External Sources
Federal Home Loan Bank (a) 6,749,076 1,452,438 5,296,638
Federal Reserve Bank 3,307,233 3,307,233
Brokered deposits 4,391,966 4,391,966
Other 1,159,000 70,000 1,089,000
Total Available Sources of Funding 19,760,484 $ 1,522,438 $ 18,238,046
Cash and other interest-bearing bank deposits 695,261
Total Liquidity $ 18,933,307

All values are in US Dollars.

(a) Amount used includes funded advances and letters of credit.

TABLE 28. Liquidity Metrics

2025 2024 2023
Free securities / total securities 51.97 % 48.65 % 38.80 %
Core deposits / total deposits 94.99 % 94.12 % 92.51 %
Wholesale funds / core deposits 4.37 % 3.09 % 7.21 %
Liquid assets / total liabilities 15.63 % 15.26 % 12.69 %
Average loans / average deposits 81.48 % 81.01 % 80.04 %

At December 31, 2025, our available on and off-balance sheet liquidity of $18.9 billion is well in excess of our estimated uninsured, noncollateralized deposits of approximately $11.3 billion.

Table of Contents

The asset portion of the balance sheet provides liquidity primarily through loan principal repayments, maturities and repayments of investment securities and occasional sales of various assets. Short-term investments such as federal funds sold, securities purchased under agreements to resell and interest-bearing deposits with the Federal Reserve Bank or with other commercial banks are additional sources of liquidity to meet cash flow requirements. Free securities represent unpledged securities that can be sold or used as collateral for borrowings, and include unpledged securities assigned to short-term dealer repurchase agreements or to the Federal Reserve Bank discount window. Management has established an internal target for the ratio of free securities to total securities of 20% or greater. As shown in Table 28 above, our ratios of free securities to total securities were 51.97% and 48.65% at December 31, 2025 and 2024, respectively. Securities and FHLB letters of credit are pledged as collateral related to public funds and repurchase agreements. The carry value of total pledged securities was $3.9 billion at both December 31, 2025, and 2024.

The liability portion of the balance sheet provides liquidity mainly through the ability to use cash sourced from various customers’ interest-bearing and noninterest-bearing deposit accounts. At December 31, 2025, deposits totaled $29.3 billion, a decrease of $213.1 million, or 1%, from December 31, 2024.

Core deposits represent total deposits excluding certificates of deposits (CDs) of $250,000 or more and brokered deposits. Core deposits totaled $27.8 billion at both December 31, 2025, and 2024. The ratio of core deposits to total deposits was 94.99% at December 31, 2025, up from 94.12% at December 31, 2024. The largest driver in the increase in the ratio was the decline in retail time deposits greater than $250,000.

There were no brokered time deposits at December 31, 2025, compared to $6.9 million at December 31, 2024. The use of brokered deposits as a funding source is subject to certain policies regarding the amount, term and interest rate.

Purchases of federal funds, securities sold under agreements to repurchase and other short-term borrowings from customers provide additional sources of liquidity to meet short-term funding requirements. Besides funding from customer sources, the Bank has a line of credit with the FHLB that is secured by blanket pledges of certain mortgage loans. At December 31, 2025, the Bank had borrowings of $400 million from the FHLB and had approximately $5.3 billion remaining available under this line. The Bank also has unused borrowing capacity at the Federal Reserve’s discount window of approximately $3.3 billion. There were no outstanding borrowings with the Federal Reserve at December 31, 2025 and December 31, 2024, or at any point during the years then ended.

Wholesale funds, which are comprised of short-term borrowings, long-term debt and brokered deposits were 4.37% of core deposits at December 31, 2025 and 3.09% at December 31, 2024. Wholesale funds totaled $1.2 billion at December 31, 2025, an increase of $360 million from December 31, 2024. The increase was primarily driven by increases of $400 million in FHLB borrowing and $70 million increase in federal funds purchased, partially offset by a $92 million decrease in customer securities sold under agreements to repurchase. The Company has established an internal target for wholesale funds to be less than 25% of core deposits.

Other key measures used to monitor liquidity include the liquid asset ratio and the loan to deposit ratio. The liquid asset ratio (liquid assets, consisting of cash, short-term investments and free securities, divided by total liabilities) measures our ability to meet short-term obligations. Our liquid asset ratio was 15.63% at December 31, 2025 compared to 15.26% at December 31, 2024. Management has established a minimum liquid asset ratio of 7.5% and an internal target of 12% or greater. The loan to deposit ratio (average loans outstanding during the reporting period divided by average deposits outstanding) measures the amount of funds the Company lends for each dollar of deposits on hand. Our average loan-to-deposit ratio was 81.48% for the year ended December 31, 2025 compared to 81.01% for the year ended December 31, 2024. Management has established a target range for the loan to deposit ratio of 87% to 89%, but has and will continue to operate outside that range under certain market conditions and circumstances.

Cash generated from operations is another important source of funds to meet liquidity needs. The Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows included in Part II, Item 8 of this document present operating cash flows and summarize all significant sources and uses of funds during the years ended December 31, 2025 and 2024.

Dividends received from the Bank have been the primary source of funds available to the Parent Company for the payment of dividends to our stockholders and for servicing its debt. The liquidity management process takes into account the various regulatory provisions that can limit the amount of dividends that the Bank can distribute to the Parent Company, as described in Note 13 – Stockholder’s Equity to the consolidated financial statements. The Parent targets cash and other liquid assets to provide liquidity in an amount sufficient to fund approximately six quarters of ongoing cash or liquid asset needs, consisting primarily of common stockholder dividends, debt service requirements, and any expected share repurchase or early extinguishment of debt. The Parent may operate below the target level on a temporary basis if a return to the target can be achieved in the near-term, generally not to exceed four quarters. The Parent had cash totaling $264.5 million at December 31, 2025.

Table of Contents

Material Cash Requirements

The Company has sufficient access to liquidity for operations. The following table summarizes select significant contractual obligations as of December 31, 2025, according to payments due by period. The table excludes obligations under deposit contracts and short-term borrowings discussed previously in this analysis. The maturities of time deposits in amounts greater than $250,000 are presented in Table 22. Purchase obligations represent material legal and binding contracts to purchase services and goods that cannot be settled or terminated without paying substantially all of the contractual amounts.

TABLE 29. Contractual Cash Obligations

Payment due by period
($ in thousands) Total Less Than <br>1 Year 1-3<br>Years 3-5<br>Years More Than<br>5 Years
Long-term debt obligations $ 576,571 $ 37,552 $ 21,674 $ 27,248 $ 490,097
Operating lease obligations(1) 154,978 18,895 37,849 30,401 67,833
Purchase obligations 161,417 93,188 57,598 10,631
Commitments to fund low income housing and small business investment company 18,332 18,332
Total $ 911,298 $ 167,967 $ 117,121 $ 68,280 $ 557,930

(1) Includes four leases that had not yet commenced at December 31, 2025, totaling $7.4 million

Capital Resources

The Company has a strong capital position which is vital to continued profitability, promotes depositor and investor confidence, and provides a solid foundation for economic downturns, future growth and flexibility in addressing strategic opportunities. Stockholders’ equity totaled $4.5 billion at December 31, 2025 compared to $4.1 billion at December 31, 2024. The $332.5 million increase from December 31, 2024 is attributable to net income of $486.1 million, $229.8 million of other comprehensive income and $20.6 million of long-term incentive and dividend reinvestment activity, partially offset by share repurchases of $249.0 million and dividends of $155.1 million.

At December 31, 2025, our tangible common equity ratio was 10.06%, compared to 9.47% at December 31, 2024. The 59 bp increase is comprised of net income (+145 bps), other comprehensive income (+67 bps) and stock-based compensation and other activity (+6 bps), partially offset by share repurchases (-73 bps), dividends (-45 bps), capital deployed in the Sabal acquisition (-33 bps) and tangible asset growth (-8 bps).

The primary quantitative measures that regulators use to gauge capital adequacy are the ratios of Total, Tier 1 and Common Equity Tier 1 regulatory capital to risk-weighted assets (risk-based capital ratios) and the ratio of Tier 1 capital to average total assets (Leverage ratio). The Federal Reserve Board’s final rule implementing the Basel III regulatory capital framework and related changes per the Dodd-Frank Act established the Basel III minimum regulatory capital requirements for all organizations for Total, Tier 1 and Common Equity Tier 1 risk-based capital ratios equal to 8.00%, 6.00%, and 4.5%, respectively, as well as set a conservation buffer of 2.5% and a Leverage ratio of 4.0%. Based on capital ratios as of December 31, 2025 using Basel III definitions, the Company and the Bank exceeded all capital requirements of the rule. The Company and the Bank have established internal target ranges for Total, Tier 1 and Common Equity Tier 1 risk-based capital ratios and the leverage ratio. At December 31, 2025, each of these capital ratios fell within, or above, their respective target range.

At December 31, 2025, our regulatory capital ratios were well in excess of current regulatory minimum requirements, including the conservatism buffers, by at least $1.1 billion. Additionally, both the Company and the Bank were considered “well capitalized” by regulatory agencies. Note 13 – Stockholders’ Equity to the consolidated financial statements provides additional information about the Bank’s regulatory capital ratios.

The following table shows certain of the Company’s capital ratios and our regulatory capital ratios as calculated under current rules at December 31, 2025 and 2024.

Table of Contents

TABLE 30. Risk-Based Capital and Capital Ratios

($ in thousands) 2025 2024
Common equity tier 1 capital $ 3,872,490 $ 3,886,926
Additional tier 1 capital
Tier 1 capital 3,872,490 3,886,926
Tier 2 capital 511,458 491,822
Total capital $ 4,383,948 $ 4,378,748
Risk-weighted assets $ 28,377,413 $ 27,490,356
Ratios
Leverage (Tier 1 capital to average assets) 11.17 % 11.29 %
Common equity tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets 13.65 % 14.14 %
Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets 13.65 % 14.14 %
Total capital to risk-weighted assets 15.45 % 15.93 %
Common stockholders' equity to total assets 12.57 % 11.77 %
Tangible common equity to total assets 10.06 % 9.47 %

We regularly perform stress analysis on our capital levels. One such scenario includes the hypothetical impact of including accumulated other comprehensive losses on market valuations of available for sale securities and cash flow hedges in regulatory capital and a further stress scenario that includes both those losses plus losses on the held to maturity investment portfolio in regulatory capital. We estimate that our regulatory capital ratios would remain in excess of the well-capitalized minimums under both of these stress scenarios at December 31, 2025.

In January 2025, the Company’s Board of Directors declared a 12.5% increase in the regular quarterly cash dividend to $0.45 per share, bringing the annual cash dividend rate of $1.80 per share. During 2024, the Company paid an annual cash dividend rate of $1.50 per share. Subsequent to year end, in January 2026, the Company’s Board of Directors increased the quarterly dividend to $0.50 per share, or 11%. The increases in our dividends are reflective of our strong regulatory ratios, allowing for improved shareholder returns. The Company has paid uninterrupted quarterly dividends to shareholders since 1967.

STOCK REPURCHASE PROGRAM

In December 2024, the Company’s Board of Directors authorized a stock repurchase program, effective January 1, 2025, pursuant to which the Company may, from time to time, purchase up to 5% of the shares of its common stock outstanding as of December 31, 2024, totaling 4.3 million shares, through the program's expiration date of December 31, 2026. The program allowed the Company to repurchase shares in the open market, by block purchase, through accelerated share repurchase plans, in privately negotiated transactions or otherwise, in one or more transactions, from time to time, depending upon market conditions and other factors, and in accordance with applicable regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission. The program did not obligate the Company to purchase any shares and could have been terminated or amended by the Board at any time prior to the expiration date. During the twelve months ended December 31, 2025, the Company completed this program by repurchasing 4,306,200 shares at an average price of $57.30 per share, inclusive of commissions. The Company has accrued $2.2 million of estimated excise tax associated with the share repurchases in 2025.

In December 2025, the Company’s Board of Directors authorized a stock repurchase program, effective January 1, 2026, pursuant to which the Company may, from time to time, purchase up to 5% of the shares of its common stock outstanding as of December 31, 2025, totaling 4.1 million shares, with the same terms as described above. The program has an expiration date of December 31, 2026 and does not obligate the Company to purchase any shares. The program may be terminated or amended by the Board at any time prior to the expiration date. This program allows us to continue to opportunistically repurchase shares of our common stock.

Table of Contents

FOURTH QUARTER RESULTS

Net income for the fourth quarter of 2025 totaled $125.6 million, or $1.49 per diluted common share (EPS), compared to $127.5 million, or $1.49 per diluted common share, in the third quarter of 2025. The Company reported net income for the fourth quarter of 2024 of $122.1 million, or $1.40 per diluted common share.

Highlights of our fourth quarter of 2025 results (compared to third quarter of 2025):

  • Net income totaled $125.6 million, or $1.49 per diluted share, compared to $127.5 million, or $1.49 per diluted share in the third quarter of 2025
  • Adjusted pre-provision net revenue (PPNR), a non-GAAP measure, totaled $174.0 million, compared to $175.6 million in the prior quarter
  • Loans increased $362 million, or 2%
  • Deposits increased $620 million, or 2%
  • Criticized commercial loans and nonaccrual loans decreased
  • Allowance for credit losses coverage remains strong at 1.43% compared to 1.45%
  • Net interest margin of 3.48%, down 1 bp from the prior quarter
  • Tangible common equity ratio of 10.06%, up 5 bps linked-quarter; common equity tier 1 ratio was 13.65%, down 44 bps linked-quarter, reflecting the repurchase of 2.5 million shares of common stock during the fourth quarter
  • Efficiency ratio of 54.93%, compared to 54.10% in the prior quarter

Total loans were $24.0 billion at December 31, 2025, up $361.9 million, or 2%, from September 30, 2025. Loan growth was driven primarily by strong production in the healthcare portfolio, increased investor commercial real estate activity and continued growth in equipment finance.

Total deposits at December 31, 2025 were $29.3 billion, up $620.0 million, or 2%, from September 30, 2025. Noninterest-bearing deposits totaled $10.4 billion at December 31, 2025, up $69.7 million, or 1%, from September 30, 2025, and comprised 35% of total period-end deposits. The linked-quarter increase in noninterest-bearing deposits was due in part to a seasonal increase in public funds deposits of $190.9 million in the fourth quarter of 2025. Interest-bearing transaction and savings deposits totaled $12.0 billion at the end of the fourth quarter of 2025, up $223.4 million, or 2%, linked-quarter, largely driven by competitive products and pricing. Interest-bearing public fund deposits increased $417.4 million, or 15%, linked-quarter, totaling $3.2 billion at December 31, 2025. The increase in interest-bearing public funds was driven by seasonal inflows. Generally we experience seasonal cash inflows from public entities in the fourth quarter, with subsequent reductions in the first quarter of the following year. Compared to September 30, 2025, retail time deposits of $3.7 billion were down $90.4 million, or 2%, driven by maturity concentration and promotional rate reductions during the fourth quarter of 2025.

Net interest income (TE) for the fourth quarter of 2025 was $284.7 million, an increase of $2.4 million, or 1%, from the third quarter of 2025. The net interest margin was 3.48% in the fourth quarter of 2025, down 1 bp linked-quarter, driven by lower loan yields (-10 bps), partially offset by higher securities yield (+2 bps) and lower cost of funds (+7 bps).

The provision for credit losses recorded in the fourth quarter of 2025 was $13.1 million, compared to $12.7 million in the third quarter of 2025. Net charge-offs were $13.0 million, or 0.22% of average total loans on an annualized basis in the fourth quarter of 2025, up from $11.4 million, or 0.19% of average total loans, in the third quarter of 2025. Our allowance for credit losses was $341.7 million at December 31, 2025, up $0.1 million from September 30, 2025. Criticized commercial loans were $535.4 million, or 2.88% of total commercial loans at December 31, 2025, compared to $549.2 million, or 3.01% of total commercial loans at September 30, 2025. Nonaccrual loans totaled $106.9 million, or 0.45% of total loans at December 31, 2025, compared to $113.6 million, or 0.48% of total loans at September 30, 2025. ORE and foreclosed assets totaled $14.8 million at December 31, 2025, up $3.6 million from September 30, 2025.

Noninterest income totaled $107.1 million for the fourth quarter of 2025, up $1.1 million, or 1%, from the third quarter of 2025. Service charges on deposits were up $0.4 million, or 1%, from the third quarter of 2025. Bank card and ATM fees were down $0.2 million, or 1%, from the third quarter of 2025. Investment and annuity income and insurance fees were down $1.9 million, or 13%, from the third quarter of 2025, primarily attributable to lower annuity sales in the fourth quarter of 2025. Compared to the third quarter of 2025, trust fees of $24.6 million were up $0.4 million, or 2%. Fees from secondary mortgage operations totaled $3.7 million for the fourth quarter of 2025, up $0.2 million, or 6%, from the third quarter of 2025. Other noninterest income totaled $19.0 million in the fourth quarter of 2025, up $2.2 million, or 13%, from the third quarter of 2025, driven primarily an increase in SBIC income, partially offset by a decline in syndication fees.

Table of Contents

Noninterest expense totaled $217.9 million, up $5.1 million, or 2%, from the third quarter of 2025. Personnel expense totaled $122.5 million, up $0.5 million, or less than 1%. Net occupancy and equipment expense totaled $18.6 million, up $0.4 million, or 2%, and amortization of intangibles totaled $2.6 million for the fourth quarter of 2025, down $0.1 million, or 3%. Net ORE and other foreclosed assets expense totaled $0.5 million in the fourth quarter of 2025, compared to a net gain of $0.3 million in the third quarter of 2025. Other noninterest expense totaled $73.6 million in the fourth quarter of 2025, up $3.5 million, or 5%, linked-quarter, driven primarily increases in advertising, data processing and other professional services expenses.

The effective income tax rate for fourth quarter 2025 was 20.7%. The effective income tax rate continues to be less than the statutory rate primarily due to tax-exempt income and income tax credits.

The following table provides selected comparative financial information for the five quarters ending with December 31, 2025.

TABLE 31. Quarterly Consolidated Financial Results

(in thousands, except per share data) December 31, 2025 September 30, 2025 June 30, 2025 March 31, 2025 December 31, 2024
Income Statement Data:
Interest income $ 407,698 $ 409,020 $ 402,581 $ 395,321 $ 414,286
Interest income (te) (a) 410,203 411,591 405,077 398,127 417,021
Interest expense 125,528 129,282 125,622 125,416 140,730
Net interest income (te) 284,675 282,309 279,455 272,711 276,291
Provision for credit losses 13,145 12,651 14,925 10,462 11,912
Noninterest income 107,131 106,001 98,524 94,791 91,209
Noninterest expense 217,850 212,753 215,979 205,059 202,333
Income before income taxes 158,306 160,335 144,579 149,175 150,520
Income tax expense 32,734 32,869 31,048 29,671 28,446
Net income $ 125,572 $ 127,466 $ 113,531 $ 119,504 $ 122,074
Supplemental disclosure items-included above, pre-tax:
Included in noninterest expense:
Sabal Trust Company acquisition expense $ $ $ 5,911 $ $
Balance Sheet Data:
Period end balance sheet data:
Loans $ 23,958,440 $ 23,596,565 $ 23,461,750 $ 23,098,146 $ 23,299,447
Earning assets 32,218,663 32,532,320 31,965,130 31,661,169 31,857,841
Total assets 35,472,762 35,766,407 35,212,652 34,750,680 35,081,785
Noninterest-bearing deposits 10,374,991 10,305,303 10,638,785 10,614,874 10,597,461
Total deposits 29,279,774 28,659,750 29,046,612 29,194,733 29,492,851
Stockholders' equity 4,460,117 4,474,479 4,365,419 4,278,672 4,127,636
Average balance sheet data:
Loans 23,715,763 23,425,895 23,249,241 23,068,573 23,248,512
Earning assets 32,598,315 32,213,632 32,081,140 32,023,885 32,333,012
Total assets 35,227,286 34,751,209 34,527,276 34,355,515 34,770,663
Noninterest-bearing deposits 10,165,806 10,121,707 10,317,446 10,163,221 10,409,022
Total deposits 28,816,539 28,492,076 28,649,900 28,752,416 29,108,381
Stockholders' equity 4,417,711 4,368,746 4,284,279 4,182,814 4,138,326
Common Shares Data:
Earnings per share:
Basic $ 1.51 $ 1.50 $ 1.32 $ 1.38 $ 1.41
Diluted 1.49 1.49 1.32 1.38 1.40
Cash dividends per common share 0.45 0.45 0.45 0.45 0.40
Performance Ratios:
Return on average assets 1.41 % 1.46 % 1.32 % 1.41 % 1.40 %
Return on average common equity 11.28 % 11.58 % 10.63 % 11.59 % 11.74 %
Efficiency ratio (b) 54.93 % 54.10 % 54.91 % 55.22 % 54.46 %
Net interest margin (te) 3.48 % 3.49 % 3.49 % 3.43 % 3.41 %
Annualized net charge offs to average loans 0.22 % 0.19 % 0.31 % 0.18 % 0.20 %

Table of Contents

.. ..
(in thousands, except per share data) December 31, 2025 September 30, 2025 June 30, 2025 March 31, 2025 December 31, 2024
Reconciliation of pre-provision net revenue (te) and adjusted pre-provision net revenue(te) (non-GAAP measures) (c)
Net income (GAAP) $ 125,572 $ 127,466 $ 113,531 $ 119,504 $ 122,074
Provision for credit losses 13,145 12,651 14,925 10,462 11,912
Income tax expense 32,734 32,869 31,048 29,671 28,446
Pre-provision net revenue 171,451 172,986 159,504 159,637 162,432
Taxable equivalent adjustment 2,505 2,571 2,496 2,806 2,735
Pre-provision net revenue (te) 173,956 175,557 162,000 162,443 165,167
Adjustments from supplemental disclosure items
Sabal Trust Company acquisition expense 5,911
Adjusted pre-provision net revenue (te) $ 173,956 $ 175,557 $ 167,911 $ 162,443 $ 165,167
Reconciliation of revenue (te), adjusted revenue (te) and efficiency ratio (non-GAAP measures) (c)
Net interest income $ 282,170 $ 279,738 $ 276,959 $ 269,905 $ 273,556
Noninterest income 107,131 106,001 98,524 94,791 91,209
Total GAAP revenue 389,301 385,739 375,483 364,696 364,765
Taxable equivalent adjustment 2,505 2,571 2,496 2,806 2,735
Total revenue (te) $ 391,806 $ 388,310 $ 377,979 $ 367,502 $ 367,500
Adjusted revenue $ 391,806 $ 388,310 $ 377,979 $ 367,502 $ 367,500
GAAP noninterest expense $ 217,850 $ 212,753 $ 215,979 $ 205,059 $ 202,333
Amortization of intangibles (2,622 ) (2,694 ) (2,524 ) (2,113 ) (2,206 )
Adjustments from supplemental disclosure items
Sabal Trust Company acquisition expense (5,911 )
Adjusted noninterest expense for efficiency $ 215,228 $ 210,059 $ 207,544 $ 202,946 $ 200,127
Efficiency ratio (b) 54.93 % 54.10 % 54.91 % 55.22 % 54.46 %

(a) Taxable equivalent basis (te). For analytical purposes, management adjusts interest income and net interest income for tax-exempt items to a taxable equivalent basis using a federal income tax rate of 21%.

(b) The efficiency ratio is noninterest expense to total net interest (te) and noninterest income, excluding amortization of purchased intangibles and supplemental disclosure items.

(c) Refer to the Non-GAAP Financial Measures section of this analysis for a discussion of these measures.

CRITICAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES AND SIGNIFICANT ESTIMATES

The accounting principles we follow and the methods for applying these principles conform to accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America and general practices followed by the banking industry. The significant accounting principles and practices we follow are described in Note 1 to the consolidated financial statements, included in Item 8 of this document. These principles and practices require management to make estimates and assumptions about future events that affect the amounts reported in the consolidated financial statements and accompanying notes. Management evaluates the estimates and assumptions made on an ongoing basis so that the resulting reported amounts reflect management’s best estimates and judgments given current facts and circumstances. The following discusses certain critical accounting policies that involve a higher degree of management judgment and complexity in producing estimates that may significantly affect amounts reported in the consolidated financial statements and notes thereto.

Allowance for Credit Losses

The allowance for credit losses (ACL) is comprised of the allowance for loan and lease losses (ALLL), a valuation account available to absorb losses on loans and leases held for investment, and the reserve for unfunded lending commitments, a liability established to absorb credit losses for the expected life of the contractual term of off-balance sheet exposures as of the date of the determination. Accounting standards require that management incorporate economic forecasts for a reasonable and supportable period, which is two years based on our current policy. We utilize third-party forecasts that consist of multiple economic scenarios. The scenarios include a baseline forecast, with a probability distribution of 50% better or worse economic performance and various upside and downside scenarios utilized at aggregated state (or regional) levels across our footprint or national level, depending on the portfolio. The economic forecasts are generally lagging and may not incorporate all events and circumstances through the financial statement date.

The Company’s management considers available forecasts along with current events not captured and our specific portfolio characteristics to determine weights to the scenario output based on our best estimate of likely outcomes. Changing economic conditions introduce enhanced estimation uncertainty in the forecasts used to estimate expected credit loss. Our credit loss models were built using historical data that may not be representative of existing economic conditions. The estimate of the life of a loan considers both contractual cash flows as well as estimated prepayments and forecasted draws on unfunded loan commitments that

Table of Contents

were also built on historical data and may react differently given the current environment. Such forecasted information is inherently uncertain, therefore, actual results may differ significantly from management’s estimates.

Management applies significant judgment when weighting the macroeconomic scenarios for the reasonable and supportable period. Our assessment considers the scenario description compared to our portfolio performance and benchmarking select variables to other third-party forecasts. At December 31, 2025, the Company weighted the Moody’s baseline scenario at 50% and the mild recessionary S-2 scenario at 50%. Results by scenario can vary significantly from period to period as both the scenario assumptions and the portfolio composition are changing, therefore comparison of scenario weighting from period to period may not be meaningful. For example, holding all other assumptions constant, the slower growth S-2 scenario produced expected credit losses 36% higher than utilization of the baseline scenario at December 31, 2025. In contrast, for the year ended December 31, 2024, the slower growth S-2 scenario produced results 40% higher than the baseline scenario. In addition, these quantitative results are adjusted, sometimes materially, by the qualitative assessment described below.

The quantitative loss rate analysis is supplemented by a review of qualitative factors that considers whether conditions differ from those existing during the historical periods used in the development of the credit loss models. Such factors include, but are not limited to, problem loan trends, changes in loan profiles and volumes, changes in lending policies and procedures, current or expected economic trends, business conditions, credit concentrations, model limitations and other relevant factors not captured by our models. While quantitative data for these factors is used where available, there is significant judgment applied in these processes.

For credits that are individually evaluated, a specific allowance is calculated as the shortfall between the credit’s value and the bank’s exposure. The loan’s value is measured by either the loan’s observable market price, the fair value of the collateral of the loan (less liquidation costs) if it is collateral dependent, or by the present value of expected future cash flows discounted at the loan’s effective interest rate. Collateral supporting loans individually evaluated for credit loss may include, but is not limited to, commercial and residential real estate, accounts receivable and other corporate assets. Valuations are highly subjective and based on information available and the resolution strategy at the time of valuation. These values are difficult to assess and have heightened uncertainty resulting from current market conditions. Actual results could differ from these estimates.

Management considers the appropriateness of these critical assumptions as part of its allowance review and believes the ACL level is appropriate based on information available through the financial statement date. Refer to Note 4 – Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses, included in Part II, Item 8 of this document, for further discussion of significant assumptions used in the current allowance calculation.

RECENT ACCOUNTING PRONOUNCEMENTS

See Note 1 to our consolidated financial statements that appears in Part II, Item 8. “Financial Statements and Supplementary Data.”

ITEM 7A. QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK

The information required for this item is included in the sections entitled “Asset/Liability Management” and “Net Interest Income at Risk” that appear in Part II, Item 7. “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and is incorporated here by reference.

Table of Contents

ITEM 8. FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA

MANAGEMENT’S REPORT ON INTERNAL CONTROL OVER FINANCIAL REPORTING

The management of Hancock Whitney Corporation has prepared the consolidated financial statements and other information in our Annual Report in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America and is responsible for its accuracy. The financial statements necessarily include amounts that are based on management’s best estimates and judgments.

In meeting its responsibility, management relies on internal accounting and related control systems. The internal control systems are designed to ensure that transactions are properly authorized and recorded in the Company’s financial records and to safeguard the Company’s assets from material loss or misuse. Such assurance cannot be absolute because of inherent limitations in any internal control system.

The Company’s management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting, as such term is defined in the Rule 13(a)–15(f) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. Under the supervision and with the participation of management, including the Company’s principal executive officer and principal financial officer, the Company conducted an evaluation of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting based on the framework in Internal Control – Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission. Management also conducted an assessment of requirements pertaining to Section 112 of the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation Improvement Act. This section relates to management’s evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, including controls over the preparation of financial statements in accordance with the instructions to the Consolidated Financial Statements for Bank Holding Companies (Form FR Y-9C) and in compliance with laws and regulations. Our evaluation included a review of the documentation of controls, evaluations of the design of the internal control system and tests of the effectiveness of internal controls.

The Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2025 was audited by PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, an independent registered public accounting firm, as stated in their accompanying report which expresses an unqualified opinion on the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2025.

Based on the Company’s evaluation under the framework in Internal Control – Integrated Framework (2013), management concluded that internal control over financial reporting was effective as of December 31, 2025.

/s/ John M. Hairston /s/ Michael M. Achary
John M. Hairston Michael M. Achary
President & Chief Executive Officer Senior Executive Vice President & Chief Financial Officer
(Principal Executive Officer) (Principal Financial Officer)
February 26, 2026 February 26, 2026

Table of Contents

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

To the Board of Directors and Stockholders of Hancock Whitney Corporation

Opinions on the Financial Statements and Internal Control over Financial Reporting

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Hancock Whitney Corporation and its subsidiaries (the “Company”) as of December 31, 2025 and 2024, and the related consolidated statements of income, of comprehensive income, of changes in stockholders’ equity and of cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2025, including the related notes (collectively referred to as the “consolidated financial statements”). We also have audited the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2025, based on criteria established in Internal Control – Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO).

In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the Company as of December 31, 2025 and 2024, and the results of its operations and its cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2025 in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. Also in our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2025, based on criteria established in Internal Control - Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the COSO.

Basis for Opinions

The Company's management is responsible for these consolidated financial statements, for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting, and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting. Our responsibility is to express opinions on the Company’s consolidated financial statements and on the Company's internal control over financial reporting based on our audits. We are a public accounting firm registered with the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (PCAOB) and are required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audits to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the consolidated financial statements are free of material misstatement, whether due to error or fraud, and whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects.

Our audits of the consolidated financial statements included performing procedures to assess the risks of material misstatement of the consolidated financial statements, whether due to error or fraud, and performing procedures that respond to those risks. Such procedures included examining, on a test basis, evidence regarding the amounts and disclosures in the consolidated financial statements. Our audits also included evaluating the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the consolidated financial statements. Our audit of internal control over financial reporting included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk. Our audits also included performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinions.

Definition and Limitations of Internal Control over Financial Reporting

A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. Management's assessment and our audit of Hancock Whitney Corporation's internal control over financial reporting also included controls over the preparation of financial statements in accordance with the instructions to the Consolidated Financial Statements for Bank Holding Companies (Form FR Y-9C) to comply with the reporting requirements of Section 112 of the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation Improvement Act (FDICIA). A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (i) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (ii) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (iii) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Table of Contents

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

Critical Audit Matters

The critical audit matter communicated below is a matter arising from the current period audit of the consolidated financial statements that was communicated or required to be communicated to the audit committee and that (i) relates to accounts or disclosures that are material to the consolidated financial statements and (ii) involved our especially challenging, subjective, or complex judgments. The communication of critical audit matters does not alter in any way our opinion on the consolidated financial statements, taken as a whole, and we are not, by communicating the critical audit matter below, providing a separate opinion on the critical audit matter or on the accounts or disclosures to which it relates.

Allowance for Credit Losses related to the Collectively Evaluated Portfolios

As described in Notes 1 and 4 to the consolidated financial statements, as of December 31, 2025, the total allowance for credit losses (“ACL”) was $342 million, of which $308 million relates to the allowance for loan and lease losses, a valuation account available to absorb losses on loans and leases held for investment, and $34 million relates to the reserve for unfunded lending commitments, a liability established to absorb credit losses for the expected life of the contractual term of off-balance sheet exposures. The total ACL related to the collectively evaluated portfolios was $334 million as of December 31, 2025. The analysis and methodology for estimating the ACL includes two primary elements: a collective approach for pools of loans that have similar risk characteristics using a loss rate analysis, and a specific reserve analysis for credits individually evaluated for credit loss. For the collectively evaluated portfolios, management utilizes internally developed credit models and applies economic forecasts to estimate the expected credit loss over the reasonable and supportable forecast period for the majority of the portfolio, and other methods, generally historical loss based, for select portfolios. Management estimates a collective allowance for a two-year reasonable and supportable forecast period utilizing probability weighted multiple macroeconomic scenarios and then reverts on a linear basis over four quarters to an average historical loss rate for the remaining term.

The principal considerations for our determination that performing procedures relating to the allowance for credit losses related to the collectively evaluated portfolios is a critical audit matter are (i) the significant judgment by management when developing the allowance for credit losses related to the collectively evaluated portfolios; (ii) a high degree of auditor judgment, subjectivity and effort in performing procedures and evaluating audit evidence related to management’s probability weights applied to multiple macroeconomic scenarios; and (iii) the audit effort involved the use of professionals with specialized skill and knowledge.

Addressing the matter involved performing procedures and evaluating audit evidence in connection with forming our overall opinion on the consolidated financial statements. These procedures included testing the effectiveness of controls relating to the allowance for credit losses related to the collectively evaluated portfolios, including controls over management’s probability weights applied to multiple macroeconomic scenarios. These procedures also included, among others, (i) testing management’s process for developing the allowance for credit losses related to the collectively evaluated portfolios; (ii) testing the completeness and accuracy of certain data used in the internally developed credit models; and (iii) the involvement of professionals with specialized skill and knowledge to assist in evaluating (a) the appropriateness of the methodology and the internally developed credit models used by management, and (b) the reasonableness of management’s probability weights applied to multiple macroeconomic scenarios.

/s/ PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP

New Orleans, Louisiana

February 26, 2026

We have served as the Company’s auditor since 2009.

Table of Contents

Hancock Whitney Corporation and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Balance Sheets

(in thousands, except per share data) 2024
Assets:
Cash and due from banks 562,995 $ 574,910
Interest-bearing bank deposits 132,037 939,306
Federal funds sold 229 409
Securities available for sale, at fair value (amortized cost of 6,341,322 and 5,774,133) 5,961,917 5,161,491
Securities held to maturity (fair value of 2,011,026 and 2,233,526) 2,132,882 2,435,663
Loans held for sale (includes 33,158 and 18,929 measured at fair value) 33,158 21,525
Loans 23,958,440 23,299,447
Less: allowance for loan losses (307,731 ) (318,882 )
Loans, net 23,650,709 $ 22,980,565
Property and equipment, net of accumulated depreciation of 370,818 and 345,962 261,181 279,767
Right of use assets, net of accumulated amortization of 73,527 and 67,063 102,056 98,822
Prepaid expense 58,847 45,763
Other real estate and foreclosed assets, net 14,788 27,797
Accrued interest receivable 138,509 143,237
Goodwill 925,404 855,453
Other intangible assets, net 67,071 35,224
Life insurance contracts 798,509 774,542
Funded pension assets, net 292,437 260,003
Deferred tax asset, net 55,798 146,567
Other assets 284,235 300,741
Total assets 35,472,762 $ 35,081,785
Liabilities and Stockholders' Equity:
Deposits:
Noninterest-bearing 10,374,991 $ 10,597,461
Interest-bearing 18,904,783 18,895,390
Total deposits 29,279,774 29,492,851
Short-term borrowings 1,017,292 639,015
Long-term debt 199,407 210,544
Accrued interest payable 14,485 20,148
Lease liabilities 121,505 117,817
Other liabilities 380,182 473,774
Total liabilities 31,012,645 30,954,149
Stockholders' equity:
Common stock 309,513 309,513
Capital surplus 1,491,219 1,719,609
Retained earnings 3,035,636 2,704,606
Accumulated other comprehensive loss, net (376,251 ) (606,092 )
Total stockholders' equity 4,460,117 4,127,636
Total liabilities and stockholders' equity 35,472,762 $ 35,081,785
Preferred shares authorized (par value of 20.00 per share) 50,000 50,000
Preferred shares issued and outstanding
Common shares authorized (par value of 3.33 per share) 350,000 350,000
Common shares issued 92,947 92,947
Common shares outstanding 82,259 86,124

All values are in US Dollars.

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

Table of Contents

Hancock Whitney Corporation and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Statements of Income

Years Ended December 31,
(in thousands, except per share data) 2025 2024 2023
Interest income:
Loans, including fees $ 1,355,852 $ 1,452,402 $ 1,379,263
Loans held for sale 1,652 1,640 1,723
Securities-taxable 220,513 194,227 189,386
Securities-tax exempt 16,015 17,698 18,627
Short-term investments 20,588 27,024 31,498
Total interest income 1,614,620 1,692,991 1,620,497
Interest expense:
Deposits 470,348 574,441 443,924
Short-term borrowings 23,687 24,372 66,657
Long-term debt 11,813 12,257 12,317
Total interest expense 505,848 611,070 522,898
Net interest income 1,108,772 1,081,921 1,097,599
Provision for credit losses 51,183 52,167 59,103
Net interest income after provision for credit losses 1,057,589 1,029,754 1,038,496
Noninterest income:
Service charges on deposit accounts 99,180 91,105 86,020
Trust fees 89,630 71,734 67,565
Bank card and ATM fees 86,135 85,491 82,966
Investment and annuity fees and insurance commissions 49,162 43,424 36,714
Secondary mortgage market operations 14,769 12,374 9,159
Securities transactions, net (11 ) (65,380 )
Other income 67,582 60,001 71,436
Total noninterest income 406,447 364,129 288,480
Noninterest expense:
Compensation expense 385,660 380,591 376,055
Employee benefits 89,731 88,786 84,740
Personnel expense 475,391 469,377 460,795
Net occupancy expense 55,871 53,650 51,573
Equipment expense 17,020 17,432 18,852
Data processing expense 127,227 121,880 117,694
Professional services expense 57,080 41,935 38,331
Amortization of intangibles 9,953 9,413 11,556
Deposit insurance and regulatory fees 17,992 24,209 49,979
Other real estate and foreclosed assets expense (income) 3,091 (2,469 ) (624 )
Other expense 88,016 84,483 88,692
Total noninterest expense 851,641 819,910 836,848
Income before income taxes 612,395 573,973 490,128
Income tax expense 126,322 113,158 97,526
Net income $ 486,073 $ 460,815 $ 392,602
Earnings per common share - basic $ 5.70 $ 5.30 $ 4.51
Earnings per common share - diluted $ 5.67 $ 5.28 $ 4.50
Dividends paid per share $ 1.80 $ 1.50 $ 1.20
Weighted-average shares outstanding - basic 84,905 86,346 86,130
Weighted-average shares outstanding - diluted 85,440 86,648 86,423

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

Table of Contents

Hancock Whitney Corporation and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income

Years Ended December 31,
($ in thousands) 2025 2024 2023
Net income $ 486,073 $ 460,815 $ 392,602
Other comprehensive income before income taxes:
Net change in unrealized gain (loss) on securities available for sale and cash flow hedges 243,977 (65,141 ) 91,061
Reclassification of net loss realized and included in earnings 35,033 52,832 115,619
Valuation adjustments to employee benefit plans 17,231 28,191 (13,325 )
Amortization of unrealized net loss on securities transferred to held to maturity 1,580 1,670 1,747
Other comprehensive income before income taxes 297,821 17,552 195,102
Income tax expense 67,980 2,517 44,047
Other comprehensive income net of income taxes 229,841 15,035 151,055
Comprehensive income $ 715,914 $ 475,850 $ 543,657

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

Table of Contents

Hancock Whitney Corporation and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders’ Equity

Accumulated
Other
Comprehensive
Capital Retained Income (Loss),
(in thousands, except parenthetical share data) Amount Surplus Earnings Net Total
Balance, December 31, 2022 92,947 $ 309,513 $ 1,716,884 $ 2,088,413 $ (772,182 ) $ 3,342,628
Net income 392,602 392,602
Other comprehensive income 151,055 151,055
Comprehensive income 543,657
Cash dividends declared (1.20 per common share) (105,557 ) (105,557 )
Common stock activity, long-term incentive plans 18,972 146 19,118
Issuance of stock from dividend reinvestment and stock purchase plans 3,815 3,815
Balance, December 31, 2023 92,947 $ 309,513 $ 1,739,671 $ 2,375,604 $ (621,127 ) $ 3,803,661
Net income 460,815 460,815
Other comprehensive income 15,035 15,035
Comprehensive income 475,850
Cash dividends declared (1.50 per common share) (131,946 ) (131,946 )
Common stock activity, long-term incentive plans 13,647 133 13,780
Issuance of stock from dividend reinvestment and stock purchase plans 4,120 4,120
Repurchase of common stock (762,993 shares) (37,829 ) (37,829 )
Balance, December 31, 2024 92,947 $ 309,513 $ 1,719,609 $ 2,704,606 $ (606,092 ) $ 4,127,636
Net income 486,073 486,073
Other comprehensive income 229,841 229,841
Comprehensive income 715,914
Cash dividends declared (1.80 per common share) (155,077 ) (155,077 )
Common stock activity, long-term incentive plans 16,143 34 16,177
Issuance of stock from dividend reinvestment and stock purchase plans 4,441 4,441
Repurchase of common stock (4,306,200 shares) (248,974 ) (248,974 )
Balance, December 31, 2025 92,947 $ 309,513 $ 1,491,219 $ 3,035,636 $ (376,251 ) $ 4,460,117

All values are in US Dollars.

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

Table of Contents

Hancock Whitney Corporation and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

($ in thousands) 2025 2024 2023
CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES:
Net income $ 486,073 $ 460,815 $ 392,602
Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided<br>   by operating activities:
Depreciation and amortization 27,314 32,301 34,720
Provision for credit losses 51,183 52,167 59,103
Gain on other real estate and foreclosed assets (761 ) (2,022 ) (967 )
Deferred tax expense 23,222 4,299 13,986
Increase in cash surrender value of life insurance contracts (25,005 ) (27,315 ) (17,671 )
(Gain) loss on disposal or impairment of assets 294 (1,242 ) (15,753 )
Loss on sale of securities available for sale 11 65,380
Net (increase) decrease in loans held for sale (11,108 ) 4,504 (24,589 )
Net amortization of securities premium/discount 13,084 13,704 16,383
Amortization of intangible assets 9,953 9,413 11,556
Stock-based compensation expense 24,444 22,703 24,652
Net change in derivative collateral liability (35,791 ) (5,288 ) 58,326
Increase (decrease) in interest payable and other liabilities (15,910 ) (16,833 ) 48,714
(Increase) decrease in other assets (5,845 ) 84,981 (160,890 )
Other, net 620 (6,445 ) (10,303 )
Net cash provided by operating activities $ 541,778 $ 625,742 $ 495,249

Table of Contents

Hancock Whitney Corporation and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows—(Continued)

($ in thousands) 2025 2024 2023
CASH FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES:
Proceeds from sales of securities available for sale $ 229,200 $ $ 977,114
Proceeds from maturities of securities available for sale 452,772 454,188 813,214
Purchases of securities available for sale (1,237,741 ) (750,265 ) (1,044,988 )
Proceeds from maturities of securities held to maturity 293,656 238,899 163,266
Purchases of securities held to maturity (6,023 )
Proceeds received (made) to terminate hedge instruments 2,270 (13,730 ) 16,360
Net redemptions (purchases) of Federal Home Loan Bank stock (16,756 ) 134,667 (68,057 )
Net (increase) decrease in short-term investments 807,449 (312,633 ) (303,022 )
Proceeds from sales of loans and leases 110,877 119,166 115,119
Net (increase) decrease in loans (847,676 ) 407,460 (968,237 )
Net cash paid in business acquisition (112,071 )
Purchases of property and equipment (18,720 ) (10,237 ) (25,025 )
Proceeds from sales of property 6,144 33,130
Proceeds from sales of other real estate and foreclosed assets 27,647 1,795 3,575
Other, net (5,263 ) (698 ) (1,637 )
Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities (314,356 ) 274,756 (295,211 )
CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES:
Net increase (decrease) in deposits (213,077 ) (197,208 ) 619,710
Net increase (decrease) in short-term borrowings 378,277 (515,814 ) (716,442 )
Dividends paid (153,803 ) (130,840 ) (104,697 )
Payroll tax remitted on net share settlement of equity awards (8,301 ) (9,358 ) (5,681 )
Other repurchases of common stock (246,874 ) (37,690 )
Proceeds from dividend reinvestment and stock purchase plan 4,441 4,120 3,815
Net cash used in financing activities (239,337 ) (886,790 ) (203,295 )
NET INCREASE (DECREASE) IN CASH AND DUE FROM BANKS (11,915 ) 13,708 (3,257 )
CASH AND DUE FROM BANKS, BEGINNING 574,910 561,202 564,459
CASH AND DUE FROM BANKS, ENDING $ 562,995 $ 574,910 $ 561,202
SUPPLEMENTAL INFORMATION
Income taxes paid (net of refunds received) $ 103,142 $ 66,111 $ 101,749
Interest paid 511,358 635,770 487,681
SUPPLEMENTAL INFORMATION FOR NON-CASH
INVESTING AND FINANCING ACTIVITIES
Assets acquired in settlement of loans 17,634 28,491 4,302

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

Table of Contents

Note 1. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies and Recent Accounting Pronouncements

DESCRIPTION OF BUSINESS

Hancock Whitney Corporation (the “Company”) is a financial services company headquartered in Gulfport, Mississippi that is both a financial holding company and a bank holding company registered under the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956, as amended. The Company provides a comprehensive and fully integrated suite of financial choices to customers through its bank subsidiary, Hancock Whitney Bank (the “Bank”), a Mississippi state bank. The Bank offers a broad range of traditional and online banking services to commercial, small business and retail customers, providing a variety of transaction and savings deposit products, treasury management services, secured and unsecured loan products (including revolving credit facilities), and letters of credit and similar financial guarantees. The Bank also provides access to trust and investment management services to retirement plans, corporations and individuals, as well as investment advisory and brokerage products. In addition, the Company offers its customers access to fixed annuity and life insurance products and investment management and other services through its limited purpose broker-dealer subsidiary, Hancock Whitney Investment Services, Inc., a nonbank subsidiary of the holding company. The Company primarily operates across the Gulf South region, including southern and central Mississippi; southern and central Alabama; southern, central and northwest Louisiana; the northern, central, and panhandle regions of Florida; and certain areas of east and northeast Texas. In addition, the Company operates loan and deposit production offices in the metropolitan areas of Nashville, Tennessee and Atlanta, Georgia.

SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

The consolidated financial statements have been prepared in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the U.S. (U.S. GAAP) and those generally practiced within the banking industry. Following is a summary of the more significant accounting policies.

Basis of Presentation

The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the Company and all other entities in which the Company has a controlling interest. Variable interest entities for which the Company has been deemed the primary beneficiary are also consolidated. Significant intercompany transactions and balances have been eliminated in consolidation.

Certain prior period amounts have been reclassified to conform to the current-period presentation. The presentation of our income tax effective rate reconciliation, as presented in Note 15 – Income Taxes, as well as income taxes paid on the face of the Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows has been modified from prior filings with the retroactive adoption of Accounting Standards Update (ASU) 2023-09. See further discussion of ASU 2023-09 in the Recent Accounting Pronouncement section later in this footnote.

Use of Estimates

The accounting principles the Company follows and the methods for applying these principles conform to U.S. GAAP and general practices followed by the banking industry. These accounting principles and practices require management to make estimates and assumptions about future events that affect the amounts reported in the consolidated financial statements and the accompanying notes. Actual results could differ from those estimates.

Fair Value Accounting

Fair value is generally defined as the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability (an exit price) in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date under current market conditions. U.S. GAAP requires the use of fair values in determining the carrying values of certain assets and liabilities in the financial statements, as well as for specific disclosures about certain assets and liabilities.

Accounting guidance establishes a fair value hierarchy that prioritizes the inputs to the valuation techniques used to measure fair value, giving preference to quoted prices in active markets (level 1) and the lowest priority to unobservable inputs such as a reporting entity’s own data or information or assumptions developed from this data (level 3). Level 2 inputs include quoted prices for similar assets or liabilities in active markets, quoted prices for identical assets or liabilities in markets that are not active, observable inputs other than quoted prices, such as interest rates and yield curves, and inputs that are derived principally from or corroborated by observable market data by correlation or other means.

Table of Contents

Business Combinations

Business combinations are accounted for under the purchase method of accounting. Purchased assets, including identifiable intangibles, and assumed liabilities are recorded at their respective acquisition date fair values. If the fair value of net assets purchased exceeds the consideration given, a bargain purchase gain is recognized. If the consideration given exceeds the fair value of the net assets received or if the fair value of the net liabilities assumed exceeds the consideration received, goodwill is recognized. Fair values are subject to refinement for up to one year after the closing date of an acquisition as information relative to closing date fair values becomes available. Acquisition costs are expensed as incurred.

All identifiable intangible assets that are acquired in a business combination are recognized at the acquisition date fair value. Identifiable intangible assets are recognized separately if they arise from contractual or other legal rights or if they are separable (i.e., capable of being sold, transferred, licensed, rented, or exchanged separately from the entity).

Cash and Due from Banks

The Company considers only cash on hand, cash items in process of collection and noninterest-bearing balances due from financial institutions as cash and due from banks.

Securities

Securities are classified as trading, held to maturity or available for sale. Management determines the appropriate classification of debt and equity securities at the time of purchase and reevaluates this classification periodically as conditions change that could require reclassification.

Available for sale securities are stated at fair value. Unrealized holding gains and unrealized holding losses are reported net of tax in other comprehensive income or loss and in accumulated other comprehensive income or loss (AOCI) until realized.

Securities that the Company both positively intends and has the ability to hold to maturity are classified as securities held to maturity and are carried at amortized cost. The intent and ability to hold are not considered satisfied when a security is available to be sold in response to changes in interest rates, prepayment rates, liquidity needs or other reasons as part of an overall asset/liability management strategy.

Premiums and discounts on securities, both those held to maturity and those available for sale, are amortized and accreted to income as an adjustment to the securities’ yields using the effective interest method. Realized gains and losses on the sale of securities are reported net as a component of noninterest income. The cost of securities sold is specifically identified for use in calculating realized gains and losses.

Credit Losses on Securities

At least quarterly, or more often when warranted, the Company performs an assessment of held to maturity debt securities for expected credit losses and available for sale debt securities for credit-related impairment, resulting in an allowance for credit losses, if applicable. The Company applies the practical expedient to exclude the accrued interest receivable balance from amortized cost basis of securities. The allowance for credit losses on held to maturity debt securities is estimated at the individual security level when there is a more than inconsequential risk of default. The assessment uses probability of default and loss given default models based on public ratings, where available, or mapped internally developed risk grades to public ratings and forecasted cash flows using the same economic forecasts and probability weighting as used for the Company’s evaluation of the loan portfolio. Qualitative adjustments to the output of the quantitative calculation are made when management deems it necessary to reflect differences in current and forecasted conditions as compared to those during the historical loss period used in model development. The Company evaluates credit impairment on available for sale debt securities at an individual security level. This evaluation is done for securities whose fair value is below amortized cost with a more than inconsequential risk of default and where the Company has assessed the decline in fair value is significant enough to suggest a credit event occurred. Credit events are generally assessed based on adverse conditions specifically related to the security, an industry, or geographic area, changes in the financial condition of the issuer of the security, or in the case of an asset-backed debt security, changes in the financial condition of the underlying loan obligors. The allowance for credit losses for such securities is measured using a discounted cash flow methodology, through which management compares the present value of expected cash flows with the amortized cost basis of the security. The allowance for credit loss is limited to the amount by which the fair value is less than the amortized cost basis.

The Company records changes in the allowance for credit losses on securities with a corresponding adjustment recorded in the provision for credit losses. If the Company intends to sell the debt security, or more likely than not will be required to sell the security before recovery of its amortized cost basis, the security is charged down to fair value against the allowance for credit losses, with any incremental impairment reported in earnings.

Table of Contents

Loans

Loans Held for Sale

Residential mortgage loans originated for sale are classified as loans held for sale on the Consolidated Balance Sheets. The Company generally elects the fair value option on funded residential mortgage loans originated for sale that are associated with forward sales contracts. For mortgage loans for which the Company has elected the fair value option, gains and losses are included in noninterest income within secondary mortgage market operations.

Held for sale loans also includes residential construction loans that are anticipated to be sold upon completion of the construction term. At times, management may originate other types of loans with the intent to sell or decide to sell loans that were not originated for that purpose. Such loans are reclassified as held for sale at the lower of cost or market when that decision is made.

Loans Held for Investment

Loans that the Company has the intent and ability to hold for the foreseeable future or until maturity or payoff are considered loans held for investment and reported as loans on the Consolidated Balance Sheets and in the related footnote disclosures. Loans held for investment include loans originated for investment and loans acquired in purchase transactions.

Loans are reported at the principal balance outstanding net of unearned income. Interest on loans and accretion of unearned income, including net deferred loan fees and costs, are computed in a manner that approximates a level yield on recorded principal. Interest on loans is recognized in income as earned.

The accrual of interest is discontinued (“nonaccrual status”) when, in management’s opinion, it is probable that the borrower will be unable to meet payment obligations as they become due, as well as when required by regulatory provisions. When accrual of interest is discontinued on a loan, all unpaid accrued interest is reversed and payments subsequently received are applied first to recover principal. Interest income is recognized for payments received after contractual principal has been satisfied. Loans are returned to accrual status when all the principal and interest contractually due are brought current and future payment performance is reasonably assured.

Acquired Loans

Acquired loans are segregated between those purchased with credit deterioration (PCD) and those that are not (non-PCD). Loans considered PCD include those individual loans (or groups of loans with similar risk characteristics) that, as of the date of acquisition, are assessed as having experienced a more-than-insignificant deterioration in credit quality since origination. The assessment of what is more-than-insignificant credit deterioration since origination considers information including, but not limited to, financial assets that are delinquent, on nonaccrual and/or otherwise adversely risk rated as of the acquisition date, those that have been downgraded since origination, and those for which, after origination, credit spreads have widened beyond the threshold specified in policy. For PCD loans, the Company bifurcates the fair value discount between the credit and noncredit components and the credit portion of the fair value discount is added to the initial amortized cost basis with a corresponding increase to the allowance for credit losses at the date of acquisition. Any noncredit discount or premium resulting from acquiring loans with credit deterioration is allocated to each individual asset. All non-PCD loans acquired are recorded at the estimated fair value of the loan at acquisition, with the estimated allowance for credit loss recorded as a provision for credit losses through earnings in the period in which the acquisition has occurred. The noncredit discount or premium for PCD loans and full discount for non-PCD loans will be accreted to interest income using the interest method based on the effective interest rate at the acquisition date.

Modifications of Loans to Borrowers Experiencing Financial Difficulty

As part of our loss mitigation efforts, we may provide modifications to borrowers experiencing financial difficulty to improve long-term collectability of the loans and to avoid the need for repossession or foreclosure of collateral. Accounting standards require monitoring and reporting of certain qualifying modifications, including renewals and refinancings where the borrowers are experiencing financial difficulty (MEFDs). Qualifying modifications are interest rate reductions, other-than-insignificant payment delays, term extensions, or any combination of these terms. Our MEFD policy generally considers six months or less to be the time frame that is considered insignificant for payment delays and/or term extensions. Multiple payment delays and/or term extensions to borrowers experiencing financial difficulty within a twelve-month period are evaluated collectively. Qualifying modified loans are subject to reporting requirements for the twelve-month period following the modification.

MEFDs can continue to accrue interest, move to nonaccrual, remain on nonaccrual or return to accrual, depending on the individual facts and circumstances of the borrower. The Company has elected to evaluate these modified loans for credit loss consistent with policies for the non-modified portfolio, which includes individually evaluating for specific reserves all nonaccrual MEFDs over our existing materiality threshold and collectively evaluating credit loss for all other MEFDs, including those that continue to accrue interest. The credit loss methodology for MEFDs is the same as described in the Allowance for Credit Losses section that follows.

Table of Contents

Allowance for Credit Losses

The allowance for credit losses (ACL) is comprised of the allowance for loan and lease losses (ALLL), a valuation account available to absorb losses on loans and leases held for investment, and the reserve for unfunded lending commitments, a liability established to absorb credit losses for the expected life of the contractual term of off-balance sheet exposures as of the date of the determination. Quarterly, management estimates losses in the portfolio and unfunded exposures based on a number of factors, including the Company’s past loan loss experience, known and potential risks in the portfolio, adverse situations that may affect the borrowers’ ability to repay, the estimated value of any underlying collateral, and current and forecasted economic conditions.

The analysis and methodology for estimating the ACL includes two primary elements: a collective approach for pools of loans that have similar risk characteristics using a loss rate analysis, and a specific reserve analysis for credits individually evaluated for credit loss. For the collective approach, the Company segments loans into commercial non-real estate, commercial real estate – owner occupied, commercial real estate – income producing, construction and land development, residential mortgage and consumer, with further segmentation by region and sub-portfolio, as deemed appropriate. Both quantitative and qualitative factors are applied at the portfolio segment levels. The Company applies the practical expedient that permits the exclusion of the accrued interest receivable balance from amortized cost basis of financing receivables for all classes of loans as our nonaccrual policy results in the timely write-off of interest accrued but uncollected.

For the collectively evaluated portfolios, the Company utilizes internally developed credit models and third-party economic forecasts to estimate expected credit losses over a reasonable and supportable forecast period for the majority of the portfolio and other methods, generally historical loss based, for select portfolios. The Company estimates a collective allowance for a two-year reasonable and supportable forecast period utilizing probability weighted multiple macroeconomic scenarios, and then reverts on a linear basis over four quarters to an average historical loss rate for the remaining term. The credit models consist primarily of multivariate regression and autoregressive models that correlate our historical net charge-off rates with select macroeconomic variables at a collective level. Forward-looking macroeconomic forecasts are applied as inputs to the credit models to predict quarterly collective net charge-off rates over the reasonable and supportable period. The net charge-off rates from the credit models for the reasonable and supportable period, the linear reversion rates, and the average historical loss rates for the post reasonable and supportable periods are applied to forecasted balance runoff for the estimated remaining term. The balance runoff incorporates prepayment assumptions developed from historical experience that are applied to the multiple macroeconomic forecasts. Forecasted net charge-off rates are also applied to forecasted draws and subsequent runoff of unfunded commitments in the estimate of the reserve for unfunded lending commitments. Qualitative adjustments to the output of quantitative estimates are made when management deems it necessary to reflect differences in current and forecasted conditions as compared to those during the historical loss period used in model development. Conditions to be considered include, but are not limited to, problem loan trends, current business and economic conditions, credit concentrations, lending policies and procedures, lending staff, collateral values, loan profiles and volumes, loan review quality, changes in competition and regulations, and other adjustments for model limitations or other variables not specifically captured.

The Company establishes specific reserves using an individually evaluated approach for nonaccrual loans and any other financial instruments that are deemed to not share risk characteristics with other collectively evaluated financial assets. For loans individually evaluated, a specific allowance is recognized for any shortfall between the loan’s value and its recorded investment. The loan’s value is measured by either the loan’s observable market price, the fair value of the collateral of the loan (less liquidation costs) if it is collateral dependent, or by the present value of expected future cash flows discounted at the loan’s effective interest rate. The Company applies the practical expedient and defines collateral dependent loans as those where the borrower is experiencing financial difficulty and on which repayment is expected to be provided substantially through the operation or sale of the collateral. Loans individually analyzed are not incorporated into the collective analysis to avoid double counting. The Company limits the individually evaluated specific reserve analysis to include commercial and residential mortgage loans with relationship balances of $1 million or greater.

It is the policy of the Company to promptly charge off all commercial and residential mortgage loans, or portions of loans, when available information reasonably confirms that they are wholly or partially uncollectible. Prior to recording a charge, the loan’s value is established based on an assessment of the value of the collateral securing the loan, the borrower’s and the guarantor’s ability and willingness to pay, and the status of the account in bankruptcy court, if applicable. Consumer loans are generally charged down when the loan is 120 days past due for most secured and unsecured loans and 150 days past due for consumer credit card loans, unless the loan is clearly both well secured and in the process of collection. Loans are charged down to the fair value of the collateral, if any, less estimated selling costs. Loans are charged off against the allowance for loan losses, with subsequent recoveries added back to the allowance.

Table of Contents

Property and Equipment

Property and equipment are recorded at cost, less accumulated depreciation and amortization. Depreciation is charged to expense using the straight-line method over the estimated useful lives of the assets, which are up to 30 years for buildings and three to ten years for most furniture and equipment. Amortization expense for software is generally charged over three years, or seven years for core systems. Leasehold improvements are amortized over the terms of the respective leases or the estimated useful lives of the improvements, whichever is shorter. The Company evaluates whether events and circumstances have occurred that indicate that such long-lived assets have been impaired. Measurement of any impairment of such long-lived assets is based on their fair values.

Property and equipment used in operations is considered held for sale when certain criteria are met, including when management has committed to a plan to sell the asset, the asset is available for sale in its immediate condition, and the sale is probable within one year of the reporting date. Assets held for sale are reported at the lower of cost or fair value less costs to sell. Gains and losses related to retirement or disposition of property and equipment are recorded in the consolidated statements of income as realized, reflected in either other income under noninterest income or other expense under noninterest expense, depending on the nature of the item.

Operating Leases

The Company recognizes a liability representing the present value of future lease payments (the lease liability) and a right-of-use asset representing its right to use the underlying asset over the lease term in the Consolidated Balance Sheets.

The Company determines if an arrangement is a lease at inception of the contract and assesses the appropriate classification as finance or operating. Operating leases with terms greater than one year are included in right-of-use lease assets and lease obligations on the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheets. The lease term includes payments to be made in optional or renewal periods only if the lessee is reasonably certain to exercise an option to extend the lease or not to exercise an option to terminate the lease. Operating lease right-of-use assets and lease liabilities are recognized at commencement date based on the present value of lease payments over the lease term using the interest rate implicit in the contract, when available, or the Company’s incremental collateralized borrowing rate with similar terms. Agreements with both lease and non-lease components are accounted for separately, with only the lease component capitalized. The right-of-use asset is the amount of the lease liability adjusted for prepaid or accrued lease payments, remaining balance of any lease incentives received, unamortized initial direct costs, and impairment. Lease expense is recorded on a straight-line basis over the lease term through amortization of the right-of-use asset plus implicit interest accreted on the operating lease liability obligation, and is reflected in net occupancy expense in the Consolidated Statements of Income.

The Company evaluates whether events and circumstances have occurred that indicate right-of-use assets have been impaired. Measurement of any impairment of such assets is based on their fair values. Once a right-of-use asset for an operating lease is impaired, the carrying amount of the right-of-use asset is reduced through expense and the remaining balance is subsequently amortized on a straight-line basis.

Certain of the Company’s leases contain variable components, such as annual changes to rent based on the consumer price index. Operating lease liabilities are not re-measured as a result of changes to variable components unless the lease must be re-measured for some other reason such as a renewal that was not reasonably certain of being exercised. Changes to the variable components are treated as variable lease payments and recognized in the period in which the obligation for those payments was incurred.

As allowed in the transition guidance in Topic 842, "Leases," the Company elected to use the standard’s “package of practical expedients,” which allowed for the use of previous conclusions about lease identification, lease classification and the accounting treatment for initial direct costs. The Company also elected the short-term lease recognition exemption for all leases with lease terms of one year or less; as such, the Company does not recognize right-of-use assets or lease liabilities on the consolidated balance sheet for such leases.

Other Real Estate and Foreclosed Assets

Other real estate and foreclosed assets includes real property and other assets that have been acquired in satisfaction of loans and leases, as well as real property no longer used in the Bank’s business. These assets are recorded at the estimated fair value less the estimated cost of disposition and carried at the lower of either cost or market. Fair value is based on independent appraisals and other relevant factors. Any initial reduction in the carrying amount of a loan to the fair value of the collateral received less selling costs is charged to the allowance for loan losses. Each asset is revalued on an annual basis, or more often if market conditions necessitate. Subsequent losses on the periodic revaluation of these assets and gains or losses recognized on disposition are charged to current earnings, as are revenues from and costs of operating and maintaining real property; with the resulting net (income) expense reflected in noninterest expense in the Consolidated Statements of Income. Improvements made to real property are capitalized if the expenditures are expected to be recovered upon the sale of the property.

Table of Contents

Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets

Goodwill represents the excess of consideration paid over the fair value of net assets acquired or the excess of the fair value liabilities assumed over consideration received in a business combination. Goodwill is not amortized but assessed for impairment on an annual basis, or more often if events or circumstances indicate there may be impairment. Accounting guidance permits the Company to first assess qualitative factors to determine if it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit exceeds its carrying value. If the Company determines it is more likely than not that the fair value exceeds book value, then a quantitative impairment test is not necessary. If the Company elects to bypass the qualitative assessment, or concludes that it is more likely than not that the fair value is less than the carrying value, a quantitative goodwill impairment test is performed. In addition, absent any triggering events, a quantitative impairment test will be performed every three years to ensure goodwill is periodically reviewed within a reasonable timeframe. The quantitative impairment test compares the estimated fair value of a reporting unit with its net book value. The Company has assigned all goodwill to one reporting unit that represents overall banking operations. The fair value of the reporting unit is based on valuation techniques that market participants would use in an acquisition of the whole unit, and may include analysis such as estimated discounted cash flows, the quoted market price of the Company’s stock adjusted for a control premium, and observable average price-to-earnings and price-to-book multiples of competitors. If the unit’s fair value is less than its carrying value, an estimate of the implied fair value of the goodwill is compared to the goodwill’s carrying value, and any impairment is recognized.

Other identifiable intangible assets with finite lives, such as core deposit intangibles, customer lists and trade names, are initially recorded at fair value and are generally amortized over the periods benefited. These assets are evaluated for impairment in a similar manner to long-lived assets.

Life Insurance Contracts

Bank-owned life insurance contracts (BOLI) are comprised of long-term life insurance contracts on the lives of certain current and past employees where the insurance policy benefits and ownership are retained by the employer. Its cash surrender value is an asset that the Company uses to partially offset the future cost of employee benefits. The cash value accumulation on BOLI is permanently tax deferred if the policy is held to the insured person’s death and certain other conditions are met.

Federal Home Loan Bank Stock

As a member of the Federal Home Loan Bank (FHLB), the Company is required to purchase and hold shares of capital stock in the FHLB in an amount equal to a membership investment plus an activity-based investment determined according to the level of outstanding FHLB advances. The shares are recorded at amortized cost, which approximates fair value, and is reflected in Other Assets in the Consolidated Balance Sheets.

Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities

The Company records all derivatives on the Consolidated Balance Sheets at fair value as components of other assets and other liabilities. The accounting for changes in the fair value of derivatives depends on the intended use of the derivative, whether the Company has elected to designate a derivative in a hedging relationship and apply hedge accounting and whether the hedging relationship has satisfied the criteria necessary to apply hedge accounting. Derivatives designated and qualifying as a hedge of the exposure to changes in the fair value of an asset, liability, or firm commitment attributable to a particular risk, such as interest rate risk, are considered fair value hedges. Derivatives designated and qualifying as a hedge of the exposure to variability in expected future cash flows, or other types of forecasted transactions, are considered cash flow hedges. Hedge accounting generally provides for the matching of the timing of gain or loss recognition on the hedging instrument with the recognition of the changes in the fair value of the hedged asset or liability that are attributable to the hedged risk in a fair value hedge or the earnings effect of the hedged forecasted transactions in a cash flow hedge.

For derivatives designated as hedging the exposure to changes in the fair value of an asset or liability (fair value hedge), the gain or loss is recognized in earnings in the period of the fair value change together with the offsetting loss or gain on the hedged item attributable to the risk being hedged. Derivatives designated as hedging exposure to variable cash flows of a forecasted transaction (cash flow hedge), are reported as a component of other comprehensive income or loss and subsequently reclassified into earnings when the forecasted transaction affects earnings or, in certain circumstances, when the hedge is terminated, with the full impact of hedge gains and losses recognized in the period in which the hedged transaction impacts the entity’s earnings. For derivatives that are not designated as hedging instruments, changes in the fair value of the derivatives are recognized in earnings immediately. Note 12 - Derivatives describes the derivative instruments currently used by the Company and discloses how these derivatives impact the Company’s financial condition and results of operations.

Table of Contents

Stockholders’ Equity

Common stock reflects shares issued at par value. Repurchase of the Company’s common stock (treasury stock) is recorded at cost as a reduction of stockholders’ equity within capital surplus in the accompanying Consolidated Balance Sheets and the Statements of Changes in Stockholders’ Equity. When treasury shares are subsequently reissued, treasury stock is reduced by the cost of such stock using the first-in-first-out method, with the difference recorded in capital surplus or retained earnings, as applicable.

Revenue Recognition

Interest Income

Interest income is recognized on an accrual basis driven by written contracts, such as loan agreements or securities contracts. Loan origination fees and costs are recognized over the life of the loan as an adjustment to yield. Unamortized premiums, discounts and other basis adjustments on loans and investment securities are recognized in interest income as a yield adjustment over the contractual lives. However, premiums for certain callable investment securities are amortized to the earliest call date.

Service Charges on Deposit Accounts

Service charges on deposit accounts include transaction-based fees for nonsufficient funds, account analysis fees, and other service charges on deposits, including monthly account service fees. Nonsufficient funds fees are recognized at the time when the account overdraft occurs in accordance with regulatory guidelines. Account analysis fees consist of fees charged on certain business deposit accounts based upon account activity as well as other monthly account fees, and are recorded under the accrual method of accounting as services are performed.

Other service charges are earned by providing depositors safeguard and remittance of funds as well as by providing other elective services for depositors that are performed upon the depositor’s request. Charges for deposit services for the safeguard and remittance of funds are recognized at the end of the statement cycle, after services are provided, as the customer retains funds in the account. Revenue for other elective services is earned at the point in time the customer uses the service.

Trust Fees

Trust fee income represents revenue generated from asset management services provided to individuals, businesses, and institutions. The Company has a fiduciary responsibility to the beneficiary of the trust to perform agreed upon services which can include investing assets, periodic reporting, and providing tax information regarding the trust. In exchange for these trust and custodial services, the Company collects fee income from beneficiaries as contractually determined via fee schedules. The Company’s performance obligation is primarily satisfied over time as the services are performed and provided to the customer. These fees are recorded under the accrual method of accounting as the services are performed. The Company generally acts as the principal in these transactions and records revenue and expenses on a gross basis.

Bank Card and Automated Teller Machine (ATM) Fees

Bank card and ATM fees include credit card, debit card and ATM transaction revenue. The majority of this revenue is card interchange fees earned through a third-party network. Performance obligations are satisfied for each transaction when the card is used and the funds are remitted. The network establishes interchange fees that the merchant remits for each transaction, and costs are incurred from the network for facilitating the interchange with the merchant. Card fees also include merchant services fees earned for providing merchants with card processing capabilities.

ATM income is generated from allowing customers to withdraw funds from other banks’ machines and from allowing a non-customer cardholder to withdraw funds from the Company’s machines. The Company satisfies its performance obligations for each transaction at the point in time that the withdrawal is processed.

Bank card and ATM fee income is recorded on accrual basis as services are provided with the related expense reflected in data processing expense.

Investment and Annuity Fees and Insurance Commissions

Investment and annuity services fee income represents income earned from investment, annuity, insurance and advisory services. The Company provides its customers with access to these products using a third-party broker dealer that provides full-service brokerage, insurance and investment advisory activities to meet their financial needs and investment objectives. As the agent in the arrangement, the Company recognizes service commissions on a net basis. Upon selection of a product, the customer enters into an agreement with the third-party service provider. The performance obligation is satisfied by fulfilling its responsibility to place

Table of Contents

customers in the product for which a commission fee is earned from our third-party service provider based on agreed-upon fee percentages. Fees are recorded on a trade date basis, net of any associated costs. Investment revenue also includes portfolio management fees, which represent quarterly fees charged on a contractual basis to customers for the management of their investment portfolios and are recorded under the accrual method of accounting.

This revenue line item also includes investment banking income, which includes fees for services arising from securities offerings or placements in which the Company acts as a principal. Revenue is recognized at the time the underwriting is completed and the revenue is reasonably determinable. Any costs associated with these transactions are reflected in the appropriate expense line item.

Insurance commission revenue is recognized as of the effective date of the insurance policy, as the Company’s performance obligation is connecting the customer to the insurance products. Fees for policy renewals are recognized when determinable, which is generally when such commissions are received or when we receive data from our third-party service provider that allows the reasonable estimation of these amounts. As the Company is agent in these transactions, expenses are recorded net in this revenue line item.

Secondary Mortgage Market Operations

Secondary mortgage market operations revenue is primarily comprised of service release premiums earned on the sale of closed-end mortgage loans to other financial institutions or government agencies that are recognized in revenue as each sales transaction occurs. This revenue line item also includes derivative income associated with our mortgage banking operations. Refer to Note 12 – Derivatives for a discussion of these derivative instruments.

Securities Transactions, net

Securities transactions include net realized gain (losses) on securities sold reflecting the excess (deficiency) of proceeds received over the specifically identified carrying amount of the assets being sold plus cost to sell. Securities sales are recorded as each transaction occurs on a trade-date basis.

Income from Bank-Owned Life Insurance

Bank-owned life insurance income primarily represents income earned from the appreciation of the cash surrender value of insurance contracts held and the proceeds of insurance benefits. Revenue from the proceeds of insurance benefits is recognized at the time a claim is confirmed.

Credit Related Fees

Credit-related fee income is primarily composed of letter of credit fees and unused commercial commitment fees. Revenue for letters of credit fees is recognized over time. Revenue for unused commercial commitment fees are recognized based on contractual terms, generally when collected.

Income from Derivatives

Income from derivatives consists primarily of income from interest rate swaps, net of fair value adjustments for customer derivatives and the related offsetting agreements with unrelated financial institutions for which the derivative instruments are not designated as hedges.

Net Gains on Sales of Premises, Equipment and Other Assets

Net gains on sales of premises, equipment and other assets consists primarily of net revenue earned from sales of excess-bank owned facilities and equipment no longer in use, gains on sales of non-residential mortgage loans and leases and other assets associated with the equipment finance line of business. Gains or losses are generally recognized when the asset has been legally transferred to the buyer, net of costs to sell.

Table of Contents

Other Miscellaneous Income

Other miscellaneous income represents a variety of revenue streams, including safe deposit box income, wire transfer fees, syndication fees, and any other income not reflected above. Income is recorded once the performance obligation is satisfied, generally on the accrual basis or on a cash basis if not material and/or considered constrained.

Advertising Costs

Advertising costs are expensed as incurred and recorded as a component of noninterest expense.

Income Taxes

Income taxes are accounted for using the asset and liability method. Current tax liabilities or assets are recognized for the estimated income taxes payable or refundable on tax returns to be filed with respect to the current year. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are based on temporary differences between the financial statement carrying amounts and the tax bases of the Company’s assets and liabilities. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured using the enacted tax rates expected to apply to taxable income in the years in which those temporary differences are expected to be realized or settled. Valuation allowances are established against deferred tax assets if, based on all available evidence, it is more likely than not that some or all of the assets will not be realized. The benefit of a position taken or expected to be taken in a tax return is recognized when it is more likely than not that the position will be sustained on its technical merits. The effects of changes in tax rates and laws upon deferred tax balances are recognized in the period in which the legislation is enacted.

The Company makes investments that generate solar investment tax credits (solar ITC). The Company uses the deferral method of accounting for solar ITC investments whereby the tax benefit from the investment tax credits is recognized as a reduction of the book basis of the related asset and is amortized into income over the tax life of the underlying investment.

The Company also made investments in projects that yield tax credits issued under the Qualified Zone Academy Bonds (QZAB) and Qualified School Construction Bonds (QSCB) prior to December 31, 2017, as well as Federal and State New Market Tax Credit (NMTC) programs. Returns on these investments are generated through the receipt of federal and state tax credits. The tax credits are recorded as a reduction to the income tax provision in the year that they are earned. Tax credits from QZAB and QSCB bonds are generally earned over the life of the bonds in lieu of interest income. Credits on Federal NMTC investments are earned over the seven-year compliance period beginning with the year of investment. Credits on State NMTC investments are generally earned over a three to five-year period depending upon the specific state program. The Company has elected not to apply the proportional amortization method to the qualifying NMTC program for any existing and future eligible investments. As such, any investment income, gains and losses, and tax credits are presented gross in the statement of income, where income and gains and losses on the investment are reported as a component of pre-tax book income/loss while the tax credits are reported as a component of income tax expense. The election for any eligible future investments in other tax credit programs will be made at the time of investment.

The Company also invests in affordable housing projects that generate low-income tax credits (LIHTC) that are earned over a 10-year period, beginning with the year the rental activity begins. The Company has elected to use the practical expedient method to amortize the investment cost, which approximates the proportional amortization method, over the 10-year tax credit period.

With the exception of QZAB and QSCB tax credits, all of the tax credits described above can be carried back one-year and carried forward 20 years if the credit cannot be fully used in the year the credits first become available for use. QZAB and QSCB tax credits generally can be carried forward indefinitely if they cannot be fully used in the year the credits are generated.

Retirement Benefits

The Company sponsors defined benefit pension plans and certain other defined benefit postretirement plans for eligible employees. The amounts reported in the consolidated financial statements with respect to these plans are based on actuarial valuations that incorporate various assumptions regarding future experience under the plans. Note 18 – Retirement Benefit Plans discusses the actuarial assumptions and provides information about the liabilities or assets recognized for the funded status of the Company’s obligations under these plans, the net benefit expense charged to current operations, and the amounts recognized as a component of other comprehensive income or loss and AOCI.

Share-Based Payment Arrangements

The grant date fair value of equity instruments awarded to employees and directors establishes the cost of the services received in exchange, and the cost associated with awards that are expected to vest is recognized over the requisite service period. Share-based compensation for service-based awards that contain a graded vesting schedule is recognized on a straight-line basis over the requisite

Table of Contents

service period for the entire award. Forfeitures of unvested awards are recognized in earnings in the period in which they occur. Refer to Note 19 – Share-Based Payment Arrangements for additional information.

Earnings (Loss) per Common Share

The Company computes earnings (loss) per share using the two-class method. The two-class method allocates net income to each class of common stock and participating security according to the common dividends declared and participation rights in undistributed earnings. For reporting periods in which a net loss is recorded, net loss is not allocated to participating securities because the holders of such securities bear no contractual obligation to fund or otherwise share in the loss. Participating securities currently consist of unvested share-based payment awards that contain nonforfeitable rights to dividends or dividend equivalents.

Basic earnings (loss) per common share is computed by dividing income or loss available to common shareholders by the weighted-average number of common shares outstanding for the applicable period. Shares outstanding exclude treasury shares and unvested share-based payment awards under long-term incentive compensation plans and directors’ compensation plans. Diluted earnings per common share is computed using the weighted-average number of common shares outstanding increased by (1) the number of shares in which employees would vest under performance-based stock awards and stock unit awards based on expected performance factors and (2) the number of additional shares that would have been issued if potentially dilutive stock options were exercised; each as determined using the treasury stock method. For reporting periods in which a net loss is recorded, no effect is given to potentially dilutive shares as the impact of such shares would be anti-dilutive.

Reportable Segment Disclosures

U.S. GAAP requires that information be reported about a company’s operating segments using a “management approach.” Reportable segments are identified in these standards as those revenue-producing components for which discrete financial information is produced internally and which are subject to evaluation by the chief operating decision maker in deciding how to allocate resources to segments. The Company’s stated strategy is to provide a consistent package of banking products and services throughout a coherent market area; as such, the Company has identified its overall banking operations as its only reportable segment. Because the overall banking operations comprise substantially all of the Company’s consolidated operations, no separate financial segment disclosures are presented. See additional segment disclosure information in Note 17 – Segment Reporting.

Other

Assets held by the Bank in a fiduciary capacity are not assets of the Bank and are not included in the Consolidated Balance Sheets.

RECENT ACCOUNTING PRONOUNCEMENTS

Accounting Standards Adopted in 2025

In December 2023, the FASB issued ASU 2023-09 "Income Taxes (Topic 740): Improvements to Income Tax Disclosures," to enhance the transparency and decision usefulness of income tax disclosures by requiring additional categories of information about federal, state, and foreign income taxes to be included in the rate reconciliation and by requiring more detail to be disclosed on certain reconciling item categories that meet a quantitative threshold. Additionally, the amendment requires all entities to annually disclose disaggregated information about income taxes paid using specific quantitative thresholds and income tax expense (or benefit) from continuing operations. The amendments in this update are effective for annual periods beginning after December 15, 2024. Entities should apply the amendments on a prospective basis and retrospective application is permitted. The Company has adopted the standard and elected to apply retrospective application. Refer to Note 15 – Income Taxes for the required disclosures. As the update contains only amendments to disclosure requirements, adoption of this standard had no impact to the Company’s consolidated results of operations or financial condition.

Accounting Standards Issued But Not Yet Adopted

In November 2024, the FASB issued ASU 2024-03, “Income Statement – Reporting Comprehensive Income – Expense Disaggregation Disclosures (Subtopic 220-40),” to improve the disclosures about a public business entity’s expenses in commonly presented expense captions. The amendments in this update require disclosure of specified information about certain costs and expenses in the notes to financial statements. Disclosure requirements also include a qualitative description of the amounts remaining in relevant expense captions that are not separately disaggregated quantitatively, among other items. An entity is not precluded from providing additional voluntary disclosures that may provide investors with additional decision-useful information. This update, as amended, is effective for annual reporting periods beginning after December 15, 2026, and interim periods within annual reporting periods beginning after December 15, 2027. Early adoption is permitted. The amendments in this update should be applied either prospectively to financial statements issued for reporting periods after the effective date of this update, or retrospectively to any or all prior periods presented in the financial statements. The Company is currently assessing the provisions of

Table of Contents

this guidance. As the update contains only amendments to disclosure requirements, adoption will have no impact to the Company’s consolidated results of operations or financial condition.

In September 2025, the FASB issued ASU 2025-06, “Intangibles – Goodwill and Other – Internal-Use Software (Subtopic 350-40): Targeted Improvements to the Accounting for Internal-Use Software,” to modernize the accounting for software costs that are accounted for under Subtopic 350-40. The amendments in this update remove all references to prescriptive and sequential software development stages in Subtopic 350-40 and instead require an entity to begin capitalizing software costs when both of the following occur: (1) management has authorized and committed to funding the software project, and (2) it is probable that the project will be completed and the software will be used to perform the function. The amendment also provides factors to consider when evaluating probable-to-complete recognition thresholds and specifies that the disclosures in Subtopic 360-10, “Property, Plant and Equipment,” are required for all capitalized internal-use software. Further, the amendment supersedes website development costs guidance and incorporates the recognition requirements in this subtopic. The amendments in this update are effective for all entities for annual reporting periods beginning after December 15, 2027, and interim reporting periods within those annual reporting periods. Early adoption is permitted as of the beginning of an annual reporting period. Entities may apply a prospective transition approach, a modified transition approach or a retrospective approach. The Company is currently assessing the provisions of this guidance, but does not expect adoption to have a material impact to the Company’s consolidated results of operations or financial condition.

In November 2025, the FASB issued ASU 2025-08, “Financial Instruments – Credit Losses (Topic 326): Purchased Loans,” to expand the population of acquired assets subject to the gross-up approach in Topic 326. Under the amendments in this update, loans (excluding credit cards) acquired without credit deterioration that are deemed “seasoned” are considered purchased seasoned loans and accounted for using the gross-up approach at acquisition. Non-purchased credit deteriorated loans (excluding credit cards) are seasoned if they are acquired in a business combination or were purchased at least 90 days after origination and the acquirer was not involved in the origination of the loans. Under the gross-up approach, the fair value discount is bifurcated between the credit and noncredit components, and the credit portion of the fair value discount is added to the initial amortized cost basis with a corresponding increase in the allowance for credit losses at the date of acquisition. Any noncredit premium or discount resulting from acquiring these seasoned loans is allocated to each individual asset and accreted or amortized to interest income using the effective yield method. Prior to this amendment, all non-purchased credit deteriorated loans acquired were recorded at the estimated fair value of the loan at acquisition, with the estimated allowance for credit loss recorded as a provision for credit losses through earnings in the period in which the acquisition occurred. The amendments in this update are effective for all entities for annual reporting periods beginning after December 15, 2026, and interim reporting periods within those annual reporting periods. The amendments should be applied prospectively to loans that are acquired on or after the initial application date. Early adoption is permitted in an interim or annual reporting period in which financial statements have not yet been issued or made available for issuance. The Company has elected to early adopt this standard as of January 1, 2026. As of the date of this filing there are no pending acquisitions, and therefore, the early adoption of this standard is not expected to have an impact on the Company’s consolidated results of operations or financial condition.

In November 2025, the FASB issued ASU 2025-09, “Derivative and Hedging (Topic 815): Hedge Accounting Improvements,” to clarify certain aspects of the guidance on hedge accounting and to address several incremental hedge accounting issues arising from the global reference rate reform initiative. The update addresses five issues: (1) the ability to group individual forecasted transactions in a cash flow hedge, modifying the term “shared risk exposure” to “similar risk exposure;” (2) the ability to apply cash flow hedge accounting to “choose your rate” debt instruments; (3) the application of cash flow hedge accounting to forecasted purchases and sales of nonfinancial assets; (4) the use of net written options has hedging instruments; and (5) the mechanics of assessing hedge effectiveness for foreign-currency-denominated dual hedge strategies. This update is effective for public business entities in the interim and annual reporting periods beginning after December 15, 2026, with early adoptions permitted. Entities should apply the amendments on a prospective basis for all hedging relationships. An entity may elect to adopt the amendments for hedging relationships that exist as of the date of adoption. Upon adoption, entities are permitted to modify certain critical terms of certain existing hedging relationships without dedesignating the hedge. The Company is currently assessing the provisions of this guidance but does not expect adoption to have a material impact to the Company’s consolidated results of operations or financial condition.

In December 2025, the FASB issued ASU 2025-11, “Interim Reporting (Topic 270): Narrow Scope Improvements," to improve interim reporting guidance in Topic 270 by improving the navigability of the required interim disclosures, clarifying when that guidance is applicable, and providing additional guidance on what disclosures should be provided in interim reporting periods. This update reorganizes and clarifies interim reporting guidance without expanding disclosure requirements. Key provisions include clarification of entities in scope of ASC 270, updates to the form and content requirements for condensed interim financial statements, and a new disclosure principle requiring disclosure of material events since year-end. This update is effective for public entities for interim reporting periods within annual reporting periods beginning after December 15, 2027, with early adoption permitted. The amendments in this update can be applied either prospectively or retrospectively to any or all prior periods presented in the financial statements. The Company is currently assessing the provisions of this guidance. As the update contains only

Table of Contents

clarification of disclosure requirements, adoption will have no impact to the Company’s consolidated results of operations or financial condition.

2. Acquisition

On May 2, 2025, the Company acquired net assets of Sabal Trust Company (“Sabal”) with cash consideration. Sabal was the largest independent, employee-owned non-depository trust company in Florida and provides trust administration, investment management, retirement planning, estate settlement, and family office services. The acquisition provides the opportunity to expand market share of the Company’s investment management and trust business in certain high-growth markets in Central Florida. The transaction was accounted for as a business combination.

The following table sets forth the preliminary acquisition date fair value of the assets acquired and the liabilities assumed, the consideration paid, and the resulting goodwill as of December 31, 2025.

ASSETS
Cash and due from banks $ 2,417
Property and equipment 1,048
Right of use assets 5,047
Identifiable intangible assets 41,800
Other assets 1,191
Total identifiable assets 51,503
LIABILITIES
Lease liabilities 4,709
Other liabilities 2,257
Total liabilities 6,966
Net assets acquired 44,537
Consideration paid 114,488
Goodwill $ 69,951

Identifiable intangible assets include customer relationships that are being amortized using an accelerated method based on forecasted cash flows over a useful life of approximately 24 years. Goodwill represents the excess of consideration paid over the fair value of the net assets acquired and is comprised of the estimated future economic benefits arising from the transaction that cannot be individually identified or do not qualify for separate recognition. These benefits include expanded presence in existing markets, operational expertise and synergies. The resulting goodwill is deductible for federal income tax purposes.

The operating results of the Company for fiscal year ended December 31, 2025 include the results from the operations of the acquired trust and asset management business from the date of acquisition. The results are not material to the Company’s results of operations and, as such, supplemental proforma financial information is not presented. During year ended December 31, 2025, the Company incurred acquisition-related costs of approximately $5.9 million, primarily in the data processing, professional services, and personnel expense line items in the Consolidated Statements of Income.

Note 3. Securities

The following tables set forth the amortized cost, gross unrealized gains and losses, and estimated fair value of debt securities classified as available for sale and held to maturity at December 31, 2025 and 2024. Amortized cost of securities does not include accrued interest which is reflected in the accrued interest line item on the consolidated balance sheets totaling $31.7 million and $29.8 million at December 31, 2025 and December 31, 2024, respectively.

Table of Contents

Securities Available for Sale
December 31, 2025 December 31, 2024
Gross Gross Gross Gross
Amortized Unrealized Unrealized Fair Amortized Unrealized Unrealized Fair
($ in thousands) Cost Gains Losses Value Cost Gains Losses Value
U.S. Treasury and government agency<br>   securities $ 266,825 $ 3,705 $ 1,198 $ 269,332 $ 185,827 $ 349 $ 3,894 $ 182,282
Municipal obligations 191,754 82 508 191,328 200,272 3,942 196,330
Residential mortgage-backed securities 2,620,980 11,643 256,994 2,375,629 2,482,109 496 353,554 2,129,051
Commercial mortgage-backed securities 3,217,663 10,530 144,868 3,083,325 2,849,372 2,185 250,592 2,600,965
Collateralized mortgage obligations 27,100 1,154 25,946 37,553 2,306 35,247
Corporate debt securities 17,000 37 680 16,357 19,000 1,384 17,616
Total $ 6,341,322 $ 25,997 $ 405,402 $ 5,961,917 $ 5,774,133 $ 3,030 $ 615,672 $ 5,161,491
Securities Held to Maturity
--- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- ---
December 31, 2025 December 31, 2024
Gross Gross Gross Gross
Amortized Unrealized Unrealized Fair Amortized Unrealized Unrealized Fair
($ in thousands) Cost Gains Losses Value Cost Gains Losses Value
U.S. Treasury and government agency<br>   securities $ 373,605 $ 248 $ 30,143 $ 343,710 $ 394,689 $ $ 45,876 $ 348,813
Municipal obligations 511,516 708 11,455 500,769 623,907 169 20,867 603,209
Residential mortgage-backed securities 497,338 34,239 463,099 573,057 61,525 511,532
Commercial mortgage-backed securities 731,329 46,455 684,874 818,604 72,854 745,750
Collateralized mortgage obligations 19,094 520 18,574 25,406 1,184 24,222
Total $ 2,132,882 $ 956 $ 122,812 $ 2,011,026 $ 2,435,663 $ 169 $ 202,306 $ 2,233,526

The Company held no securities classified as trading at December 31, 2025 or 2024.

The following tables present the amortized cost and fair value of debt securities available for sale and held to maturity at December 31, 2025 by contractual maturity. Actual maturities will differ from contractual maturities because of rights to call or repay obligations with or without penalties and scheduled and unscheduled principal payments on mortgage-backed securities and collateral mortgage obligations.

($ in thousands) Amortized<br>Cost Fair<br>Value
Debt Securities Available for Sale
Due in one year or less $ 31,996 $ 32,084
Due after one year through five years 1,766,369 1,711,795
Due after five years through ten years 1,829,382 1,743,201
Due after ten years 2,713,575 2,474,837
Total available for sale debt securities $ 6,341,322 $ 5,961,917
($ in thousands) Amortized<br>Cost Fair<br>Value
--- --- --- --- ---
Debt Securities Held to Maturity
Due in one year or less $ 141,124 $ 140,203
Due after one year through five years 666,314 648,904
Due after five years through ten years 475,596 452,476
Due after ten years 849,848 769,443
Total held to maturity debt securities $ 2,132,882 $ 2,011,026

Table of Contents

The following table presents the proceeds from, gross gains on, and gross losses on sales of securities during the years ended December 31, 2025, 2024 and 2023. Net gains or losses are reflected in the "Securities transactions, net" line item on the Consolidated Statements of Income.

Years Ended December 31,
($ in thousands) 2025 2024 2023
Proceeds $ 229,200 $ $ 977,114
Gross gains 4,197
Gross losses 4,208 65,380

Securities with carrying values totaling approximately $3.9 billion at both December 31, 2025 and December 31, 2024 were pledged as collateral, primarily to secure public deposits or securities sold under agreements to repurchase.

Credit Quality

The Company’s policy is to invest only in securities of investment grade quality. These investments are largely limited to U.S. agency securities and municipal securities. Management has concluded, based on the long history of no credit losses, that the expectation of nonpayment of the held to maturity securities carried at amortized cost is zero for securities that are backed by the full faith and credit of and/or guaranteed by the U.S. government. As such, no allowance for credit losses has been recorded for these securities. The municipal portfolio is analyzed separately for allowance for credit loss in accordance with the applicable guidance for each portfolio as noted below.

The Company evaluates credit impairment for individual securities available for sale whose fair value was below amortized cost with a more than inconsequential risk of default and where the Company had assessed whether the decline in fair value was significant enough to suggest a credit event occurred. There were no securities with a material credit loss event and therefore, no allowance for credit loss was recorded in any period presented.

The fair value and gross unrealized losses for securities classified as available for sale with unrealized losses at December 31, 2025 are presented in the table below.

Available for sale
December 31, 2025
Losses < 12 Months Losses 12 Months or > Total
Gross Gross Gross
Fair Unrealized Fair Unrealized Fair Unrealized
($ in thousands) Value Losses Value Losses Value Losses
U.S. Treasury and government agency securities $ 17,468 $ 9 $ 14,677 $ 1,189 $ 32,145 $ 1,198
Municipal obligations 124,852 508 124,852 508
Residential mortgage-backed securities 54,250 598 1,442,746 256,396 1,496,996 256,994
Commercial mortgage-backed securities 374,740 1,787 2,158,865 143,081 2,533,605 144,868
Collateralized mortgage obligations 25,946 1,154 25,946 1,154
Corporate debt securities 1,998 2 11,322 678 13,320 680
Total $ 448,456 $ 2,396 $ 3,778,408 $ 403,006 $ 4,226,864 $ 405,402

The fair value and gross unrealized losses for securities classified as available for sale with unrealized losses at December 31, 2024 are presented in the table below.

Available for sale
December 31, 2024
Losses < 12 Months Losses 12 Months or > Total
Gross Gross Gross
Fair Unrealized Fair Unrealized Fair Unrealized
($ in thousands) Value Losses Value Losses Value Losses
U.S. Treasury and government agency securities $ 130,453 $ 2,243 $ 7,247 $ 1,651 $ 137,700 $ 3,894
Municipal obligations 24,149 247 170,110 3,695 194,259 3,942
Residential mortgage-backed securities 347,772 2,935 1,554,001 350,619 1,901,773 353,554
Commercial mortgage-backed securities 184,534 2,738 2,139,191 247,854 2,323,725 250,592
Collateralized mortgage obligations 35,247 2,306 35,247 2,306
Corporate debt securities 15,616 1,384 15,616 1,384
Total $ 686,908 $ 8,163 $ 3,921,412 $ 607,509 $ 4,608,320 $ 615,672

Table of Contents

At each reporting period, the Company evaluated its held to maturity municipal obligation portfolio for credit loss using probability of default and loss given default models. The models were run using a long-term average probability of default migration and with a probability weighting of Moody’s economic forecasts. The resulting credit losses, if any, were negligible and no allowance for credit loss was recorded.

The fair value and gross unrealized losses for securities classified as held to maturity with unrealized losses at December 31, 2025 are presented in the table below.

Held to maturity
December 31, 2025
Losses < 12 Months Losses 12 Months or > Total
Gross Gross Gross
Fair Unrealized Fair Unrealized Fair Unrealized
($ in thousands) Value Losses Value Losses Value Losses
U.S. Treasury and government agency securities $ $ $ 316,814 $ 30,143 $ 316,814 $ 30,143
Municipal obligations 98,559 97 325,241 11,358 423,800 11,455
Residential mortgage-backed securities 463,099 34,239 463,099 34,239
Commercial mortgage-backed securities 684,874 46,455 684,874 46,455
Collateralized mortgage obligations 18,574 520 18,574 520
Total $ 98,559 $ 97 $ 1,808,602 $ 122,715 $ 1,907,161 $ 122,812

The fair value and gross unrealized losses for securities classified as held to maturity with unrealized losses at December 31, 2024 are presented in the table below.

Held to maturity December 31, 2024
Losses < 12 Months Losses 12 Months or > Total
Gross Gross Gross
Fair Unrealized Fair Unrealized Fair Unrealized
($ in thousands) Value Losses Value Losses Value Losses
U.S. Treasury and government agency securities $ 27,660 $ 840 $ 321,154 $ 45,036 $ 348,814 $ 45,876
Municipal obligations 82,028 451 497,999 20,416 580,027 20,867
Residential mortgage-backed securities 511,531 61,525 511,531 61,525
Commercial mortgage-backed securities 745,750 72,854 745,750 72,854
Collateralized mortgage obligations 24,222 1,184 24,222 1,184
Total $ 109,688 $ 1,291 $ 2,100,656 $ 201,015 $ 2,210,344 $ 202,306

At December 31, 2025 and 2024, the Company had 604 and 729 securities, respectively, with market values below their cost basis. There were no material unrealized losses related to the marketability of the securities or the issuer’s ability to meet contractual obligations. In all cases, the indicated impairment on these debt securities would be recovered no later than the security’s maturity date or possibly earlier if the market price for the security increases with a reduction in the yield required by the market. The unrealized losses were deemed to be non-credit related at December 31, 2025 and 2024. At December 31, 2025, the Company had adequate liquidity and, therefore, neither planned nor expected to be required to liquidate these securities before recovery of the amortized cost basis.

Note 4. Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses

The Company generally makes loans in its market areas of southern and central Mississippi; southern and central Alabama; northwest, central and southern Louisiana; the northern, central and panhandle regions of Florida; certain areas of east and northeast Texas; and the metropolitan areas of Nashville, Tennessee and Atlanta, Georgia. In addition, and to a lesser degree, the Bank makes loans both regionally and nationally, generally through its specialty lines of business, including the equipment finance, commercial real estate and healthcare segments, often with sponsors in our market areas.

The following table presents loans at their amortized cost basis, by portfolio class at December 31, 2025 and December 31, 2024. The amortized cost basis is net of unearned income and excludes accrued interest totaling $105.1 million and $109.8 million at

Table of Contents

December 31, 2025 and 2024, respectively. Accrued interest is reflected in the accrued interest line item in the Consolidated Balance Sheets.

December 31,
($ in thousands) 2025 2024
Commercial non-real estate $ 9,809,011 $ 9,876,592
Commercial real estate - owner occupied 3,270,080 3,011,955
Total commercial and industrial 13,079,091 12,888,547
Commercial real estate - income producing 4,283,168 3,798,612
Construction and land development 1,239,086 1,281,115
Residential mortgages 4,016,917 3,961,328
Consumer 1,340,178 1,369,845
Total loans $ 23,958,440 $ 23,299,447

The following briefly describes the composition of each loan category and portfolio class.

Commercial and industrial

Commercial and industrial loans are made available to businesses for working capital (including financing of inventory and receivables), for business expansion, facilitating the acquisition of a business, and for the purchase of equipment and machinery, including equipment leasing. These loans are primarily made based on the identified cash flows of the borrower and, when secured, have the added strength of the underlying collateral.

Commercial non-real estate loans may be secured by the assets being financed or other tangible or intangible business assets such as accounts receivable, inventory, ownership, enterprise value or commodity interests, and may incorporate a personal or corporate guarantee; however, some short-term loans may be made on an unsecured basis, including a small portfolio of corporate credit cards, generally issued as a part of overall customer relationships.

Commercial real estate – owner occupied loans consist of commercial mortgages on properties where repayment is generally dependent on the cash flow from the ongoing operations and activities of the borrower. Like commercial non-real estate, these loans are primarily made based on the identified cash flows of the borrower, but also have the added strength of the value of underlying real estate collateral.

Commercial real estate – income producing

Commercial real estate – income producing loans consist of loans secured by commercial mortgages on properties where the loan is made to real estate developers or investors and repayment is dependent on the sale, refinance, or income generated from the operation of the property. Properties financed include multifamily, retail, healthcare related facilities, industrial, office, hotel/motel and restaurants, and other commercial properties.

Construction and land development

Construction and land development loans are made to facilitate the acquisition, development, improvement and construction of both commercial and residential-purpose properties. Such loans are made to builders and investors where repayment is expected to be made from the sale, refinance or operation of the property or to businesses to be used in their business operations. This portfolio also includes residential construction loans and loans secured by raw land not yet under development.

Residential mortgages

Residential mortgages consist of closed-end loans secured by first liens on 1- 4 family residential properties. The portfolio includes both fixed and adjustable-rate loans, although most longer-term, fixed-rate loans originated are sold in the secondary mortgage market.

Consumer

Consumer loans include second lien mortgage home loans, home equity lines of credit and nonresidential consumer purpose loans. Nonresidential consumer loans are made to finance the purchase of personal property, including automobiles, recreational vehicles and boats, and for other personal purposes (secured and unsecured), and also include deposit account secured loans. Consumer loans also include a small portfolio of credit card receivables issued on the basis of applications received through referrals from the Bank’s branches, online and other marketing efforts.

Table of Contents

The Bank makes loans in the normal course of business to directors and executive officers of the Company and the Bank and to their associates. Loans to such related parties were approximately $38.9 million and $46.2 million at December 31, 2025 and 2024, respectively. Related party loan activity in 2025 reflects new loans of $23.1 million, repayments of $30.2 million, and a net decrease of $0.2 million related to changes in directors and executive officers and their associates.

The Bank has a line of credit with the Federal Home Loan Bank of Dallas that is secured by blanket pledges of certain qualifying loan types. The Bank had $400 million borrowings on this line at December 31, 2025 and no borrowings at December 31, 2024.

The following schedules show activity in the allowance for credit losses by portfolio class for the years ended December 31, 2025, 2024 and 2023, as well as the allowance for credit loss by primary calculation method at the end of each period.

Commercial Non-Real Estate Commercial Real Estate-Owner Occupied Total Commercial and Industrial Commercial Real Estate-Income Producing Construction and Land Development Residential Mortgages Consumer Total
($ in thousands) Year Ended December 31, 2025
Allowance for credit losses
Allowance for loan losses:
Beginning balance $ 121,090 $ 36,264 $ 157,354 $ 71,975 $ 21,158 $ 42,445 $ 25,950 $ 318,882
Charge-offs (45,564 ) (4,626 ) (50,190 ) (34 ) (1,314 ) (922 ) (16,006 ) (68,466 )
Recoveries 11,332 686 12,018 49 123 841 2,976 16,007
Net provision for loan losses 34,581 8,371 42,952 (11,515 ) (2,517 ) 470 11,918 41,308
Ending balance - allowance for loan losses $ 121,439 $ 40,695 $ 162,134 $ 60,475 $ 17,450 $ 42,834 $ 24,838 $ 307,731
Reserve for unfunded lending commitments:
Beginning balance $ 6,441 $ 309 $ 6,750 $ 642 $ 14,639 $ 4 $ 2,018 $ 24,053
Provision for losses on unfunded<br>   commitments 6,198 62 6,260 363 3,310 (1 ) (57 ) 9,875
Ending balance - reserve for unfunded<br>   lending commitments $ 12,639 $ 371 $ 13,010 $ 1,005 $ 17,949 $ 3 $ 1,961 $ 33,928
Total allowance for credit losses $ 134,078 $ 41,066 $ 175,144 $ 61,480 $ 35,399 $ 42,837 $ 26,799 $ 341,659
Allowance for credit losses:
Individually evaluated $ 6,506 $ 602 $ 7,108 $ $ $ 236 $ 54 $ 7,398
Collectively evaluated $ 127,572 $ 40,464 $ 168,036 $ 61,480 $ 35,399 $ 42,601 $ 26,745 $ 334,261
Commercial Non-Real Estate Commercial Real Estate-Owner Occupied Total Commercial and Industrial Commercial Real Estate-Income Producing Construction and Land Development Residential Mortgages Consumer Total
--- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- ---
($ in thousands) Year Ended December 31, 2024
Allowance for credit losses
Allowance for loan losses:
Beginning balance $ 101,737 $ 40,197 $ 141,934 $ 74,539 $ 27,039 $ 38,983 $ 25,412 $ 307,907
Charge-offs (45,488 ) (143 ) (45,631 ) (8,822 ) (264 ) (380 ) (17,987 ) (73,084 )
Recoveries 22,292 1,036 23,328 7 64 595 3,057 27,051
Net provision for loan losses 42,549 (4,826 ) 37,723 6,251 (5,681 ) 3,247 15,468 57,008
Ending balance - allowance for loan losses $ 121,090 $ 36,264 $ 157,354 $ 71,975 $ 21,158 $ 42,445 $ 25,950 $ 318,882
Reserve for unfunded lending commitments:
Beginning balance $ 5,507 $ 327 $ 5,834 $ 1,344 $ 20,019 $ 30 $ 1,667 $ 28,894
Provision for losses on unfunded<br>   commitments 934 (18 ) 916 (702 ) (5,380 ) (26 ) 351 (4,841 )
Ending balance - reserve for unfunded<br>   lending commitments $ 6,441 $ 309 $ 6,750 $ 642 $ 14,639 $ 4 $ 2,018 $ 24,053
Total allowance for credit losses $ 127,531 $ 36,573 $ 164,104 $ 72,617 $ 35,797 $ 42,449 $ 27,968 $ 342,935
Allowance for credit losses:
Individually evaluated $ 8,672 $ $ 8,672 $ $ $ 751 $ 197 $ 9,620
Collectively evaluated $ 118,859 $ 36,573 $ 155,432 $ 72,617 $ 35,797 $ 41,698 $ 27,771 $ 333,315

Table of Contents

Commercial Non-Real Estate Commercial Real Estate-Owner Occupied Total Commercial and Industrial Commercial Real Estate-Income Producing Construction and Land Development Residential Mortgages Consumer Total
($ in thousands) Year Ended December 31, 2023
Allowance for credit losses
Allowance for loan losses:
Beginning balance $ 96,461 $ 48,284 $ 144,745 $ 71,961 $ 30,498 $ 32,464 $ 28,121 $ 307,789
Charge-offs (59,830 ) (59,830 ) (73 ) (72 ) (55 ) (15,393 ) (75,423 )
Recoveries 6,152 957 7,109 14 11 1,278 3,611 12,023
Net provision for loan losses 58,954 (9,044 ) 49,910 2,637 (3,398 ) 5,296 9,073 63,518
Ending balance - allowance for loan losses $ 101,737 $ 40,197 $ 141,934 $ 74,539 $ 27,039 $ 38,983 $ 25,412 $ 307,907
Reserve for unfunded lending commitments:
Beginning balance $ 4,984 $ 302 $ 5,286 $ 1,395 $ 25,110 $ 31 $ 1,487 $ 33,309
Provision for losses on unfunded<br>   commitments 523 25 548 (51 ) (5,091 ) (1 ) 180 (4,415 )
Ending balance - reserve for unfunded<br>   lending commitments $ 5,507 $ 327 $ 5,834 $ 1,344 $ 20,019 $ 30 $ 1,667 $ 28,894
Total allowance for credit losses $ 107,244 $ 40,524 $ 147,768 $ 75,883 $ 47,058 $ 39,013 $ 27,079 $ 336,801
Allowance for credit losses:
Individually evaluated $ 1,666 $ $ 1,666 $ $ $ $ $ 1,666
Collectively evaluated $ 105,578 $ 40,524 $ 146,102 $ 75,883 $ 47,058 $ 39,013 $ 27,079 $ 335,135

The calculation of the allowance for credit losses is performed using two primary approaches: a collective approach for pools of loans that have similar risk characteristics using a loss rate analysis, and a specific reserve analysis for credits individually evaluated. The allowance for credit losses for collectively evaluated portfolios is developed using multiple Moody’s macroeconomic forecasts applied to internally developed credit models for a two year reasonable and supportable period. These forecasts are anchored on a baseline economic forecast, which Moody’s defines as the “most likely outcome” based on current conditions and its view of where the economy is headed. The baseline scenario is positioned at the 50th percentile of possible outcomes. Several upside and downside alternative scenarios are also derived from that baseline scenario and considered when assessing reasonably possible outcomes.

The modest decrease in the allowance for credit losses at December 31, 2025 compared to December 31, 2024 reflects net decline in funded reserves, largely offset by an increase in unfunded reserves. In arriving at the allowance for credit losses at December 31, 2025, the Company weighted Moody’s December 2025 baseline economic forecast at 50% and downside mild recessionary S-2 scenario at 50%. The December 2025 baseline scenario maintains a generally optimistic outlook in its assumptions surrounding the drivers of economic growth, with no recession forecasted in the near-term. The S-2 scenario is less optimistic compared to the baseline with a mild recession forecasted starting in the first quarter of 2026 and lasting for three quarters.

The modest changes in the allowance for credit losses for the years ended December 31, 2024 and 2023 both reflected relatively stable economic conditions, outlook and credit quality metrics. In arriving at the allowance for credit losses at December 31, 2024 and December 31, 2023, the Company weighted the baseline economic forecast at 40%, the downside recessionary scenario S-2 at 60%.

Nonaccrual Loans and Certain Reportable Modified Loan Disclosures

The following table shows the composition of nonaccrual loans and those without an allowance for loan losses, by portfolio class at December 31, 2025 and 2024.

December 31,
2025 2024
($ in thousands) Total<br>Nonaccrual Nonaccrual<br>Without<br>Allowance For<br>Loan Losses Total<br>Nonaccrual Nonaccrual<br>Without<br>Allowance For<br>Loan Losses
Commercial non-real estate $ 34,525 $ 3,294 $ 33,418 $ 4,855
Commercial real estate - owner occupied 6,723 1,470 2,727 1,198
Total commercial and industrial 41,248 4,764 36,145 6,053
Commercial real estate - income producing 4,760 5,114 356
Construction and land development 3,173 2,178 5,561 4,929
Residential mortgages 46,986 2,511 44,086 1,475
Consumer 10,703 316 11,187 500
Total loans $ 106,870 $ 14,883 $ 97,335 $ 12,957

Table of Contents

As a part of our loss mitigation efforts, we may provide modifications to borrowers experiencing financial difficulty to improve long-term collectability of the loans and to avoid the need for repossession or foreclosure of collateral. Nonaccrual loans include reportable nonaccruing modified loans to borrowers experiencing financial difficulty (MEFDs) of $5.8 million at December 31, 2025 and $20.2 million at December 31, 2024. Total reportable MEFDs, both accruing and nonaccruing, were $162.8 million at December 31, 2025 and $99.5 million at December 31, 2024. Unfunded commitments to borrowers whose terms have been modified as a reportable MEFD were $7.2 million and $6.9 million at December 31, 2025 and 2024, respectively.

The tables below provide detail by portfolio class for reportable MEFDs entered into during the years ended December 31, 2025 2024 and 2023. Modified facilities are reported using the balance at the end of each period reported and are reflected only once in each table based on the type of modification or combination of modification.

Year Ended December 31, 2025
Term Extension Payment Delay Term Extensions and Payment Delay Other(1)
($ in thousands) Balance Percentage of Portfolio Balance Percentage of Portfolio Balance Percentage of Portfolio Balance Percentage of Portfolio
Commercial non-real estate $ 94,293 0.96 % $ 4,529 0.05 % $ 4,493 0.05 % $
Commercial real estate - owner occupied 28,698 0.88 % 241 0.01 %
Total commercial and industrial 122,991 0.94 % 4,770 0.04 % 4,493 0.03 %
Commercial real estate - income producing 14,914 0.35 %
Construction and land development 147 0.01 %
Residential mortgages 11,173 0.28 % 1,319 0.03 % 2,065 0.05 % 602 0.01 %
Consumer 132 0.01 % 148 0.01 % 95 0.01 %
Total reportable modified loans $ 149,357 0.62 % $ 6,089 0.03 % $ 6,706 0.03 % $ 697 0.00 %

(1) Includes interest rate reduction and a combination of interest rate reduction and term extension.

Year Ended December 31, 2024
Term Extension Payment Delay Term Extensions and Payment Delay Other(1)
($ in thousands) Balance Percentage of Portfolio Balance Percentage of Portfolio Balance Percentage of Portfolio Balance Percentage of Portfolio
Commercial non-real estate $ 58,176 0.59 % $ 19,150 0.19 % $ 15,373 0.16 % $ 758 0.01 %
Commercial real estate - owner occupied
Total commercial and industrial 58,176 0.45 % 19,150 0.15 % 15,373 0.12 % 758 0.01 %
Commercial real estate - income producing 2,741 0.07 %
Construction and land development
Residential mortgages 3,170 0.08 %
Consumer 131 0.01 %
Total reportable modified loans $ 64,218 0.28 % $ 19,150 0.08 % $ 15,373 0.07 % $ 758 0.00 %

(1) Includes interest rate reduction and other than insignificant payment delays.

Year Ended December 31, 2023
Term Extension Payment Delay Term Extensions and Payment Delay Other(1)
($ in thousands) Balance Percentage of Portfolio Balance Percentage of Portfolio Balance Percentage of Portfolio Balance Percentage of Portfolio
Commercial non-real estate $ 7,930 0.08 % $ 4,274 0.04 % $ 9,753 0.10 % $
Commercial real estate - owner occupied 1,774 0.06 %
Total commercial and industrial 9,704 0.07 % 4,274 0.03 % 9,753 0.07 %
Commercial real estate - income producing
Construction and land development 85 0.01 %
Residential mortgages 254 0.01 % 202 0.01 %
Consumer 78 0.01 % 196 0.01 %
Total reportable modified loans $ 10,121 0.04 % $ 4,274 0.02 % $ 9,949 0.04 % $ 202 0.00 %

(1) Includes interest rate reduction and other than insignificant payment delays.

Reportable modifications to borrowers experiencing financial difficulty during the year ended December 31, 2025 consisted of weighted-average term extensions totaling ten months for the commercial portfolio, two years for the residential mortgage portfolio and three years for the consumer portfolio. The weighted-average term of other than insignificant payment delays was six months for

Table of Contents

the commercial portfolio, eight months for the residential mortgage portfolio and seven months for the consumer portfolio. The weighted-average interest rate reduction for the residential and consumer portfolio was 240 and 125 basis points, respectively. Reported term extensions and payment delays are considered more than insignificant if they exceeded six months when considering other modifications made in the past twelve months.

Reportable modifications to borrowers experiencing financial difficulty during the year ended December 31, 2024 consisted of weighted-average term extensions totaling nine months for the commercial portfolio, six years for the residential mortgage portfolio and four years for the consumer portfolio. The weighted-average term of other than insignificant payment delays for the commercial portfolio was eight months. The weighted-average interest rate reduction for the commercial portfolio was 50 basis points.

Reportable modifications to borrowers experiencing financial difficulty during the year ended December 31, 2023 consisted of weighted-average term extensions totaling ten months for commercial, ten years for residential mortgage and eight years for consumer. The weighted-average term of other than insignificant payment delays for the commercial and consumer portfolios was three months. The weighted-average interest rate reduction for the residential mortgage portfolio was 80 basis points.

The tables below present the aging analysis of reportable modifications to borrowers experiencing financial difficulty by portfolio class at December 31, 2025 and 2024.

December 31, 2025 30-59<br>Days<br>Past Due 60-89<br>Days<br>Past Due Greater<br>Than<br>90 Days<br>Past Due Total<br>Past Due Current Total Reportable <br>Modified Loans
(in thousands)
Commercial non-real estate $ $ 27,670 $ 734 $ 28,404 $ 74,911 $ 103,315
Commercial real estate - owner occupied 28,939 28,939
Total commercial and industrial 27,670 734 28,404 103,850 132,254
Commercial real estate - income producing 14,914 14,914
Construction and land development 147 147
Residential mortgages 1,285 416 1,701 13,458 15,159
Consumer 148 148 227 375
Total reportable modified loans $ 1,285 $ 28,086 $ 882 $ 30,253 $ 132,596 $ 162,849
December 31, 2024 30-59<br>Days<br>Past Due 60-89<br>Days<br>Past Due Greater<br>Than<br>90 Days<br>Past Due Total<br>Past Due Current Total Reportable <br>Modified Loans
--- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- ---
(in thousands)
Commercial non-real estate $ 1,975 $ $ 12,548 $ 14,523 $ 78,934 $ 93,457
Commercial real estate - owner occupied
Total commercial and industrial 1,975 12,548 14,523 78,934 93,457
Commercial real estate - income producing 826 826 1,915 2,741
Construction and land development
Residential mortgages 179 249 501 929 2,241 3,170
Consumer 131 131
Total reportable modified loans $ 2,154 $ 1,075 $ 13,049 $ 16,278 $ 83,221 $ 99,499

There were seven loans to commercial borrowers totaling $27.6 million and two loans to consumer borrowers totaling $0.2 million with a reportable term extension and/or significant payment delay modification that had post modification payment defaults during the twelve months ended December 31, 2025. There were loans to seven commercial borrowers totaling $20.8 million and loans to three residential mortgage borrowers totaling $0.8 million with a reportable term extension and/or significant payment delay modification that had post modification payment defaults during the twelve months ended December 31, 2024. There was one loan to a commercial borrower totaling $4.4 million with a reportable term extension and significant payment delay modification that had a post modification payment default during the twelve months ended December 31, 2023. A payment default occurs if the loan is either 90 days or more delinquent or has been charged off as of the end of the period presented.

Table of Contents

Aging Analysis

The tables below present the aging analysis of past due loans by portfolio class at December 31, 2025 and 2024.

December 31, 2025 60-89<br>Days<br>Past Due Greater<br>Than<br>90 Days<br>Past Due Total <br>Past Due Current Total<br>Loans Recorded <br>Investment<br>> 90 Days<br>and Accruing
( in thousands)
Commercial non-real estate 19,008 $ 43,316 $ 39,954 $ 102,278 $ 9,706,733 $ 9,809,011 $ 20,358
Commercial real estate - owner occupied 15,013 308 7,609 22,930 3,247,150 3,270,080 1,586
Total commercial and industrial 34,021 43,624 47,563 125,208 12,953,883 13,079,091 21,944
Commercial real estate - income producing 990 2,806 7,177 10,973 4,272,195 4,283,168 2,928
Construction and land development 1,754 564 3,488 5,806 1,233,280 1,239,086 565
Residential mortgages 42,302 17,984 34,656 94,942 3,921,975 4,016,917 116
Consumer 9,284 4,675 9,839 23,798 1,316,380 1,340,178 3,245
Total loans 88,351 $ 69,653 $ 102,723 $ 260,727 $ 23,697,713 $ 23,958,440 $ 28,798

All values are in US Dollars.

December 31, 2024 60-89<br>Days<br>Past Due Greater<br>Than<br>90 Days<br>Past Due Total <br>Past Due Current Total<br>Loans Recorded <br>Investment<br>> 90 Days<br>and Accruing
( in thousands)
Commercial non-real estate 19,326 $ 5,264 $ 27,756 $ 52,346 $ 9,824,246 $ 9,876,592 $ 14,557
Commercial real estate - owner occupied 1,113 38 3,747 4,898 3,007,057 3,011,955 1,097
Total commercial and industrial 20,439 5,302 31,503 57,244 12,831,303 12,888,547 15,654
Commercial real estate - income producing 220 5,417 464 6,101 3,792,511 3,798,612 150
Construction and land development 1,066 3,773 5,314 10,153 1,270,962 1,281,115 3,563
Residential mortgages 42,211 25,050 34,113 101,374 3,859,954 3,961,328 27
Consumer 10,770 5,381 8,504 24,655 1,345,190 1,369,845 2,458
Total loans 74,706 $ 44,923 $ 79,898 $ 199,527 $ 23,099,920 $ 23,299,447 $ 21,852

All values are in US Dollars.

Credit Quality Indicators

The following tables present the credit quality indicators by segment and portfolio class of loans at December 31, 2025 and 2024.

December 31, 2025
($ in thousands) Commercial Non-<br>Real Estate Commercial Real<br>Estate - Owner<br>Occupied Total Commercial<br>and Industrial Commercial Real<br>Estate - Income<br>Producing Construction and<br>Land Development Total Commercial
Grade:
Pass $ 9,180,624 $ 3,064,325 $ 12,244,949 $ 4,035,415 $ 1,170,834 $ 17,451,198
Pass-Watch 266,120 123,373 389,493 189,994 35,305 614,792
Special Mention 88,729 23,195 111,924 8,251 28,208 148,383
Substandard 273,538 59,187 332,725 49,508 4,739 386,972
Doubtful
Total $ 9,809,011 $ 3,270,080 $ 13,079,091 $ 4,283,168 $ 1,239,086 $ 18,601,345
December 31, 2024
--- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- ---
($ in thousands) Commercial Non-<br>Real Estate Commercial Real<br>Estate - Owner<br>Occupied Total Commercial<br>and Industrial Commercial Real<br>Estate - Income<br>Producing Construction and<br>Land Development Total Commercial
Grade:
Pass $ 9,157,232 $ 2,833,228 $ 11,990,460 $ 3,625,981 $ 1,207,404 $ 16,823,845
Pass-Watch 219,975 135,566 355,541 99,638 66,221 521,400
Special Mention 149,705 17,901 167,606 22,278 1,014 190,898
Substandard 349,680 25,260 374,940 50,715 6,476 432,131
Doubtful
Total $ 9,876,592 $ 3,011,955 $ 12,888,547 $ 3,798,612 $ 1,281,115 $ 17,968,274

Table of Contents

December 31, 2025 December 31, 2024
($ in thousands) Residential<br>Mortgage Consumer Total Residential<br>Mortgage Consumer Total
Performing $ 3,969,931 $ 1,329,475 $ 5,299,406 $ 3,917,242 $ 1,358,658 $ 5,275,900
Nonperforming 46,986 10,703 57,689 44,086 11,187 55,273
Total $ 4,016,917 $ 1,340,178 $ 5,357,095 $ 3,961,328 $ 1,369,845 $ 5,331,173

The Company routinely assesses the ratings of loans in its portfolio through an established and comprehensive portfolio management process. Below are the definitions of the Company’s internally assigned grades:

Commercial:

  • Pass - loans properly approved, documented, collateralized, and performing which do not reflect an abnormal credit risk.
  • Pass - Watch - credits in this category are of sufficient risk to cause concern. This category is reserved for credits that display negative performance trends. The “Watch” grade should be regarded as a transition category.
  • Special Mention - a criticized asset category defined as having potential weaknesses that deserve management’s close attention. If left uncorrected, these potential weaknesses may, at some future date, result in the deterioration of the repayment prospects for the credit or the institution’s credit position. Special mention credits are not considered part of the classified credit categories and do not expose the institution to sufficient risk to warrant adverse classification.
  • Substandard - an asset that is inadequately protected by the current sound worth and paying capacity of the obligor or of the collateral pledged, if any. Assets so classified must have a well-defined weakness or weaknesses that jeopardize the liquidation of the debt. They are characterized by the distinct possibility that the institution will sustain some loss if the deficiencies are not corrected.
  • Doubtful - an asset that has all the weaknesses inherent in one classified substandard with the added characteristic that the weaknesses make collection or liquidation in full, on the basis of currently existing facts, conditions, and values, highly questionable and improbable.
  • Loss - credits classified as loss are considered uncollectable and are charged off promptly once so classified.

Residential and Consumer:

  • Performing – accruing loans
  • Nonperforming – loans for which there are good reasons to doubt that payments will be made in full. Nonperforming loans include all loans with nonaccrual status.

Table of Contents

Vintage Analysis

The following tables present credit quality disclosures of amortized cost by class and vintage for term loans and by revolving and revolving converted to amortizing at December 31, 2025 and 2024. The Company defines vintage as the later of origination, renewal or modification date. The gross charge-offs presented in the tables that follow are for the years ended December 31, 2025 and December 31, 2024.

Term Loans Revolving Loans
December 31, 2025 Amortized Cost Basis by Origination Year Revolving Converted to
($ in thousands) 2025 2024 2023 2022 2021 Prior Loans Term Loans Total
Commercial Non-Real Estate:
Pass $ 2,030,587 $ 1,164,266 $ 711,218 $ 812,902 $ 525,095 $ 891,032 $ 2,955,174 $ 90,350 $ 9,180,624
Pass-Watch 24,737 27,477 39,683 33,385 12,896 18,064 94,461 15,417 266,120
Special Mention 2,405 6,975 6,239 27,719 10,564 4,305 28,330 2,192 88,729
Substandard 13,738 6,450 81,228 87,745 11,275 6,798 51,619 14,685 273,538
Doubtful
Total $ 2,071,467 $ 1,205,168 $ 838,368 $ 961,751 $ 559,830 $ 920,199 $ 3,129,584 $ 122,644 $ 9,809,011
Gross Charge-offs $ 4,798 $ 2,718 $ 15,397 $ 2,888 $ 74 $ 531 $ 3,722 $ 15,436 $ 45,564
Commercial Real Estate - Owner Occupied:
Pass $ 616,536 $ 401,399 $ 312,006 $ 461,247 $ 459,700 $ 711,509 $ 51,600 $ 50,328 $ 3,064,325
Pass-Watch 26,766 6,397 2,746 43,060 14,187 27,591 2,506 120 123,373
Special Mention 2,371 2,202 1,008 12,024 5,054 293 195 48 23,195
Substandard 2,082 822 6,685 20,353 1,472 27,723 50 59,187
Doubtful
Total $ 647,755 $ 410,820 $ 322,445 $ 536,684 $ 480,413 $ 767,116 $ 54,351 $ 50,496 $ 3,270,080
Gross Charge-offs $ $ $ 86 $ $ 2,741 $ 1,799 $ $ $ 4,626
Commercial Real Estate - Income Producing:
Pass $ 1,110,044 $ 416,052 $ 519,955 $ 724,326 $ 549,335 $ 649,996 $ 64,217 $ 1,490 $ 4,035,415
Pass-Watch 22,429 15,606 4,219 101,959 4,277 40,381 1,123 189,994
Special Mention 7,962 289 8,251
Substandard 192 7,669 10,441 10,871 20,185 150 49,508
Doubtful
Total $ 1,140,627 $ 431,658 $ 532,132 $ 836,726 $ 564,483 $ 710,562 $ 65,490 $ 1,490 $ 4,283,168
Gross Charge-offs $ $ $ $ 34 $ $ $ $ $ 34
Construction and Land Development:
Pass $ 349,811 $ 358,827 $ 185,672 $ 54,798 $ 75,084 $ 14,954 $ 131,153 $ 535 $ 1,170,834
Pass-Watch 29,323 814 1,500 3,299 128 241 35,305
Special Mention 60 28,036 112 28,208
Substandard 72 185 1,665 2,560 135 122 4,739
Doubtful
Total $ 379,266 $ 359,826 $ 188,837 $ 88,693 $ 75,459 $ 15,317 $ 131,153 $ 535 $ 1,239,086
Gross Charge-offs $ $ $ $ 1,297 $ $ 17 $ $ $ 1,314
Residential Mortgage:
Performing $ 360,686 $ 131,928 $ 390,276 $ 1,039,884 $ 824,012 $ 1,220,288 $ 2,857 $ $ 3,969,931
Nonperforming 371 2,300 10,582 10,244 6,335 17,154 46,986
Total $ 361,057 $ 134,228 $ 400,858 $ 1,050,128 $ 830,347 $ 1,237,442 $ 2,857 $ $ 4,016,917
Gross Charge-offs $ $ 36 $ 502 $ 335 $ $ 49 $ $ $ 922
Consumer Loans:
Performing $ 50,512 $ 24,693 $ 22,963 $ 18,103 $ 8,928 $ 47,131 $ 1,123,471 $ 33,674 $ 1,329,475
Nonperforming 51 44 349 842 627 4,367 408 4,015 10,703
Total $ 50,563 $ 24,737 $ 23,312 $ 18,945 $ 9,555 $ 51,498 $ 1,123,879 $ 37,689 $ 1,340,178
Gross Charge-offs $ 85 $ 952 $ 1,104 $ 1,277 $ 528 $ 695 $ 9,228 $ 2,137 $ 16,006

Table of Contents

Term Loans Revolving Loans
December 31, 2024 Amortized Cost Basis by Origination Year Revolving Converted to
($ in thousands) 2024 2023 2022 2021 2020 Prior Loans Term Loans Total
Commercial Non-Real Estate:
Pass $ 1,794,904 $ 1,069,637 $ 1,154,669 $ 819,520 $ 339,594 $ 925,046 $ 2,946,499 $ 107,363 $ 9,157,232
Pass-Watch 8,466 46,681 43,379 29,193 12,768 9,851 61,076 8,561 219,975
Special Mention 412 21,337 52,375 6,044 6,234 41 62,934 328 149,705
Substandard 19,839 91,192 117,545 15,225 8,200 2,898 65,138 29,643 349,680
Doubtful
Total $ 1,823,621 $ 1,228,847 $ 1,367,968 $ 869,982 $ 366,796 $ 937,836 $ 3,135,647 $ 145,895 $ 9,876,592
Gross Charge-offs $ 705 $ 7,575 $ 7,494 $ 11,090 $ 213 $ 1,837 $ 5,952 $ 10,622 $ 45,488
Commercial Real Estate - Owner Occupied:
Pass $ 365,158 $ 319,684 $ 537,069 $ 524,572 $ 433,844 $ 554,293 $ 97,999 $ 609 $ 2,833,228
Pass-Watch 18,937 8,575 66,286 5,547 2,695 29,078 3,727 721 135,566
Special Mention 4,417 410 6,759 3,756 2,559 17,901
Substandard 1,322 2,630 5,574 1,563 1,248 12,923 25,260
Doubtful
Total $ 389,834 $ 331,299 $ 615,688 $ 535,438 $ 437,787 $ 598,853 $ 101,726 $ 1,330 $ 3,011,955
Gross Charge-offs $ $ $ 131 $ $ $ 12 $ $ $ 143
Commercial Real Estate - Income Producing:
Pass $ 416,947 $ 453,428 $ 975,075 $ 750,907 $ 494,925 $ 501,389 $ 31,673 $ 1,637 $ 3,625,981
Pass-Watch 2,586 7,005 43,221 9,399 20,694 16,354 220 159 99,638
Special Mention 20,292 1,986 22,278
Substandard 1,818 18,189 8,604 2,210 19,731 163 50,715
Doubtful
Total $ 441,643 $ 478,622 $ 1,028,886 $ 762,516 $ 535,350 $ 517,906 $ 31,893 $ 1,796 $ 3,798,612
Gross Charge-offs $ $ $ 8,819 $ $ $ 3 $ $ $ 8,822
Construction and Land Development:
Pass $ 237,136 $ 418,002 $ 296,286 $ 103,259 $ 33,519 $ 14,477 $ 102,694 $ 2,031 $ 1,207,404
Pass-Watch 624 2,279 62,415 391 30 323 159 66,221
Special Mention 1,014 1,014
Substandard 324 796 1,576 3,554 26 200 6,476
Doubtful
Total $ 239,098 $ 421,077 $ 360,277 $ 107,204 $ 33,575 $ 15,000 $ 102,853 $ 2,031 $ 1,281,115
Gross Charge-offs $ $ 113 $ 94 $ 30 $ $ 20 $ $ 7 $ 264
Residential Mortgage:
Performing $ 161,019 $ 422,269 $ 1,068,191 $ 882,918 $ 447,690 $ 932,182 $ 2,772 $ 201 $ 3,917,242
Nonperforming 327 7,724 10,974 6,687 1,199 17,175 44,086
Total $ 161,346 $ 429,993 $ 1,079,165 $ 889,605 $ 448,889 $ 949,357 $ 2,772 $ 201 $ 3,961,328
Gross Charge-offs $ $ 57 $ 189 $ 2 $ $ 132 $ $ $ 380
Consumer Loans:
Performing $ 56,983 $ 39,301 $ 35,320 $ 20,397 $ 15,035 $ 41,299 $ 1,120,027 $ 30,296 $ 1,358,658
Nonperforming 51 46 320 639 767 3,442 535 5,387 11,187
Total $ 57,034 $ 39,347 $ 35,640 $ 21,036 $ 15,802 $ 44,741 $ 1,120,562 $ 35,683 $ 1,369,845
Gross Charge-offs $ 92 $ 1,733 $ 2,474 $ 1,173 $ 180 $ 985 $ 8,826 $ 2,524 $ 17,987

Residential Mortgage Loans in Process of Foreclosure

Loans in process of foreclosure include those for which formal foreclosure proceedings are in process according to local requirements of the applicable jurisdiction. Included in loans are $12.0 million and $10.5 million of consumer loans secured by single family residential real estate that are in process of foreclosure as of December 31, 2025 and 2024, respectively. In addition to the single family residential real estate loans in process of foreclosure, the Company also held $5.1 million and $2.0 million of foreclosed single family residential properties in other real estate owned as of December 31, 2025 and 2024, respectively.

Loans Held for Sale

Loans held for sale totaled $33.2 million and $21.5 million at December 31, 2025 and 2024, respectively. Loans held for sale is composed primarily of residential mortgage loans originated for sale in the secondary market. At December 31, 2025, residential mortgage loans carried at the fair value option totaled $33.2 million with an unpaid principal balance of $32.3 million. At December 31, 2024 residential mortgage loans carried at the fair value option totaled $18.9 million with an unpaid principal balance of $18.6 million. All other loans held for sale are carried at lower of cost or market.

Table of Contents

Note 5. Property and Equipment

Property and equipment consisted of the following at December 31, 2025 and 2024:

December 31,
($ in thousands) 2025 2024
Land and land improvements $ 63,067 $ 63,016
Buildings and leasehold improvements 316,628 312,871
Furniture, fixtures and equipment 131,149 128,401
Software 107,771 106,884
Assets under development 13,384 14,557
Property and equipment, gross 631,999 625,729
Accumulated depreciation and amortization (370,818 ) (345,962 )
Property and equipment, net $ 261,181 $ 279,767

Assets under development is comprised primarily of software design and implementation costs.

Depreciation and amortization expense was $27.3 million, $32.3 million and $34.7 million for the years ended December 31, 2025, 2024, and 2023, respectively.

Property and Equipment Held for Sale

There were no assets that met the criteria to be classified as held for sale at December 31, 2025 and 2024. For more information on the Company’s policy for accounting for assets held for sale, refer to Note 1 – Summary of Significant Accounting Policies and Recent Accounting Pronouncements.

Note 6. Operating Leases

The Company has operating leases on a number of its branches, certain regional headquarters and other properties to limit its exposure to ownership risks such as fluctuations in real estate prices and obsolescence. The Company leases real estate with lease terms generally from five to 20 years, some of which have renewal options from one to 20 years. As these extension options are not generally considered reasonably certain of renewal, they are not included in the lease term. The Company is not a lessee in any contracts classified as finance leases.

The following tables present supplemental information pertaining to operating leases at and for the years ended December 31, 2025 and 2024.

Years Ended December 31,
($ in thousands) 2025 2024
Cash paid for amounts included in the measurement of lease liabilities for operating leases $ 17,370 $ 16,992
Right of use assets obtained in exchange for lease liabilities 11,932 5,749
December 31,
2025 2024
Weighted-average remaining lease term (in years) 9.74 10.40
Weighted-average discount rate 3.92 % 3.77 %

Table of Contents

The following table sets forth the maturities of the Company’s lease liabilities and the present value discount at December 31, 2025.

( in thousands)
2026 18,737
2027 18,728
2028 17,559
2029 15,679
2030 12,881
Thereafter 64,025
Total 147,609
Present value discount (26,104 )
Lease liability 121,505

All values are in US Dollars.

The following table sets forth the components of the Company’s lease expense for the years ended December 31, 2025, 2024 and 2023.

Years Ended December 31,
($ in thousands) 2025 2024 2023
Operating lease expense $ 17,275 $ 16,358 $ 16,545
Short-term lease expense 645 323 144
Variable lease expense 399 329 243
Sublease income (440 ) (391 ) (403 )
Total $ 17,879 $ 16,619 $ 16,529

At December 31, 2025, the Company had four leases that had not yet commenced, with discounted lease obligations totaling $7.4 million.

Note 7. Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets

Goodwill represents the excess of the consideration paid over the fair value of the net assets acquired or the excess of the fair value of the net liabilities assumed over the consideration received in a business combination. The carrying amount of goodwill was $925.4 million at December 31, 2025 and $855.5 million at December 31, 2024. For information regarding changes to the Company’s carrying amount of goodwill and other intangibles, refer to Note 2 – Acquisition.

The Company completed its annual impairment test of goodwill as of September 30, 2025 by performing a qualitative (Step Zero) assessment. The qualitative assessment involved the examination of changes in macroeconomic conditions, industry and market conditions, overall financial performance, cost factors and other relevant entity-specific events, including changes in management and other key personnel and changes in the share price of the Company’s common stock. As a result of the assessment, the Company concluded that its goodwill was not impaired.

No goodwill impairment charges were recognized during the years ended December 31, 2025, 2024 or 2023.

Identifiable intangible assets with finite lives are amortized over the periods benefited and are evaluated for impairment similar to other long-lived assets. The purchase and carrying values of intangible assets subject to amortization at December 31, 2025 and 2024 were as follows:

December 31, 2025
Purchase Accumulated Carrying
($ in thousands) Value Amortization Value
Core deposit intangibles $ 235,845 $ 223,561 $ 12,284
Credit card and trust relationships 80,662 25,875 54,787
Total $ 316,507 $ 249,436 $ 67,071

Table of Contents

December 31, 2024
Purchase Accumulated Carrying
($ in thousands) Value Amortization Value
Core deposit intangibles $ 235,845 $ 217,260 $ 18,585
Credit card and trust relationships 49,962 33,323 16,639
Total $ 285,807 $ 250,583 $ 35,224

Aggregate amortization expense by category of finite lived intangible assets for the years ended December 31, 2025, 2024, and 2023 are as follows:

Years Ended December 31,
($ in thousands) 2025 2024 2023
Core deposit intangibles $ 6,301 $ 7,602 $ 9,613
Credit card and trust relationships 3,652 1,811 1,943
Total $ 9,953 $ 9,413 $ 11,556

At December 31, 2025, the weighted-average remaining life of core deposit intangibles was approximately 8 years, and the weighted-average remaining life of other identifiable intangibles was approximately 20 years.

The following table shows estimated amortization expense of other intangible assets at December 31, 2025 for the five succeeding years and all years thereafter, calculated based on current amortization schedules.

( in thousands)
2026 8,175
2027 6,393
2028 5,881
2029 5,429
2030 5,016
Thereafter 36,177
Total 67,071

All values are in US Dollars.

Note 8. Other Assets

Significant balances included in Other Assets in the Consolidated Balance Sheets at December 31, 2025 and 2024 are presented below.

December 31,
($ in thousands) 2025 2024
Investments in small business investment and other companies $ 64,203 $ 61,952
Derivative assets 63,126 73,840
Derivative collateral 32,890 64,260
FHLB stock 29,713 11,958
Income tax receivable 23,004 19,207
Investments in low income housing tax credit entities 21,836 25,577
Other 49,463 43,947
Total $ 284,235 $ 300,741

The Company invests in certain affordable housing project limited partnerships that are qualified low-income housing tax credit developments. These investments are considered variable interest entities for which the Company is not the primary beneficiary and, therefore, are not consolidated. These partnerships generate low-income tax credits that are earned over a 10-year period, beginning with the year the rental activity begins. The Company has elected to use the practical expedient method of amortization, which approximates the proportional amortization method, whereby the investment cost is amortized in proportion to the allocated tax credits over the 10 year tax credit period. Additionally, the Company recognizes deferred taxes on the basis difference of the tax equity investment to reflect the financial impact of other tax benefits (e.g., tax operating losses) not included in the practical expedient amortization. The tax credits, when realized, are reflected in the consolidated statements of income as a reduction of income tax expense. The Company’s investments in affordable housing limited partnerships totaled $37.5 million at both December 31, 2025 and 2024, with a carry balance net of accumulated amortization included in the other assets line item on our Consolidated

Table of Contents

Balance Sheets totaling $21.8 million and $25.6 million, respectively, for those same periods. The net impact of the low-income housing tax credit program was not material to our Consolidated Statements of Income or Cash Flows for the years ended December 31, 2025 and 2024.

Note 9. Deposits

The following table presents a detail of deposits at December 31, 2025 and 2024:

December 31,
($ in thousands) 2025 2024
Noninterest-bearing deposits $ 10,374,991 $ 10,597,461
Interest-bearing retail transaction and savings deposits 11,998,892 11,327,725
Interest-bearing public fund deposits:
Public fund transaction and savings deposits 3,120,389 3,127,427
Public fund time deposits 96,925 85,072
Total interest-bearing public fund deposits 3,217,314 3,212,499
Retail time deposits 3,688,577 4,348,265
Brokered time deposits 6,901
Total interest-bearing deposits 18,904,783 18,895,390
Total deposits $ 29,279,774 $ 29,492,851

The maturity of time deposits at December 31, 2025 follows.

( in thousands)
2026 3,739,010
2027 25,322
2028 11,710
2029 4,286
2030 4,057
Thereafter 1,117
Total time deposits 3,785,502

All values are in US Dollars.

The aggregate amount of time deposit in accounts in denominations that meet or exceed the insured limit of $250,000 totaled approximately $1.5 billion at December 31, 2025.

Table of Contents

Note 10. Short-Term Borrowings

The following table presents information concerning short-term borrowings at and for the years ended December 31, 2025 and 2024:

December 31,
($ in thousands) 2025 2024
Federal funds purchased:
Amount outstanding at period end $ 70,400 $ 300
Average amount outstanding during period 16,879 12,935
Maximum amount at any month end during period 110,300 200,275
Weighted-average interest rate at period end 3.74 % 3.90 %
Weighted-average interest rate during period 4.84 % 5.61 %
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase:
Amount outstanding at period end $ 546,892 $ 638,715
Average amount outstanding during period 613,630 639,912
Maximum amount at any month end during period 734,288 792,589
Weighted-average interest rate at period end 1.18 % 0.95 %
Weighted-average interest rate during period 1.36 % 1.65 %
FHLB borrowings:
Amount outstanding at period end $ 400,000 $
Average amount outstanding during period 339,044 238,593
Maximum amount at any month end during period 1,275,000 650,000
Weighted-average interest rate at period end 3.62 %
Weighted-average interest rate during period 4.28 % 5.48 %

Federal funds purchased represent unsecured borrowings from other banks, generally on an overnight basis.

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase (“repurchase agreements”) are funds borrowed on a secured basis by selling securities under agreements to repurchase, mainly in connection with treasury-management services offered to deposit customers. The customer repurchase agreements mature daily and are secured by agency securities. As the Company maintains effective control over assets sold under agreements to repurchase, the securities continue to be presented in the Consolidated Balance Sheets. Because the Company acts as a borrower transferring assets to the counterparty, and the agreements mature daily, the Company’s risk is limited.

Short-term borrowings include Federal Home Loan Bank (FHLB) advances totaling $0.4 billion as of December 31, 2025 which consisted of one fixed rate note entered into on December 31, 2025, that matured on January 2, 2026. There were no FHLB advances outstanding at December 31, 2024. As FHLB short-term borrowings mature, they are generally paid off and replaced with new short-term advances, if warranted, depending on funding needs.

Note 11. Long-Term Debt

At December 31, 2025 and 2024, long-term debt was comprised of the following:

December 31,
($ in thousands) 2025 2024
Subordinated notes payable, maturing June 2060 $ 172,500 $ 172,500
Other long-term debt 32,135 43,424
Less: unamortized debt issuance costs (5,228 ) (5,380 )
Total long-term debt $ 199,407 $ 210,544

Table of Contents

The following table sets forth unamortized debt issuance costs associated with the respective debt instruments at December 31, 2025:

($ in thousands) Principal Unamortized Debt<br> Issuance Costs
Subordinated notes payable, maturing June 2060 $ 172,500 $ 5,228
Other long-term debt 32,135
Total $ 204,635 $ 5,228

On June 9, 2020, the Company completed the issuance of subordinated notes payable with an aggregate principal amount of $172.5 million, with a stated maturity of June 15, 2060. The notes accrue interest at a fixed rate of 6.25% per annum, with quarterly interest payments that began September 15, 2020. Subject to prior approval by the Federal Reserve, the Company may redeem the notes in whole or in part on any interest payment dates. This debt qualifies as tier 2 capital in the calculation of certain regulatory capital ratios.

All of the Company’s other long-term debt consists of borrowings associated with tax credit fund activities. Although these borrowings have indicated maturities through

2052

, each is expected to be satisfied at the end of the seven-year compliance period for the related tax credit investments.

Note 12. Derivatives

Risk Management Objective of Using Derivatives

The Company enters into derivative financial instruments to manage risks related to differences in the amount, timing, and duration of the Company’s known or expected cash receipts and its known or expected cash payments. The Bank also enters into interest rate derivative agreements as a service to certain qualifying customers. The Bank manages a matched book with respect to these customer derivatives in order to minimize its net interest rate risk exposure resulting from such agreements. In addition, the Bank also enters into risk participation agreements under which it may either sell or buy credit risk associated with a customer’s performance under certain interest rate derivative contracts related to loans in which participation interests have been sold to or purchased from other banks.

Table of Contents

Fair Values of Derivative Instruments on the Balance Sheet

The table below presents the notional or contractual amounts and fair values of the Company’s derivative financial instruments as well as their classification on the consolidated balance sheets at December 31, 2025 and 2024.

December 31, 2025 December 31, 2024
Derivative (1) Derivative (1)
($ in thousands) Type of Hedge Notional or Contractual Amount Assets Liabilities Notional or Contractual Amount Assets Liabilities
Derivatives designated as hedging instruments:
Interest rate swaps - variable rate loans Cash Flow $ 1,775,000 $ 4,026 $ 16,335 $ 1,350,000 $ $ 48,022
Interest rate swaps - securities Fair Value 397,500 23,569 477,500 39,647
$ 2,172,500 $ 27,595 $ 16,335 $ 1,827,500 $ 39,647 $ 48,022
Derivatives not designated as hedging instruments:
Interest rate swaps N/A $ 5,308,711 $ 73,725 $ 73,829 $ 4,926,461 $ 108,702 $ 108,761
Risk participation agreements N/A 373,117 10 10 445,554 7 9
Forward commitments to sell residential mortgage loans N/A 9,081 2 108 25,526 383
Interest rate-lock commitments on residential mortgage loans N/A 23,192 497 27,465 420
To Be Announced (TBA) securities N/A 30,000 4 62 15,250 88 1
Foreign exchange forward contracts N/A 82,157 3,779 3,745 82,756 1,389 1,358
Visa Class B derivative contract N/A 41,588 1,284 42,020 2,089
$ 5,867,846 $ 78,017 $ 79,038 $ 5,565,032 $ 110,606 $ 112,601
Total derivatives $ 8,040,346 $ 105,612 $ 95,373 $ 7,392,532 $ 150,253 $ 160,623
Less: netting adjustments (2) (42,486 ) (6 ) (76,413 )
Total derivative assets/liabilities $ 63,126 $ 95,367 $ 73,840 $ 160,623

(1) Derivative assets and liabilities are reported in other assets or other liabilities, respectively, in the consolidated balance sheets.

(2) Represents balance sheet netting of derivative assets and liabilities for variation margin collateral held or placed with the same central clearing counterparty. See offsetting assets and liabilities for further information.

Cash Flow Hedges of Interest Rate Risk

The Company is party to various interest rate swap agreements designated and qualifying as cash flow hedges of the Company’s forecasted variable cash flows for pools of variable rate loans. For each agreement, the Company receives interest at a fixed rate and pays at a variable rate. The Company terminated certain swap agreements during the fiscal years ended December 31, 2024 and 2023, resulting in cash paid of approximately $13.7 million and $2.9 million, respectively. There were no terminated interest rate swap agreements designated as cash flow hedges during the fiscal year ended December 31, 2025. The net cash received/paid for these transactions was recorded as accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) and is being amortized into earnings through the original maturity dates of the respective contracts. The notional amounts of the active interest rate swap agreements at December 31, 2025 expire as follows: $425 million in

2026

; $825 million in

2027

, $50 million in

2028

, $275 million in

2029

and $200 million in

2030

.

Fair Value Hedges of Interest Rate Risk

Interest rate swaps on securities available for sale

The Company is party to forward-starting fixed payer swaps that convert the latter portion of the term of certain available for sale securities to a floating rate. These derivative instruments are designated as fair value hedges of interest rate risk. This strategy provides the Company with a fixed rate coupon during the front-end unhedged tenor of the bonds and results in a floating rate security during the back-end hedged tenor. At December 31, 2025, these single layer instruments have hedge start dates between January 2025 and July 2026, and maturity dates from December 2027 through March 2031. The change in the fair value of the

Table of Contents

hedged item attributable to interest rate risk and the net hedge income from effective hedges is presented in interest income along with the fair value of the hedging instrument.

During the year ended December 31, 2025, $248.5 million of fair value hedges became effective with the resulting net earnings recorded in interest income on the “Securities-taxable” line item on the Consolidated Statements of Income. Once effective, fair value hedges synthetically convert the notional portion of the hedged asset to a variable rate over the life of the hedge that is indexed to the federal funds effective rate.

The hedged available for sale securities are part of closed portfolios of pre-payable commercial mortgage-backed securities. In accordance with ASC 815, prepayment risk may be excluded when measuring the change in fair value of such hedged items attributable to interest rate risk under the portfolio layer method. At December 31, 2025, the amortized cost basis of the closed portfolio of pre-payable commercial mortgage-backed securities totaled $432.0 million, excluding any basis adjustment. The amount that represents the hedged items was $373.8 million and the basis adjustment associated with the hedged items was a loss totaling $23.7 million.

The Company terminated certain swap agreements designated as a fair value hedge during the years ended December 31, 2025 and 2023, resulting in net cash received of approximately $2.3 million and $19.3 million, respectively. There were no fair value swap agreements terminated during the year ended December 31, 2024. At the time of termination, the value of the swaps was recorded as an adjustment to the book value of the underlying security, thereby changing its current book yield and extending its duration, if held, or impacting the net gain or loss, if sold.

Derivatives Not Designated as Hedges

Customer interest rate derivative program

The Bank enters into interest rate derivative agreements, primarily rate swaps, with commercial banking customers to facilitate their risk management strategies. The Bank enters into offsetting agreements with unrelated financial institutions, thereby mitigating its net risk exposure resulting from such transactions. Because the interest rate derivatives associated with this program do not meet hedge accounting requirements, changes in the fair value of both the customer derivatives and the offsetting derivatives are recognized directly in earnings.

Risk participation agreements

The Bank also enters into risk participation agreements under which it may either assume or sell credit risk associated with a borrower’s performance under certain interest rate derivative contracts. In those instances where the Bank has assumed credit risk, it is not a direct counterparty to the derivative contract with the borrower and has entered into the risk participation agreement because it is a party to the related loan agreement with the borrower. In those instances in which the Bank has sold credit risk, it is the sole counterparty to the derivative contract with the borrower and has entered into the risk participation agreement because other banks participate in the related loan agreement. The Bank manages its credit risk under risk participation agreements by monitoring the creditworthiness of the borrower, based on the Bank’s normal credit review process.

Mortgage banking derivatives

The Bank also enters into certain derivative agreements as part of its mortgage banking activities. These agreements include interest rate lock commitments on prospective residential mortgage loans and forward commitments to sell loans to investors on either a best efforts or a mandatory delivery basis. The Company uses these forward sales commitments, which may include To Be Announced (TBA) security contracts, on the open market to protect the value of its rate locks and mortgage loans held for sale from changes in interest rates and pricing between the origination of the rate lock and the final sale of these loans. These instruments meet the definition of derivative financial instruments and are reflected in other assets and other liabilities in the Consolidated Balance Sheets, with changes to the fair value recorded in noninterest income within the secondary mortgage market operations line item in the Consolidated Statements of Income.

The loans sold on a mandatory basis commit the Company to deliver a specific principal amount of mortgage loans to an investor at a specified price, by a specified date. If the Company fails to deliver the amount of mortgages necessary to fulfill the commitment by the specified date, we may be obligated to pay a pair-off fee, based on then-current market prices, to the investor/counterparty to compensate the investor for the shortfall. Mandatory delivery forward commitments include TBA security contracts on the open market to provide protection against changes in interest rates on the locked mortgage pipeline. The Company expects that mandatory delivery contracts, including TBA security contracts, will experience changes in fair value opposite to the changes in the fair value of derivative loan commitments. Certain assumptions, including pull through rates and rate lock periods, are used in managing the

Table of Contents

existing and future hedges. The accuracy of underlying assumptions could impact the ultimate effectiveness of any hedging strategies.

Forward commitments under best effort contracts commit the Company to deliver a specific individual mortgage loan to an investor if the loan to the underlying borrower closes. Generally, best efforts cash contracts have no pair-off risk regardless of market movement. The price the investor will pay the seller for an individual loan is specified prior to the loan being funded, generally the same day the Company enters into the interest rate lock commitment with the potential borrower. The Company expects that these best efforts forward loan sale commitments will experience a net neutral shift in fair value with related derivative loan commitments.

At the closing of the loan, the rate lock commitment derivative expires and the Company generally records a loan held for sale at fair value under the election of fair value option.

Customer foreign exchange forward contract derivatives

The Company enters into foreign exchange forward derivative agreements, primarily forward foreign currency contracts, with commercial banking customers to facilitate their risk management strategies. The Bank manages its risk exposure from such transactions by entering into offsetting agreements with unrelated financial institutions. The Bank has not elected to designate these foreign exchange forward contract derivatives as hedges; as such, changes in the fair value of both the customer derivatives and the offsetting derivatives are recognized directly in earnings.

Visa Class B derivative contract

The Company is a member of Visa USA. In 2018, the Company sold the majority of its Visa Class B holdings, at which time it entered into a derivative agreement with the purchaser whereby the Company will make or receive cash payments whenever the conversion ratio of the Visa Class B shares into Visa Class A shares is adjusted. The conversion ratio changes when Visa deposits funds to a litigation escrow established by Visa to pay settlements for certain litigation, for which Visa is indemnified by Visa USA members. The Company is also required to make periodic financing payments to the purchaser until all of Visa’s covered litigation matters are resolved. Thus, the derivative contract extends until the end of Visa’s covered litigation matters, the timing of which is uncertain.

During the second quarter of 2024, Visa allowed Class B holders to convert some but not all of their Class B shares to Class A shares. As a result of this conversion event, the Bank and its counterparty agreed to modify the transaction agreement to reflect the partial exchange and include certain provisions related to conversion rate changes. The conversion plan approved by Visa requires a minimum of 12 months before another exchange event and thus extends the expected time for a full resolution of the matter.

The contract includes a contingent accelerated termination clause based on the credit ratings of the Company. At December 31, 2025 and 2024, the fair value of the liability associated with this contract was $1.3 million and $2.1 million respectively. Refer to Note 21 – Fair Value of Financial Instruments for discussion of the valuation inputs and process for this derivative liability.

Effect of Derivative Instruments on the Statements of Income

The effects of derivative instruments on the Consolidated Statements of Income for the years ended December 31, 2025, 2024, and 2023 are presented in the table below.

Table of Contents

Years Ended December 31,
($ in thousands)<br>Derivative Instruments: Location of Gain (Loss) Recognized<br>in the Statements of Income: 2025 2024 2023
Cash flow hedges:
Variable rate loans Interest income - loans $ (33,743 ) $ (47,944 ) $ (40,714 )
Fair value hedges:
Securities Interest income - securities - taxable 18,096 12,627 11,945
Securities - termination Noninterest income - securities transactions, net 399 2,725
Derivatives not designated as hedging:
Residential mortgage banking Noninterest income - secondary mortgage market operations (12 ) 335 753
Customer and all other instruments Noninterest income - other noninterest income 5,819 (3,790 ) 420
Total gain (loss) $ (9,441 ) $ (38,772 ) $ (24,871 )

Credit Risk-Related Contingent Features

Certain of the Bank’s derivative instruments contain provisions allowing the financial institution counterparty to terminate the contracts in certain circumstances, such as the downgrade of the Bank’s credit ratings below specified levels, a default by the Bank on its indebtedness, or the failure of the Bank to maintain specified minimum regulatory capital ratios or its regulatory status as a well-capitalized institution. These derivative agreements also contain provisions regarding the posting of collateral by each party. The Company is not in violation of any such provisions. The aggregate fair value of derivative instruments with credit risk-related contingent features that were in a net liability position at December 31, 2025 and 2024 was $13.2 million and $39.1 million, respectively, for which the Company had posted collateral of $13.0 million and $38.0 million, respectively.

Offsetting Assets and Liabilities

The Bank’s derivative instruments with certain counterparties contain legally enforceable netting provisions that allow for net settlement of multiple transactions to a single amount, which may be positive, negative, or zero. Agreements with certain bilateral counterparties require both parties to maintain collateral in the event that the fair values of derivative instruments exceed established exposure thresholds. For centrally cleared derivatives, the Company is subject to initial margin posting and daily variation margin exchange with the central clearinghouses. Offsetting information in regards to all derivative assets and liabilities, including accrued interest subject to these master netting agreements at December 31, 2025 and 2024 is presented in the following tables:

As of December 31, 2025
Gross Amounts<br>Offset in the Net Amounts <br>Presented in the Gross Amounts Not Offset in the<br>Statement of Financial Position
($ in thousands) Gross<br>Amounts<br>Recognized Statement of<br>Financial<br>Position Statement of<br>Financial<br>Position Financial<br>Instruments Cash<br>Collateral Net<br>Amount
Derivative Assets $ 89,930 $ (43,810 ) $ 46,120 $ 36,259 $ 32,890 $ 42,751
Derivative Liabilities $ 36,264 $ (5 ) $ 36,259 $ 36,259 $ $
As of December 31, 2024
--- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- ---
Gross Amounts<br>Offset in the Net Amounts <br>Presented in the Gross Amounts Not Offset in the<br>Statement of Financial Position
($ in thousands) Gross<br>Amounts<br>Recognized Statement of<br>Financial<br>Position Statement of<br>Financial<br>Position Financial<br>Instruments Cash<br>Collateral Net<br>Amount
Derivative Assets $ 149,808 $ (77,915 ) $ 71,893 $ 54,707 $ 64,260 $ 81,446
Derivative Liabilities $ 54,707 $ $ 54,707 $ 54,707 $ $

The Company has excess posted collateral compared to total exposure due to initial margin requirements for day-to-day rate volatility.

Table of Contents

Note 13. Stockholders’ Equity

Common Shares Outstanding

Common shares outstanding excludes treasury shares totaling 10.7 million and 6.7 million with a first-in-first-out cost basis of $502.9 million and $264.1 million at December 31, 2025 and 2024, respectively. Shares outstanding also excludes unvested restricted share awards of totaling 8,520 and 111,964 at December 31, 2025 and 2024, respectively.

Stock Buyback Programs

On December 10, 2025, the Company’s Board of Directors approved a stock buyback program, effective January 1, 2026, whereby the Company is authorized to repurchase up to 5% of the shares of the Company's common stock outstanding as of December 31, 2025, or approximately 4.1 million shares, through the program’s expiration date of December 31, 2026. The program allows the Company to repurchase its common shares in the open market, by block purchase, through accelerated share repurchase programs, in privately negotiated transactions, or otherwise, in one or more transactions, from time to time, depending on market conditions and other factors, and in accordance with applicable regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission. The Company is not obligated to purchase any shares under this program, and the Board of Directors has the ability to terminate or amend the program at any time prior to the expiration date.

Prior to its completion in December 2025, the Company had in place a stock repurchase program authorized by the Board of Directors on December 9, 2024, whereby the Company was authorized to repurchase up to 5% of the Company's common stock outstanding at December 31, 2024, or approximately 4.3 million shares, with the same terms described above through the program's expiration date of December 31, 2026. During the year ended December 31, 2025, the Company repurchased all of the 4,306,200 shares of its common stock that were authorized under this program, at an average cost of $57.30 per share, inclusive of commissions, under this program. The Company has accrued $2.2 million of estimated excise tax associated with share repurchases during the year ended December 31, 2025.

Prior to its expiration on December 31, 2024, the Company had in place a stock repurchase program authorized by the Board of Directors on January 26, 2023, whereby the Company was authorized to repurchase up to 5% of the Company's common stock outstanding at December 31, 2022, or approximately 4.3 million shares, with terms the same as those described above. During the year ended December 31, 2024, the Company repurchased 762,993 shares of its common stock at an average cost of $49.40 per share, inclusive of commissions, under this program. No shares were repurchased under this program in 2023. The Company paid $0.1 million of estimated excise tax associated with share repurchases during 2024.

Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss)

Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income or Loss (AOCI) is reported as a component of stockholders’ equity. AOCI can include, among other items, unrealized holding gains and losses on securities available for sale (AFS), including the Company’s share of unrealized gains and losses reported by a partnership accounted for under the equity method, gains and losses associated with pension or other post-retirement benefits that are not recognized immediately as a component of net periodic benefit cost, and gains and losses on derivative instruments that are designated as, and qualify as, cash flow hedges. Net unrealized gains and losses on AFS securities reclassified as securities held to maturity (HTM) also continue to be reported as a component of AOCI and will be amortized over the estimated remaining life of the securities as an adjustment to interest income. Subject to certain thresholds, unrealized losses on employee benefit plans will be reclassified into income as pension and post-retirement costs are recognized over the remaining service period of plan participants. Accumulated gains or losses on cash flow hedges of variable rate loans described in Note 12 will be reclassified into income over the life of the hedge. Accumulated other comprehensive loss resulting from the terminated interest rate swaps are being amortized over the remaining maturities of the designated instruments. Gains and losses within AOCI are net of deferred income taxes, where applicable.

Table of Contents

A rollforward of the components of Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss) is presented in the table that follows:

($ in thousands) Available<br>for Sale<br>Securities HTM<br>Securities<br>Transferred<br>from AFS Employee<br>Benefit<br>Plans Cash Flow<br>Hedges Equity Method Investment Total
Balance, December 31, 2022 $ (584,408 ) $ (10,734 ) $ (97,952 ) $ (79,093 ) $ 5 $ (772,182 )
Net change in unrealized gain (loss) 104,543 (13,850 ) 368 91,061
Reclassification of net loss realized and included in earnings 68,105 6,800 40,714 115,619
Valuation adjustments to employee benefit plans (13,325 ) (13,325 )
Amortization of unrealized net loss on securities transferred to held to maturity 1,747 1,747
Income tax (expense) benefit (38,988 ) (398 ) 1,416 (6,077 ) (44,047 )
Balance, December 31, 2023 $ (450,748 ) $ (9,385 ) $ (103,061 ) $ (58,306 ) $ 373 $ (621,127 )
Net change in unrealized loss (31,119 ) (33,678 ) (344 ) (65,141 )
Reclassification of net loss realized and included in earnings 4,888 47,944 52,832
Valuation adjustments to employee benefit plans 28,191 28,191
Amortization of unrealized net loss on securities transferred to held to maturity 1,670 1,670
Income tax (expense) benefit 8,188 (356 ) (7,253 ) (3,096 ) (2,517 )
Balance, December 31, 2024 $ (473,679 ) $ (8,071 ) $ (77,235 ) $ (47,136 ) $ 29 $ (606,092 )
Net change in unrealized gain 232,827 8,094 3,056 243,977
Reclassification of net (gain) loss realized and included in earnings 410 3,281 33,742 (2,400 ) 35,033
Valuation adjustments to employee benefit plans 17,231 17,231
Amortization of unrealized net loss on securities transferred to held to maturity 1,580 1,580
Income tax expense (53,393 ) (367 ) (4,725 ) (9,495 ) (67,980 )
Balance, December 31, 2025 $ (293,835 ) $ (6,858 ) $ (61,448 ) $ (14,795 ) $ 685 $ (376,251 )

Table of Contents

The following table shows the line items in the consolidated statements of income affected by amounts reclassified from AOCI:

Amount reclassified from AOCI (a) Year Ended December 31, Increase (Decrease) in Affected
($ in thousands) 2025 2024 Income Statement Line Item
Amortization of unrealized net loss on securities transferred to HTM $ (1,580 ) $ (1,670 ) Interest income
Tax effect 367 356 Income taxes
Net of tax (1,213 ) (1,314 ) Net income
Loss on sale of AFS securities (410 ) Securities transactions, net
Tax effect 94 Income taxes
Net of tax (316 ) Net income
Amortization of defined benefit pension and post-retirement items (3,281 ) (4,888 ) Other noninterest expense
Tax effect 756 1,072 Income taxes
Net of tax (2,525 ) (3,816 ) Net income
Reclassification of unrealized loss on cash flow hedges (27,619 ) (45,537 ) Interest income
Tax effect 6,268 9,882 Income taxes
Net of tax (21,351 ) (35,655 ) Net income
Amortization of loss on terminated cash flow hedges (6,123 ) (2,407 ) Interest income
Tax effect 1,390 522 Income taxes
Net of tax (4,733 ) (1,885 ) Net income
Reclassification of unrealized gain on equity method investment 2,400 Other noninterest income
Tax effect Income taxes
Net of tax 2,400 Net income
Total reclassifications, net of tax $ (27,738 ) $ (42,670 ) Net income
(a) Amounts in parenthesis indicate reduction in net income.

Regulatory Capital

Measures of regulatory capital are an important tool used by regulators to monitor the financial health of financial institutions. The primary quantitative measures used to gauge capital adequacy are Common Equity Tier 1, Tier 1 and Total regulatory capital to risk-weighted assets (risk-based capital ratios) and the Tier 1 capital to average total assets (leverage ratio). Both the Company and the Bank subsidiary are required to maintain minimum risk-based capital ratios of 8.0% total capital, 4.5% Common Equity Tier 1, and 6.0% Tier 1 capital. The minimum leverage ratio is 3.0% for bank holding companies and banks that meet certain specified criteria, including having the highest supervisory rating. All others are required to maintain a leverage ratio of at least 4.0%.

To evaluate capital adequacy, regulators compare an institution’s regulatory capital ratios with their agency guidelines, as well as with the guidelines established as part of the uniform regulatory framework for prompt corrective supervisory action toward financial institutions. The framework for prompt corrective action categorizes capital levels into one of five classification ratings from well-capitalized to critically under-capitalized. For an institution to be eligible to be classified as well capitalized its Total risk-based capital ratios must be at least 10.0% for total capital, 6.5% for Common Equity Tier 1 and 8.0% for Tier 1 capital, and its leverage ratio must be at least 5.0%. In reaching an overall conclusion on capital adequacy or assigning a classification under the uniform framework, regulators also consider other subjective and quantitative measures of risk associated with an institution. The Company and the Bank were deemed to be well capitalized based upon the most recent notifications from their regulators. There are no conditions or events since those notifications that management believes would change the classifications. At December 31, 2025 and 2024, the Company and the Bank were in compliance with all of their respective minimum regulatory capital requirements.

Table of Contents

Following is a summary of the actual regulatory capital amounts and ratios for the Company and the Bank together with corresponding regulatory capital requirements at December 31, 2025 and 2024.

Actual Required for Minimum<br>Capital Adequacy Required To Be<br>Well Capitalized
($ in thousands) Amount Ratio % Amount Ratio % Amount Ratio %
At December 31, 2025
Tier 1 leverage capital
Hancock Whitney Corporation $ 3,872,490 11.17 $ 1,386,435 4.00 $ 1,733,044 5.00
Hancock Whitney Bank 3,753,825 10.84 1,385,477 4.00 1,731,847 5.00
Common equity tier 1 (to risk weighted assets)
Hancock Whitney Corporation $ 3,872,490 13.65 $ 1,276,984 4.50 $ 1,844,532 6.50
Hancock Whitney Bank 3,753,825 13.24 1,275,931 4.50 1,843,011 6.50
Tier 1 capital (to risk weighted assets)
Hancock Whitney Corporation $ 3,872,490 13.65 $ 1,702,645 6.00 $ 2,270,193 8.00
Hancock Whitney Bank 3,753,825 13.24 1,701,241 6.00 2,268,322 8.00
Total capital (to risk weighted assets)
Hancock Whitney Corporation $ 4,383,948 15.45 $ 2,270,193 8.00 $ 2,837,741 10.00
Hancock Whitney Bank 4,092,783 14.43 2,268,322 8.00 2,835,402 10.00
At December 31, 2024
Tier 1 leverage capital
Hancock Whitney Corporation $ 3,886,926 11.29 $ 1,377,216 4.00 $ 1,721,520 5.00
Hancock Whitney Bank 3,754,217 10.91 1,376,113 4.00 1,720,142 5.00
Common equity tier 1 (to risk weighted assets)
Hancock Whitney Corporation $ 3,886,926 14.14 $ 1,237,066 4.50 $ 1,786,873 6.50
Hancock Whitney Bank 3,754,217 13.67 1,235,956 4.50 1,785,270 6.50
Tier 1 capital (to risk weighted assets)
Hancock Whitney Corporation $ 3,886,926 14.14 $ 1,649,421 6.00 $ 2,199,228 8.00
Hancock Whitney Bank 3,754,217 13.67 1,647,942 6.00 2,197,256 8.00
Total capital (to risk weighted assets)
Hancock Whitney Corporation $ 4,378,748 15.93 $ 2,199,228 8.00 $ 2,749,036 10.00
Hancock Whitney Bank 4,073,539 14.83 2,197,256 8.00 2,746,570 10.00

Regulatory Restrictions on Dividends

Regulatory policy statements provide that generally, bank holding companies should pay dividends only out of current operating earnings and that the level of dividends must be consistent with current and expected capital requirements. Dividends received from the Bank have been the primary source of funds available to the Company for the payment of dividends to its stockholders. Federal and State banking laws and regulations restrict the amount of dividends the Bank may distribute to the Company without prior regulatory approval, as well as the amount of loans it may make to the Company. Dividends paid by the Bank are subject to approval by the Commissioner of Banking and Consumer Finance of the State of Mississippi. Further, a capital conservation buffer of 2.5% above each of the minimum capital ratio requirements (Common Equity Tier 1, Tier 1, and Total risk-based capital) must be met for a bank or bank holding company to be able to pay dividends without restrictions.

Table of Contents

Note 14. Other Noninterest Income and Other Noninterest Expense

The components of other noninterest income and other noninterest expense are as follows:

Years Ended December 31,
($ in thousands) 2025 2024 2023
Other noninterest income:
Income from bank-owned life insurance $ 21,348 $ 16,944 $ 15,454
Credit-related fees 11,273 12,036 12,557
Income (loss) from derivatives 5,819 (3,790 ) 420
Net gains on sales of premises, equipment and other assets 6,119 7,820 19,388
Other miscellaneous income 23,023 26,991 23,617
Total other noninterest income $ 67,582 $ 60,001 $ 71,436
Other noninterest expense:
Corporate value and franchise taxes $ 17,272 $ 19,002 $ 20,355
Advertising 14,261 13,298 13,454
Telecommunication and postage 10,134 9,519 10,773
Entertainment and contributions 12,900 11,849 10,664
Tax credit investment amortization 4,258 6,250 5,791
Travel expenses 7,115 5,965 5,469
Printing and supplies 3,981 3,939 4,073
Other retirement expense (16,172 ) (18,112 ) (13,460 )
Other miscellaneous expense 34,267 32,773 31,573
Total other noninterest expense $ 88,016 $ 84,483 $ 88,692

Note 15. Income Taxes

Income tax expense included in net income consisted of the following components:

Years Ended December 31,
($ in thousands) 2025 2024 2023
Included in net income
Current federal $ 89,830 $ 94,382 $ 72,884
Current state 13,270 14,477 10,656
Total current provision 103,100 108,859 83,540
Deferred federal 21,114 3,648 12,139
Deferred state 2,108 651 1,847
Total deferred provision 23,222 4,299 13,986
Total expense included in net income $ 126,322 $ 113,158 $ 97,526

Income tax expense does not reflect the tax effects of amounts recognized in other comprehensive income and in AOCI, a separate component of stockholders’ equity. These amounts include unrealized gains and losses on securities available for sale or transferred to held to maturity, unrealized gains and losses on derivatives and hedging transactions, and valuation adjustments of defined benefit and other post-retirement benefit plans. Refer to Note 13 – Stockholders’ Equity for additional information.

Temporary differences arise between the tax bases of assets or liabilities and their carrying amounts for financial reporting purposes. The expected tax effects from when these differences are resolved are recorded currently as deferred tax assets or liabilities.

Table of Contents

Significant components of the Company’s deferred tax assets and liabilities were as follows:

December 31,
($ in thousands) 2025 2024
Deferred tax assets:
Allowance for loan losses $ 73,479 $ 80,270
Federal and state net operating loss 8,483 2,560
Lease liability 27,399 26,686
Net unrealized losses on securities available-for-sale and cash flow hedges 93,189 155,432
Derivatives 12,304 22,840
Other 10,015 14,271
Gross deferred tax assets 224,869 302,059
Valuation allowance (5,928 ) (4,623 )
Net deferred tax assets $ 218,941 $ 297,436
Deferred tax liabilities:
Employee compensation and benefits $ (20,660 ) $ (14,708 )
Fixed assets & intangibles (35,435 ) (33,500 )
Lease financing (66,455 ) (60,354 )
Right-of-use asset (23,014 ) (22,383 )
Loan purchase accounting adjustments (8 )
Other (17,579 ) (19,916 )
Gross deferred tax liabilities $ (163,143 ) $ (150,869 )
Net deferred tax asset $ 55,798 $ 146,567

Reported income tax expense differed from amounts computed by applying the statutory income tax rate of 21% for the years ended December 31, 2025, 2024 and 2023 to earnings or loss before income taxes. Historically, the primary differences have been due to tax-exempt income, federal and state tax credits and excess tax benefits from stock-based compensation. The main source of tax credits has been investments in tax-advantaged securities and tax credit projects. These investments are made primarily in the markets we serve and directed at tax credits issued under the Federal and State New Market Tax Credit (NMTC) programs, Low-Income Housing Tax Credit (LIHTC) programs, as well as pre-2018 Qualified Zone Academy Bonds (QZAB) and Qualified School Construction Bonds (QSCB). A reconciliation between reported income tax expense and the amounts computed by applying the U.S. federal statutory income tax rate of 21% to income before taxes, prepared in accordance with the revised disclosure requirements of Topic 740, is presented in the table below. Disclosures for the comparative prior periods have been reclassified to conform to the current presentation.

2025 2024 2023
($ in thousands) Amount % Amount % Amount %
U.S. federal statutory tax rate $ 128,603 21.0 % $ 120,534 21.0 % $ 102,927 21.0 %
State income taxes, net of federal income tax effect 11,808 1.9 % 11,953 2.1 % 9,703 2.0 %
Effects of cross-border tax laws
Other 19 0.0 % 0.0 % 2 0.0 %
Tax credits
New market tax credit (4,805 ) (0.8 )% (7,268 ) (1.3 )% (6,924 ) (1.4 )%
Other (2,098 ) (0.3 )% (1,743 ) (0.3 )% (2,650 ) (0.5 )%
Changes in valuation allowances 205 0.0 % 234 0.0 % 1,679 0.3 %
Nontaxable or nondeductible Items
Tax-exempt interest (7,773 ) (1.3 )% (8,443 ) (1.5 )% (8,755 ) (1.8 )%
Life insurance contracts (5,882 ) (1.0 )% (6,017 ) (1.0 )% (4,020 ) (0.8 )%
Other 5,571 1.0 % 3,908 0.7 % 5,136 1.0 %
Changes in unrecognized tax benefits 674 0.1 % 0.0 % 428 0.1 %
Income tax expense $ 126,322 20.6 % $ 113,158 19.7 % $ 97,526 19.9 %

There were no activities or transactions with foreign tax effects or effects of changes in tax laws or rates enacted in any of the periods presented. In 2025, state and local income taxes in Florida and Mississippi comprise the majority of the domestic state and local income taxes, net of federal effect category. In 2024, state and local income taxes in Florida, Mississippi, and Tennessee

Table of Contents

comprise the majority of the domestic state and local income taxes, net of federal effect category. While in 2023, state and local income taxes in Alabama, Florida and Mississippi comprise the majority of the domestic state and local income taxes, net of federal effect category.

The Company had approximately $79.2 million in state net operating loss carryforwards that originated in the tax years 2003 through 2025 and begin expiring in

2032

. A $79.2 million gross state valuation allowance has been established for all non-bank entity level state net operating loss carryforwards, which translates to a net $3.7 million valuation allowance in the Company’s deferred tax inventory. The remainder of the allowance is related to deferred executive compensation. The impact of this valuation allowance is not material to the financial statements.

The tax benefit of a position taken or expected to be taken in a tax return should be recognized when it is more likely than not that the position will be sustained on its technical merits. The liability for unrecognized tax benefits was immaterial as of December 31, 2025, 2024 and 2023. The Company recognizes interest and penalties, if any, related to income tax matters in income tax expense, and the amounts recognized during 2025, 2024 and 2023 were insignificant.

Income taxes paid (net of refunds received), disaggregated by jurisdictional categories (U.S. federal, U.S. state and local and non-U.S.) required by the revised requirements of Topic 740, is presented in the table below. The Company did not pay any non-U.S. taxes in years ended December 31, 2025, 2024 or 2023.

Years Ended December 31,
($ in thousands) 2025 2024 2023
U.S. Federal $ 90,888 $ 52,731 $ 88,668
U.S. state and local
Florida * 3,480 *
Other 12,254 9,900 13,081
Total U.S. state and local 12,254 13,380 13,081
Total income taxes paid (net of refunds received) $ 103,142 $ 66,111 $ 101,749

* The amount of income tax paid (net of refunds received) during this year does not meet the 5% disaggregation threshold.

The Company and its subsidiaries file a consolidated U.S. federal income tax return, as well as filing various state returns. Generally, the federal returns for years prior to 2022 are no longer subject to examination. State returns that are open to examination vary by jurisdiction and are generally open three to four years.

Note 16. Earnings Per Share

The Company calculates earnings per share using the two-class method. The two-class method allocates net income to each class of common stock and participating security according to common dividends declared and participation rights in undistributed earnings. Participating securities consist of nonvested share-based payment awards that contain nonforfeitable rights to dividends or dividend equivalents

A summary of the information used in the computation of earnings per common share follows.

Years Ended December 31,
($ in thousands, except per share data) 2025 2024 2023
Numerator:
Net income to common shareholders $ 486,073 $ 460,815 $ 392,602
Net income or dividends allocated to participating securities - basic and diluted 2,042 3,027 4,014
Net income allocated to common shareholders - basic and diluted $ 484,031 $ 457,788 $ 388,588
Denominator:
Weighted-average common shares - basic 84,905 86,346 86,130
Dilutive potential common shares 535 302 293
Weighted-average common shares - diluted 85,440 86,648 86,423
Earnings per common share:
Basic $ 5.70 $ 5.30 $ 4.51
Diluted $ 5.67 $ 5.28 $ 4.50

Table of Contents

Potential common shares consist of stock options, nonvested performance-based awards, nonvested restricted stock units, and nonvested restricted share awards deferred under the Company’s nonqualified deferred compensation plan. These potential common shares do not enter into the calculation of diluted earnings per share if the impact would be antidilutive, i.e., increase earnings per share or reduce a loss per share. The weighted-average of potentially dilutive common shares that were anti-dilutive totaled 5,394, 16,338 and 100,391 for the years ended December 31, 2025, 2024 and 2023, respectively, and were excluded from the calculation of diluted earnings per common diluted share for the respective periods.

Note 17. Segment Reporting

U.S. GAAP requires that information be reported about a company’s operating segments using a “management approach.” Reportable segments are identified in these standards as those revenue-producing components for which discrete financial information is produced internally and which are subject to evaluation by the chief operating decision maker in deciding how to allocate resources to segments. The Company has identified the Capital Committee as the chief operating decision maker. The Capital Committee is comprised of the Chief Executive Officer, Chief Financial Officer, Hancock Whitney Bank President and Chief Operating Officer, Chief Credit Officer, Chief Risk Officer, Chief Human Resources Officer, and General Counsel. Consistent with the Company’s strategy that is focused on providing a consistent package of banking products and services across all markets, the Company has identified its overall banking operations as its only reportable segment.

The Capital Committee primarily uses net income and its components to make operational and financial decisions and manage the Company. Financial reports utilized include actual results compared to budget, forecasts, prior period results, peer information, and analyst estimates. The accounting policies used to measure the profit and loss of the segment are the same as those described in the summary of significant accounting policies found in Note 1 – Summary of Significant Accounting Policies and Recent Accounting Pronouncements. The significant segment expenses included in net income are presented in the financial statement captions shown on the face of the Consolidated Statements of Income and in Note 14 – Other Noninterest Income and Other Noninterest Expense, and align materially with those reported to the Capital Committee. There are no other segment items that are required to reconcile expenses included in net income to significant expenses reviewed by the Capital Committee.

Note 18. Retirement Benefit Plans

The Company sponsors a qualified defined benefit pension plan, the Hancock Whitney Corporation Pension Plan and Trust Agreement (“Pension Plan”), covering certain eligible associates. Eligibility is based on minimum age and service-related requirements. In 2017, the Pension Plan was amended to exclude any individual hired or rehired by the Company after June 30, 2017 from eligibility to participate. The Pension Plan amendment further provided that the accrued benefits of each participant in the Pension Plan whose combined age plus years of service as of January 1, 2018 totaled less than 55 were to be frozen as of January 1, 2018, and not thereafter increase.

The Company makes contributions to this plan in amounts sufficient to meet funding requirements set forth in federal employee benefit and tax laws, plus such additional amounts as the Company may determine to be appropriate. The Company was not required to make a contribution to the Pension Plan during 2025 or 2024. The Company does not anticipate being required to make a contribution, nor does it anticipate making a discretionary contribution to the Pension Plan in 2026.

The Company also offers a defined contribution retirement benefit plan, the Hancock Whitney Corporation 401(k) Savings Plan and Trust Agreement (“401(k) Plan”), that covers substantially all associates who have been employed 60 days and meet a minimum age requirement and employment classification criteria. The Company matches 100% of the first 1% of compensation saved by a participant, and 50% of the next 5% of compensation saved. Newly eligible associates are automatically enrolled at an initial 3% savings rate unless the associate actively opts out of participation in the plan. The 401(k) Plan was also amended during the second quarter of 2017 for participants whose benefits were frozen under the Pension Plan to add an enhanced Company contribution beginning January 1, 2018, in the amount of 2%, 4% or 6% of such participant’s eligible compensation, based on the participant’s age and years of service with the Company. The 401(k) Plan’s amendment further provided that the Company will contribute to the benefit of those associates of the Company hired or rehired after June 30, 2017, and those associates of the Company never enrolled in the Pension Plan an additional basic contribution in an amount equal to 2% of the associate’s eligible compensation beginning January 1, 2018. Participants vest in the new basic and enhanced Company contributions upon completion of three years of service.

The Company’s 401(k) plan matching expense totaled $18.8 million, $17.8 million and $17.9 million for the years ended December 31, 2025, 2024, and 2023, respectively.

Certain associates who were designated executive officers of Whitney Holding Corporation and/or Whitney National Bank before the acquisition by the Company are also covered by an unfunded nonqualified defined benefit pension plan. The benefits under this

Table of Contents

nonqualified plan were designed to supplement amounts to be paid under the defined benefit plan previously maintained for employees of Whitney Holding Corporation and/or Whitney National Bank (the “Whitney Pension Plan”), and are calculated using the Whitney Pension Plan’s formula, but without applying the restrictions imposed on qualified plans by certain provisions of the Internal Revenue Code. Accrued benefits under this plan were frozen as of December 31, 2012 in connection with the merger of the Whitney Pension Plan into the Company’s qualified defined benefit pension plan, and no future benefits will be accrued under this plan.

The Company also sponsors defined benefit postretirement plans for certain associates. The Hancock postretirement plans are available only to associates hired by the Company prior to January 1, 2000. The Hancock plans provide health care and life insurance benefits to retiring associates who participate in medical and/or group life insurance benefit plans for active associates and have reached 55 years of age with ten years of service, at the time of retirement. The postretirement health care plan is contributory, with retiree contributions adjusted annually and subject to certain employer contribution maximums.

The Whitney postretirement plans are available only to former employees of Whitney Holding Corporation and/or Whitney National Bank who meet the eligibility requirements, and offer health care and life insurance benefits for eligible retirees and their eligible dependents. Participant contributions are required under the health plan. These plans restrict eligibility for postretirement health benefits to retirees already receiving benefits as of the date of the plan amendments in 2007 and to those active participants who were eligible to receive benefits as of December 31, 2007 (i.e., were age 55 with ten years of credited service). Life insurance benefits are currently only available to associates who retired before December 31, 2007.

The Company assumed certain trends in health care costs in the determination of the benefit obligations. The plans assumed a 7.50% increase in health costs, increasing to 8.00% in 2026, declining to 5.75% uniformly over a three year period, and then following the Getzen model thereafter. At December 31, 2025, the mortality assumption was based on Revised RP-2014 Employee and Healthy Annuitants Bottom Quartile Fully Generational Mortality Table for Males and Females - Projected with Improvement Scale MP-2021.

Table of Contents

The following tables detail the changes in the benefit obligations and plan assets of the defined benefit plans for the years ended December 31, 2025 and 2024, as well as the funded status of the plans at each year end and the amounts recognized in the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheets. The Company uses a December 31 measurement date for all defined benefit pension plans and other postretirement benefit plans.

Pension Benefits Other Post-Retirement Benefits
($ in thousands) 2025 2024 2025 2024
Change in benefit obligation
Benefit obligation at beginning of year $ 486,231 $ 517,648 $ 10,447 $ 13,404
Service cost 6,061 7,707 24 31
Interest cost 25,086 24,047 520 578
Plan participants' contributions 549 608
Plan amendments 369
Net actuarial gain (loss) 16,517 (35,453 ) 170 (2,371 )
Benefits paid (27,988 ) (27,718 ) (1,469 ) (1,803 )
Benefit obligation, end of year 505,907 486,231 10,610 10,447
Change in plan assets
Fair value of plan assets at beginning of year 734,820 723,064
Actual return on plan assets 81,135 40,388
Employer contributions 1,320 1,264 920 1,196
Plan participants' contributions 549 608
Benefit payments (27,988 ) (27,718 ) (1,469 ) (1,804 )
Expenses (2,286 ) (2,178 )
Fair value of plan assets, end of year 787,001 734,820
Funded status at end of year - net asset (liability) $ 281,094 $ 248,589 $ (10,610 ) $ (10,447 )
Amounts recognized in accumulated other comprehensive loss
Unrecognized loss (gain) at beginning of year $ 109,324 $ 141,049 $ (9,474 ) $ (7,902 )
Net actuarial loss (gain) (21,678 ) (31,725 ) 1,166 (1,572 )
Unrecognized loss (gain) at end of year $ 87,646 $ 109,324 $ (8,308 ) $ (9,474 )
Projected benefit obligation $ 505,907 $ 486,231
Accumulated benefit obligation 488,780 467,634
Fair value of plan assets 787,001 734,820

The net funded status of $281.1 million for pension benefits plans includes an excess of plan assets over the benefit obligation of $292.4 million on the defined benefit pension plan, partially offset by an unfunded benefit obligation of $11.3 million for the nonqualified retirement plan.

Net actuarial gain is a significant component of the change in the projected benefit obligation of the Pension Plan for the year ended December 31, 2025. The actuarial gain was primarily driven by a change in the discount rate used in computing the projected benefit obligation at December 31, 2025.

Table of Contents

The following table shows net periodic (benefit) cost included in expense and the changes in the amounts recognized in AOCI during the years ended December 31, 2025, 2024, and 2023.

Pension Benefits Other Post-Retirement Benefits
($ in thousands) 2025 2024 2023 2025 2024 2023
Net periodic (benefit) cost
Service cost $ 6,061 $ 7,707 $ 7,916 $ 24 $ 31 $ 34
Interest cost 25,086 24,047 23,854 520 578 622
Expected return on plan assets (45,059 ) (47,626 ) (44,710 )
Amortization of net (gain) loss/prior service cost 4,404 5,687 7,643 (1,123 ) (799 ) (843 )
Net periodic benefit (9,508 ) (10,185 ) (5,297 ) (579 ) (190 ) (187 )
Other changes in plan assets and benefit<br>   obligations recognized in other<br>   comprehensive income, before taxes
Net (loss) gain recognized during the year (4,404 ) (5,687 ) (7,643 ) 1,123 799 843
Net actuarial loss (gain) (17,274 ) (26,038 ) 13,449 43 (2,371 ) 92
Total recognized in other comprehensive<br>   income (21,678 ) (31,725 ) 5,806 1,166 (1,572 ) 935
Total recognized in net periodic benefit<br>   cost and other comprehensive income $ (31,186 ) $ (41,910 ) $ 509 $ 587 $ (1,762 ) $ 748
Discount rate for benefit obligations 5.35 % 5.62 % 4.83 % 5.28 % 5.56 % 4.81 %
Discount rate for net periodic benefit cost 5.62 % 4.83 % 5.00 % 5.56 % 4.81 % 4.98 %
Expected long-term return on plan assets 6.25 % 6.50 % 6.50 % n/a n/a n/a
Rate of compensation increase scaled * scaled * scaled * n/a n/a n/a

*Graded scale, declining from 7.25% at age 20 to 2.25% at age 65

The long term rate of return on plan assets is determined by using the weighted-average of historical real returns for major asset classes based on target asset allocations. For all periods presented, the discount rate for the benefit obligation was calculated by matching expected future cash flows to the USI Consulting Group Pension Discount Curve (AA).

The following table presents expected plan benefit payments over the ten years succeeding December 31, 2025:

($ in thousands) Pension Post-Retirement Total
2026 $ 30,922 $ 837 $ 31,759
2027 32,352 873 33,225
2028 33,579 885 34,464
2029 34,791 852 35,643
2030 36,008 817 36,825
2031-2035 190,109 3,772 193,881
. $ 357,761 $ 8,036 $ 365,797

The expected benefit payments are estimated based on the same assumptions used to measure the Company’s benefit obligations at December 31, 2025.

The fair values of pension plan assets at December 31, 2025 and 2024, by asset category, are shown in the following tables. The fair value is presented based on the Financial Accounting Standards Board’s fair value hierarchy that prioritizes inputs into the valuation techniques used to measure fair value. Level 1 uses quoted prices in active markets for identical assets, Level 2 uses significant observable inputs, and Level 3 uses significant unobservable inputs. In accordance with Subtopic 820-10 common trust funds are reported at fair value using net asset value per share (or its equivalent) as a practical expedient and are not classified in the fair value hierarchy.

Table of Contents

For all investments, the plan attempts to use quoted market prices of identical assets on active exchanges, or Level 1 measurements. Where such quoted market prices are not available, the plan will use quoted prices for similar instruments or discounted cash flows to estimate the value, reported as Level 2.

Fair Value Measurements by Asset Category / Fund Level 2 Level 3 Total
( in thousands)
Cash and equivalents 5,732 $ $ $ 5,732
Total cash and cash equivalents 5,732 5,732
Fixed income securities 37,238 34,384 71,622
Exchange Traded Fund (ETF)-Fixed income 4,834 4,834
Total fixed income 42,072 34,384 76,456
Domestic and foreign stock 50,646 50,646
Mutual funds-equity 40,900 40,900
Total equity 91,546 91,546
Total assets at fair value 139,350 34,384 173,734
Collective investment trust fund - equity 62,901
Common trust funds (fixed income) 483,491
Common trust fund (real assets) 66,875
Total 139,350 $ 34,384 $ $ 787,001

All values are in US Dollars.

Fair Value Measurements by Asset Category / Fund Level 2 Level 3 Total
( in thousands)
Cash and equivalents 6,357 $ $ $ 6,357
Total cash and cash equivalents 6,357 6,357
Fixed income securities 26,476 37,726 64,202
Exchange Traded Fund (ETF)-Fixed income 4,133 4,133
Total fixed income 30,609 37,726 68,335
Domestic and foreign stock 48,279 48,279
Mutual funds-equity 38,812 38,812
Total equity 87,091 87,091
Total assets at fair value 124,057 37,726 161,783
Common trust funds (fixed income) 514,562
Common trust fund (real assets) 58,475
Total 124,057 $ 37,726 $ $ 734,820

All values are in US Dollars.

The following table presents the percentage allocation of the plan assets by asset category and corresponding target allocations at December 31, 2025 and 2024.

Plan Assets Target Allocation
at December 31, at December 31,
2025 2024 2025 2024
Asset category:
Cash and equivalents 1 % 1 % 0 - 5% 0 - 5%
Fixed income securities 71 79 8-72% 8-72%
Equity securities 20 12 16-22% 16-22%
Real assets 8 8 4-10% 4-10%
100 % 100 %

Plan assets are invested in long-term strategies and evaluated within the context of a long-term investment horizon, and the ultimate pension benefit obligation they are meant to satisfy. The overall goal of the investment program is to ensure solvency of the Plan, enabling the payment of pension obligations over time as they come due. Plan assets are diversified across multiple asset classes to minimize the risk of large losses, and are increasingly allocated to assets with characteristics that are likely to mimic the interest rate sensitivity of the Plan’s liabilities. Through these investments, the Plan seeks to offset the volatility of its liabilities and therefore reduce the volatility of the Plan’s funded status. Typically, the allocation will include investments in long duration fixed income

Table of Contents

securities. Short-term fluctuations in value are considered secondary to long-term results. The investment performance of the plan is regularly monitored to ensure that appropriate risk levels are being achieved and to evaluate returns versus a suitable market benchmark. The benefits investment committee meets periodically to review the policy, strategy, and performance of the plans.

Note 19. Share-Based Payment Arrangements

The Company maintains incentive compensation plans that incorporate share-based payment arrangements for associates and directors. The current plan under which share-based awards may be granted, the 2020 Long Term Incentive Plan (the “2020 Plan”), was approved by the Company’s stockholders at the 2020 annual meeting as a successor to the Company’s 2014 Long-Term Incentive Plan (the “2014 Plan”). Certain share-based awards remain outstanding under the 2014 Plan and prior equity incentive compensation plans, but no future awards may be granted thereunder.

The Compensation Committee of the Company’s Board of Directors administers the equity incentive plans, makes determinations with respect to participation by employees or directors and authorizes the share-based awards. Under the 2020 Plan, participants may be awarded stock options (including incentive stock options for associates), restricted shares, performance stock awards and stock appreciation rights, all on a stand-alone, combination or tandem basis. To date, the Committee has awarded stock options, tenure-based restricted share awards and units, and performance stock units under the 2020 Plan and the prior equity incentive plans.

Under the 2020 Plan, future awards may be granted for the issuance of an aggregate of 5,200,000 shares of the Company’s common stock, plus a number of additional shares of the Company’s common stock (not to exceed 1,000,000) for which awards under the 2014 Plan are cancelled, expired, forfeited or otherwise not issued, or settled in cash. The 2020 Plan limits the number of shares for which awards may be granted to any participant during any calendar year to 250,000 shares. The Company may use authorized unissued shares or shares held in treasury to satisfy awards under the 2020 Plan.

As of December 31, 2025, there were approximately 2.2 million shares available for future issuance under the 2020 equity compensation plan.

For the years ended December 31, 2025, 2024 and 2023, total share-based compensation expense recognized in income was $24.4 million, $22.7 million and $24.7 million, respectively. The total recognized income tax benefit related to the share-based compensation was $6.7 million, $6.3 million and $5.7 million for 2025, 2024 and 2023, respectively.

A summary of the Company’s nonvested restricted and performance shares for the year ended December 31, 2025 is presented below:

Number of<br>Shares Weighted-Average<br>Grant-Date<br>Fair Value
Nonvested at January 1, 2025 1,391,236 $ 46.14
Granted 561,240 56.14
Vested (481,141 ) 44.84
Cancelled/Forfeited (71,140 ) 48.02
Nonvested at December 31, 2025 1,400,195 $ 50.51

At December 31, 2025, there was $47.8 million of total unrecognized compensation expense related to nonvested restricted and performance share awards and units expected to vest in the future. This compensation is expected to be recognized in expense over a weighted-average period of

2.9

years. The fair value of shares that vested during the years ended December 31, 2025 and 2024 totaled $21.5 million and $24.0 million, respectively.

During the year ended December 31, 2025, the Company granted 445,989 restricted stock units (RSUs) to certain eligible employees. The holders of unvested restricted stock units have no rights as a shareholder of the Company, including voting or dividend rights. The Company has elected to award dividend equivalents on each restricted stock unit not deferred under the Company's nonqualified deferred compensation plan. Such dividend equivalents are forfeited should the employee terminate employment prior to the vesting of the RSU.

During the year ended December 31, 2025, the Company granted to key members of executive management 26,989 performance share awards subject to a total shareholder return (“TSR”) performance metric with a grant date fair value of $66.84 per share. The fair value of the performance share units subject to TSR at the grant date was determined using a Monte Carlo simulation method. The number of performance share units subject to TSR that ultimately vest at the end of the three-year performance period, if any, will be based on the relative rank of the Company’s three-year TSR among the TSRs of a peer group of 49 regional banks. The

Table of Contents

Company also granted 26,198 performance share awards subject to a return on average assets (ROAA) performance metric and 26,198 performance share awards subject to a return on average tangible common equity (ROATCE) performance metric with a grant date fair value of $52.02 per share for both performance share awards. The number of performance shares subject to ROAA and ROTCE that ultimately vest if any, will be based on the relative rank of the Company’s three-year ROAA and ROATCE relative the KBW Regional Bank index. The maximum number of performance share units that could vest is 200% of the target award. Compensation expense for these performance shares is recognized on a straight-line basis over the three-year service period.

Note 20. Commitments and Contingencies

Credit Related

In the normal course of business, the Bank enters into financial instruments, such as commitments to extend credit and letters of credit, to meet the financing needs of its customers. Such instruments are not reflected in the accompanying consolidated financial statements until they are funded, although they expose the Bank to varying degrees of credit risk and interest rate risk in much the same way as funded loans. Under regulatory capital guidelines, the Company and Bank must include unfunded commitments meeting certain criteria in risk-weighted capital calculations.

Commitments to extend credit include revolving commercial credit lines, nonrevolving loan commitments issued mainly to finance the acquisition and development or construction of real property or equipment, and credit card and personal credit lines. The availability of funds under commercial credit lines and loan commitments generally depends on whether the borrower continues to meet credit standards established in the underlying contract and other contractual conditions. Loan commitments generally have fixed expiration dates or other termination clauses and may require payment of a fee by the borrower. Credit card and personal credit lines are generally subject to cancellation if the borrower’s credit quality deteriorates. A number of commercial and personal credit lines are used only partially or, in some cases, not at all before they expire, and the total commitment amounts do not necessarily represent future cash requirements of the Company.

A substantial majority of the letters of credit are standby agreements that obligate the Bank to fulfill a customer’s financial commitments to a third party if the customer is unable to perform. The Bank issues standby letters of credit primarily to provide credit enhancement to its customers’ other commercial or public financing arrangements and to help them demonstrate financial capacity to vendors of essential goods and services.

The contractual amounts of these instruments reflect the Company’s exposure to credit risk. The Company undertakes the same credit evaluation in making loan commitments and assuming conditional obligations as it does for on-balance sheet instruments and may require collateral or other credit support. At December 31, 2025 and 2024, the Company had a reserve for unfunded lending commitments totaling $33.9 million and $24.1 million, respectively.

The following table presents a summary of the Company’s off-balance sheet financial instruments as of December 31, 2025 and December 31, 2024:

December 31,
($ in thousands) 2025 2024
Commitments to extend credit $ 9,650,197 $ 9,249,468
Letters of credit 409,010 420,614

Legal Proceedings

The Company is party to various legal proceedings arising in the ordinary course of business. Management does not believe that loss contingencies, if any, arising from pending litigation and regulatory matters will have a material adverse effect on the consolidated financial position or liquidity of the Company.

Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (FDIC) Special Assessment

In November 2023, the FDIC approved a final rule to implement a special deposit insurance assessment to recover losses to the Deposit Insurance Fund (DIF) arising from the full protection of uninsured depositors under the systemic risk exception following the receiverships of Silicon Valley Bank and Signature Bank in the spring of 2023. To-date, the Company has expensed $27.6 million related to this special assessment based on loss estimate information provided by the FDIC.

The loss estimates resulting from the failures of these institutions may be subject to further change pending the projected and actual outcome of loss share agreements, joint ventures, and outstanding litigation. The exact amount of losses incurred will not be

Table of Contents

determined until the FDIC terminates the receiverships of these banks; therefore, the Company’s exact exposure for FDIC special assessment remains unknown.

Note 21. Fair Value Measurements

The FASB defines fair value as the exchange price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in the principal or most advantageous market for the asset or liability in an orderly transaction between market participants on the measurement date. The FASB’s guidance also establishes a fair value hierarchy that prioritizes the inputs to these valuation techniques used to measure fair value, giving preference to quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities (level 1) and the lowest priority to unobservable inputs such as a reporting entity’s own data (level 3). Level 2 inputs include quoted prices for similar assets or liabilities in active markets, quoted prices for identical assets or liabilities in markets that are not active, observable inputs other than quoted prices, such as interest rates and yield curves, and inputs that are derived principally from or corroborated by observable market data by correlation or other means.

Fair Value of Assets and Liabilities Measured on a Recurring Basis

The following tables present, for each of the fair value hierarchy levels, the Company’s financial assets and liabilities that are measured at fair value on a recurring basis on the consolidated balance sheets at December 31, 2025 and 2024:

December 31, 2025
($ in thousands) Level 1 Level 2 Level 3 Total
Assets
Available for sale debt securities:
U.S. Treasury and government agency securities $ $ 269,332 $ $ 269,332
Municipal obligations 191,328 191,328
Corporate debt securities 16,357 16,357
Residential mortgage-backed securities 2,375,629 2,375,629
Commercial mortgage-backed securities 3,083,325 3,083,325
Collateralized mortgage obligations 25,946 25,946
Total available for sale securities 5,961,917 5,961,917
Mortgage loans held for sale 33,158 33,158
Derivative assets (1) 63,126 63,126
Total recurring fair value measurements - assets $ $ 6,058,201 $ $ 6,058,201
Liabilities
Derivative liabilities (1) $ $ 94,083 $ 1,284 $ 95,367
Total recurring fair value measurements - liabilities $ $ 94,083 $ 1,284 $ 95,367

(1) For further disaggregation of derivative assets and liabilities, see Note 12 – Derivatives.

December 31, 2024
(in thousands) Level 1 Level 2 Level 3 Total
Assets
Available for sale debt securities:
U.S. Treasury and government agency securities $ $ 182,282 $ $ 182,282
Municipal obligations 196,330 196,330
Corporate debt securities 17,616 17,616
Residential mortgage-backed securities 2,129,051 2,129,051
Commercial mortgage-backed securities 2,600,965 2,600,965
Collateralized mortgage obligations 35,247 35,247
Total available for sale securities 5,161,491 5,161,491
Mortgage loans held for sale 18,929 18,929
Derivative assets (1) 73,840 73,840
Total recurring fair value measurements - assets $ $ 5,254,260 $ $ 5,254,260
Liabilities
Derivative liabilities (1) $ $ 158,534 $ 2,089 $ 160,623
Total recurring fair value measurements - liabilities $ $ 158,534 $ 2,089 $ 160,623

(1) For further disaggregation of derivative assets and liabilities, see Note 12 – Derivatives.

Table of Contents

Securities classified as level 2 include obligations of U.S. Government agencies and U.S. Government-sponsored agencies, including U.S. Treasury securities, residential and commercial mortgage-backed securities and collateralized mortgage obligations that are issued or guaranteed by U.S. government agencies, and state and municipal bonds. The level 2 fair value measurements for investment securities are obtained quarterly from a third-party pricing service that uses industry-standard pricing models. Substantially all of the model inputs are observable in the marketplace or can be supported by observable data. The Company invests only in securities of investment grade quality with a targeted duration, for the overall portfolio, generally between two and five and a half years. Company policies generally limit U.S. investments to agency securities and municipal securities determined to be investment grade according to an internally generated score which generally includes a rating of not less than “Baa” or its equivalent by a nationally recognized statistical rating agency.

Loans held for sale consist of residential mortgage loans carried under the fair value option. The fair value for these instruments is classified as level 2 based on market prices obtained from potential buyers.

For the Company’s derivative financial instruments designated as hedges and those under the customer interest rate program, the fair value is obtained from a third-party pricing service that uses an industry-standard discounted cash flow model that relies on inputs, Overnight Index swap rate curves, and SOFR swap curves (where applicable); all observable in the marketplace. To comply with the accounting guidance, credit valuation adjustments are incorporated in the fair values to appropriately reflect nonperformance risk for both the Company and the counterparties. Although the Company has determined that the majority of the inputs used to value these derivative instruments fall within level 2 of the fair value hierarchy, the credit value adjustments utilize level 3 inputs, such as estimates of current credit spreads. The Company has determined that the impact of the credit valuation adjustments is not significant to the overall valuation of these derivatives. As a result, the Company has classified its derivative valuations for these instruments in level 2 of the fair value hierarchy. The Company’s policy is to measure counterparty credit risk quarterly for derivative instruments, which are all subject to master netting arrangements consistent with how market participants would price the net risk exposure at the measurement date.

The Company also has certain derivative instruments associated with the Bank’s mortgage-banking activities. These derivative instruments include interest rate lock commitments on prospective residential mortgage loans and forward commitments to sell these loans to investors on a best efforts delivery basis and To Be Announced securities for mandatory delivery contracts. The fair value of these derivative instruments is measured using observable market prices for similar instruments and is classified as a level 2 measurement.

The Company’s level 3 liability consists of a derivative contract with the purchaser of 192,163 shares of Visa Class B common stock. Pursuant to the agreement, the Company retains the risks associated with the ultimate conversion of the Visa Class B common shares into shares of Visa Class A common stock, such that the counterparty will be compensated for any dilutive adjustments to the conversion ratio and the Company will be compensated for any anti-dilutive adjustments to the ratio. The agreement also requires periodic payments by the Company to the counterparty calculated by reference to the market price of Visa Class A common shares at the time of sale and a fixed rate of interest that stepped up once after the eighth scheduled quarterly payment. The fair value of the liability is determined using a discounted cash flow methodology. The significant unobservable inputs used in the fair value measurement are the Company’s own assumptions about estimated changes in the conversion rate of the Visa Class B common shares into Visa Class A common shares, the date on which such conversion is expected to occur and the estimated growth rate of the Visa Class A common share price. Refer to Note 12 – Derivatives for information about the derivative contract with the counterparty.

The Company believes its valuation methods for its assets and liabilities carried at fair value are appropriate; however, the use of different methodologies or assumptions, particularly as applied to level 3 assets and liabilities, could have a material effect on the computation of their estimated fair values.

Changes in Level 3 Fair Value Measurements and Quantitative Information about Level 3 Fair Value Measurements

The nominal changes in the fair value of level 3 financial instruments is due to the net impact of cash settlements and losses included in earnings. The level 3 fair value measurement was based on discounted cash flows, with a Visa Class B common share conversion ratio range of 1.55x to 1.54x and an estimated time to resolution of 21 to 33 months. The range of sensitivities that management utilized in its fair value calculations is deemed acceptable in the industry with respect to the identified financial instrument.

The Company’s policy is to recognize transfers between valuation hierarchy levels as of the end of a reporting period.

Table of Contents

Fair Value of Assets Measured on a Nonrecurring Basis

Certain assets and liabilities are measured at fair value on a nonrecurring basis. Collateral-dependent loans individually evaluated for credit loss are measured at the fair value of the underlying collateral based on independent third-party appraisals that take into consideration market-based information such as recent sales activity for similar assets in the property’s market.

Other real estate owned and foreclosed assets, including both foreclosed property and surplus banking property, are level 3 assets that are adjusted to fair value, less estimated selling costs, upon transfer from loans or property and equipment. Subsequently, other real estate owned and foreclosed assets are carried at the lower of carrying value or fair value less estimated selling costs. Fair values are determined by sales agreement or third-party appraisals as discounted for estimated selling costs, information from comparable sales, and marketability of the assets.

The fair value information presented below is not as of the period end, rather it was as of the date the fair value adjustment was recorded during the twelve months for each of the dates presented below, and excludes nonrecurring fair value measurements of assets no longer on the balance sheet.

The following tables present the Company’s financial assets that are measured at fair value on a nonrecurring basis for each of the fair value hierarchy levels:

December 31, 2025
($ in thousands) Level 1 Level 2 Level 3 Total
Collateral dependent individually evaluated loans $ $ $ 33,762 $ 33,762
Other real estate owned and foreclosed assets 14,788 14,788
Total nonrecurring fair value measurements $ $ $ 48,550 $ 48,550
December 31, 2024
--- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- ---
($ in thousands) Level 1 Level 2 Level 3 Total
Collateral dependent individually evaluated loans $ $ $ 28,301 $ 28,301
Other real estate owned and foreclosed assets 27,797 27,797
Total nonrecurring fair value measurements $ $ $ 56,098 $ 56,098

Accounting guidance from the FASB requires the disclosure of estimated fair value information about certain on- and off-balance sheet financial instruments, including those financial instruments that are not measured and reported at fair value on a recurring basis. The significant methods and assumptions used by the Company to estimate the fair value of financial instruments are discussed below.

Cash, Short-Term Investments and Federal Funds Sold – For these short-term instruments, the carrying amount is a reasonable estimate of fair value.

Securities – The fair value measurement for securities available for sale is discussed earlier in this note. The same measurement techniques were applied to the valuation of securities held to maturity.

Loans, Net – The fair value measurement for certain collateral dependent loans that are individually evaluated for credit loss was described earlier in this note. For the remaining portfolio, fair values were generally determined by discounting scheduled cash flows using discount rates determined with reference to current market rates at which loans with similar terms would be made to borrowers of similar credit quality.

Loans Held For Sale – These loans are either carried under the fair value option or at the lower of cost or market. Given the short duration of these instruments, the carrying amount is considered a reasonable estimate of fair value.

Deposits – The accounting guidance requires that the fair value of deposits with no stated maturity, such as noninterest-bearing demand deposits and interest-bearing checking and savings accounts, be assigned fair values equal to amounts payable upon demand (carrying amounts). The fair value of fixed-maturity certificates of deposit is estimated using the rates currently offered for deposits of similar remaining maturities.

Federal Funds Purchased and Securities Sold under Agreements to Repurchase– For these short-term liabilities, the carrying amount is a reasonable estimate of fair value.

Table of Contents

Short-Term FHLB Borrowings – FHLB borrowings at December 31, 2025 consisted of one short-term fixed rate borrowings (two calendar days outstanding); as such, the carrying amount of the instrument is a reasonable estimate of fair value. There were no FHLB borrowings at December 31, 2024

Long-Term Debt – The fair value is estimated by discounting the future contractual cash flows using current market rates at which debt with similar terms could be obtained.

Derivative Financial Instruments – The fair value measurement for derivative financial instruments is described earlier in this note.

The following tables present the estimated fair values of the Company’s financial instruments by fair value hierarchy levels and the corresponding carrying amounts.

December 31, 2025
Total Carrying
($ in thousands) Level 1 Level 2 Level 3 Fair Value Amount
Financial assets:
Cash, interest-bearing bank deposits, and federal funds<br>sold $ 695,032 $ 229 $ $ 695,261 $ 695,261
Available for sale securities 5,961,917 5,961,917 5,961,917
Held to maturity securities 2,011,026 2,011,026 2,132,882
Loans, net 23,588,681 23,588,681 23,650,709
Loans held for sale 33,158 33,158 33,158
Derivative financial instruments 63,126 63,126 63,126
Financial liabilities:
Deposits $ $ $ 29,274,190 $ 29,274,190 $ 29,279,774
Federal funds purchased 70,400 70,400 70,400
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase 546,892 546,892 546,892
Short-term FHLB Borrowings 400,000 400,000 400,000
Long-term debt 162,257 162,257 199,407
Derivative financial instruments 94,083 1,284 95,367 95,367
December 31, 2024
--- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- ---
Total Carrying
($ in thousands) Level 1 Level 2 Level 3 Fair Value Amount
Financial assets:
Cash, interest-bearing bank deposits, and federal funds<br>sold $ 1,514,216 $ 409 $ $ 1,514,625 $ 1,514,625
Available for sale securities 5,161,491 5,161,491 5,161,491
Held to maturity securities 2,233,526 2,233,526 2,435,663
Loans, net 22,562,577 22,562,577 22,980,565
Loans held for sale 21,525 21,525 21,525
Derivative financial instruments 73,840 73,840 73,840
Financial liabilities:
Deposits $ $ $ 29,482,628 $ 29,482,628 $ 29,492,851
Federal funds purchased 300 300 300
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase 638,715 638,715 638,715
Long-term debt 174,660 174,660 210,544
Derivative financial instruments 158,534 2,089 160,623 160,623

Table of Contents

Note 22. Condensed Parent Company Information

The following condensed financial statements reflect the accounts and transactions of Hancock Whitney Corporation only:

Condensed Balance Sheets

December 31,
($ in thousands) 2025 2024
Assets:
Cash $ 264,514 $ 272,693
Investment in bank subsidiaries 4,341,452 3,994,927
Investment in non-bank subsidiaries 25,830 27,460
Due from subsidiaries and other assets 3,182 3,301
Total assets $ 4,634,978 $ 4,298,381
Liabilities and Stockholders' Equity:
Long term debt $ 167,272 $ 167,120
Other liabilities 7,589 3,625
Stockholders' equity 4,460,117 4,127,636
Total liabilities and stockholders' equity $ 4,634,978 $ 4,298,381

Condensed Statements of Income

Years Ended December 31,
($ in thousands) 2025 2024 2023
Operating income
From subsidiaries:
Cash dividends received from bank subsidiaries $ 380,000 $ 205,000 $ 185,000
Cash dividend from nonbank subsidiary 6,000 6,000
Equity in earnings of subsidiaries greater than dividends received 115,053 265,188 222,731
Total operating income 501,053 476,188 407,731
Other expense, net 19,885 19,828 19,587
Income tax benefit (4,905 ) (4,455 ) (4,458 )
Net income $ 486,073 $ 460,815 $ 392,602
Other comprehensive income, net of tax 229,841 15,035 151,055
Comprehensive income $ 715,914 $ 475,850 $ 543,657

Condensed Statements of Cash Flows

Years Ended December 31,
($ in thousands) 2025 2024 2023
Cash flows from operating activities - principally<br>   dividends received from subsidiaries $ 396,358 $ 227,125 $ 198,093
Net cash provided by operating activities 396,358 227,125 198,093
Cash flows from investing activities:
Proceeds from sale of premises and equipment 320
Net cash provided by investing activities 320
Cash flows from financing activities:
Dividends paid to stockholders (153,803 ) (130,840 ) (104,697 )
Repurchase of common stock (246,874 ) (37,690 )
Proceeds from dividend reinvestment and other incentive plans 4,441 4,422 3,815
Payroll tax remitted on net share settlement of equity awards (8,301 ) (9,358 ) (5,681 )
Net cash used in financing activities (404,537 ) (173,466 ) (106,563 )
Net increase (decrease) in cash (8,179 ) 53,979 91,530
Cash, beginning of year 272,693 218,714 127,184
Cash, end of year $ 264,514 $ 272,693 $ 218,714

Table of Contents

Note 23. Subsequent Event

Subsequent to December 31, 2025, in January 2026, the Company completed a restructuring of its available for sale investment securities portfolio, whereby lower-yielding securities were sold and the proceeds were reinvested in higher-yielding securities. The portfolio restructure included the sale of securities with an amortized cost of $1.5 billion for proceeds of $1.4 billion, resulting in a net pre-tax loss of approximately $98.5 million that will be reflected in earnings for the quarter ending March 31, 2026. Management has evaluated this portfolio restructure in accordance with ASC 855, Subsequent Events, and determined that it represents a nonrecognized subsequent event that did not require an adjustment to the accompanying consolidated financial statements as of December 31, 2025.

Table of Contents

ITEM 9. CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE

None.

ITEM 9A. CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES

Evaluation of Disclosure Controls and Procedures

The term “disclosure controls and procedures” is defined in Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the Exchange Act). The rules refer to our controls and other procedures that are designed to ensure that information required to be disclosed in reports that we file or submit under the Exchange Act is (1) recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time periods specified in the Securities and Exchange Commission’s rules and forms and (2) accumulated and communicated to our management, including our principal executive officer and principal financial officer, as appropriate to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosure.

Management, including our principal executive officer and principal financial officer, has performed an evaluation of the effectiveness of our disclosure controls and procedures and based on that evaluation, our principal executive officer and principal financial officer have concluded that our disclosure controls and procedures were effective as of December 31, 2025.

Internal Control Over Financial Reporting

The Company’s management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting, as such term is defined in Rule 13a-15(f) under the Exchange Act, designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. The Company’s management, with the participation of its principal executive and principal financial officers, evaluated the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2025 based on the framework set forth in Internal Control – Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission. Management also conducted an assessment of requirements pertaining to Section 112 of the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation Improvement Act. This section relates to management’s evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, including controls over the preparation of the schedules equivalent to the basic financial statements in accordance with the instructions to the Consolidated Financial Statements for Bank Holding Companies (Form Y-9C) and compliance with specific laws and regulations. Our evaluation included a review of the documentation of controls, evaluations of the design of the internal control system and tests of the effectiveness of internal controls.

PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, the independent registered public accounting firm that audited the Company’s consolidated financial statements included in Item 8. “Financial Statements and Supplementary Data,” has issued an attestation report on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting, which is also included in Item 8.

Based on the foregoing evaluation, management concluded that the Company’s internal control over financial reporting was effective as of December 31, 2025.

There was no change in the Company’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the fourth quarter of 2025 that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.

ITEM 9B. OTHER INFORMATION

Pursuant to Item 408(a) of Regulation S-K, none of our directors or executive officers adopted, terminated or modified a Rule 10b5-1 trading arrangement or a non-Rule 10b5-1 trading arrangement during the quarter ended December 31, 2025.

Hancock Whitney Corporation will hold its Annual Meeting of Shareholders of common stock virtually on Wednesday, April 29, 2026, at 11:00 a.m. Central Daylight Time. Additional information about the Annual Meeting, including the matters to be considered, will be set forth in the Company’s definitive proxy statement for the 2026 Annual Meeting to be filed in due course with the SEC.

ITEM 9C. DISCLOSURE REGARDING FOREIGN JURISDICTIONS THAT PREVENT INSPECTIONS

None.

Table of Contents

PART III

ITEM 10. DIRECTORS, EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

Information concerning our directors will appear in our definitive proxy statement to be filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission for our 2026 annual meeting of the shareholders under the caption, “Information about Our Directors.” Information concerning compliance with Section 16(a) of the Exchange Act will appear in our proxy statement under the caption, "Delinquent Section 16(a) Reports.” Information concerning our code of business ethics for officers and associates, our code of ethics for financial officers, and our code of ethics for directors will appear in our proxy statement under the caption “Transactions with Related Persons.” Information concerning our audit committee will appear in our proxy statement under the caption “Board of Directors and Corporate Governance – Board Committees – Audit Committee.” The information set forth under each such caption is incorporated herein by reference. The information required by Item 10 of this Report regarding our executive officers appears in a separately captioned heading in Item 1 of this Report.

ITEM 11. EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION

The information required by Item 402, Item 407(e)(4) and Item 407(e)(5) of Regulation S-K will appear in our definitive proxy statement relating to our 2026 annual meeting of shareholders and is incorporated herein by reference.

The Company has adopted an insider trading policy that governs the purchase, sale, and/or other transactions of our securities by directors, officers and associates of the Company and its subsidiaries and their immediate family members (collectively, "Insiders") and any other individuals whom the Company may designate as Insiders because they have access to material nonpublic information concerning the Company. A copy of our insider trading policy is filed as Exhibit 19 to this Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2025. In addition, with regard to the Company’s trading its own securities, it is the Company's policy to comply with federal securities laws and the applicable exchange listing requirements.

ITEM 12. SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT AND RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS

Information concerning ownership of certain beneficial owners and management will appear in our definitive proxy statement relating to our 2026 annual meeting of shareholders under the caption “Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management.” The information set forth under each such caption is incorporated herein by reference.

ITEM 13. CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS, AND DIRECTOR INDEPENDENCE

Information concerning certain relationships and related transactions will appear in our definitive proxy statement relating to our 2026 annual meeting of shareholders under the caption “Transactions with Related Persons.” Information concerning director independence will appear in our proxy statement under the caption “Board of Directors and Corporate Governance.” The information set forth under each such caption is incorporated herein by reference.

ITEM 14. PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTANT FEES AND SERVICES

The Company’s independent registered public accounting firm is PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, New Orleans, LA, Auditor Firm ID

238

. Information concerning principal accountant fees and services will appear in our definitive proxy statement relating to our 2026 annual meeting of shareholders under the caption “Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm.” Such information is incorporated herein by reference.

Table of Contents

PART IV

ITEM 15. EXHIBITS AND FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES

(a) The following documents are filed as part of this Report:

  1. The following consolidated financial statements of Hancock Whitney Corporation and subsidiaries are filed as part of this Report under Item 8. “Financial Statements and Supplementary Data”:

Consolidated Balance Sheets – December 31, 2025 and 2024

Consolidated Statements of Income – Years ended December 31, 2025, 2024 and 2023

Consolidated Statements of Other Comprehensive Income – Years ended December 31, 2025, 2024 and 2023

Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders’ Equity– Years ended December 31, 2025, 2024 and 2023

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows –Years ended December 31, 2025, 2024 and 2023

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements – December 31, 2025

  1. Financial schedules required to be filed by Item 8 of this Report, and by Item 15(d) below:

The schedules to the consolidated financial statements set forth by Article 9 of Regulation S-X are not required under the related instructions or are inapplicable and, therefore, have been omitted.

  1. Exhibits required to be filed by Item 601 of Regulation S-K, and by Item 15(b) below.

All other financial statements and schedules are omitted as the required information is inapplicable or the required information is presented in the consolidated financial statements or related notes.

Table of Contents

EXHIBIT INDEX
Exhibit<br>Number Description
3.1 Second Amended and Restated Articles of Incorporation of the Company (filed as Exhibit 3.1 to the Company’s 8-K (File No. 001-36872) filed with the Commission on May 1, 2020, and incorporated herein by reference).
3.2 Second Amended and Restated Bylaws of the Company (filed as Exhibit 3.2 to the Company’s 8-K (File No. 001-36872) filed with the Commission on May 1, 2020, and incorporated herein by reference).
4.1 Specimen stock certificate of the Company (reflecting change in par value from $10.00 to $3.33, effective March 6, 1989) (filed as Exhibit 4 to the Company’s registration statement on Form S-8 (File No. 333-11831) filed with the Commission on September 12, 1996, and incorporated herein by reference).
4.2 Indenture, dated as of March 9, 2015, between Hancock Holding Company and The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, N.A. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to Hancock Whitney Corporation’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on March 9, 2015).
4.3 Supplemental Indenture, dated as of June 2, 2020, between Hancock Whitney Corporation and The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, N.A. (filed as Exhibit 4.2 to the Company’s Form 8-K (File No. 001-36872) filed with the Commission on June 2, 2020, and incorporated herein by reference).
4.4 Form of Global Note representing the 6.25% Subordinated Notes due 2060 (filed as Exhibit 4.3 to the Company’s Form 8-K (File No. 001-36872) filed with the Commission on June 2, 2020, and incorporated herein by reference).
*10.1 2014 Long Term Incentive Plan (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Form 8-K (File No. 0-13089) filed with the Commission on April 21, 2014, and incorporated herein by reference).
*10.2 Amendment to the Hancock Holding Company 2014 Long Term Incentive Plan (filed as Appendix A of the Company’s definitive Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A (File No. 001-36872) filed with the Commission on March 17, 2017, and incorporated herein by reference).
*10.3 Hancock Whitney Corporation 2020 Long Term Incentive Plan (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Form 8-K (File Number 001-36872) filed with the Commission on May 1, 2020, and incorporated herein by reference).
*10.4 Amendment to the Hancock Whitney Corporation 2020 Long Term Incentive Plan (filed as Appendix B of the Company’s definitive Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A (File No. 001-36872) filed with the Commission on March 15, 2022, and incorporated herein by reference).
*10.5 Amendment to the Hancock Whitney Corporation 2020 Long Term Incentive Plan (filed as Appendix B to the Company's 2020 Long Term Incentive Plan (filed as Appendix B of the Company's definitive Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A (File No. 001-36872) filed with the Commission on March 11, 2025, and incorporated herein by reference).
*10.6 Hancock Whitney Corporation 2010 Nonqualified Deferred Compensation Plan, restated effective May 25, 2018, (filed as Exhibit 99.3 to the Company’s Form S-8 (File No. 333-258295) filed with the Commission on July 30, 2021, and incorporated herein by reference).
*10.7 Hancock Whitney Corporation 2010 Employee Stock Purchase Plan, amended and restated effective July 1, 2018, (filed as Exhibit 99.2 to the Company’s Form S-8 (file No. 333-258295) filed with the Commission on July 30, 2021, and incorporated herein by reference).
*10.8 Form of Change in Control Employment Agreement between the Company and certain named executive officers effective January 1, 2021 (filed as Exhibit 10.7 to the Company’s Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2022 (File No. 001-36872), filed with the Commission on February 27, 2023, and incorporated by reference).
*10.9 Hancock Whitney Corporation Executive Incentive Plan effective January 1, 2022 (filed as Exhibit 10.8 to the Company’s Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2022 (File No. 001-36872), filed with the Commission on February 27, 2023, and incorporated by reference).
*10.10 Insurance Plan and Summary Plan Description, adopted by the Company effective July 1, 2014 (filed as Exhibit 10.20 to the Company’s Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2014 (File No. 0-13089), filed with the Commission on February 27, 2015, and incorporated herein by reference).
*10.11 Form of Restricted Common Stock Award Agreement effective January 1, 2020 (filed as Exhibit 10.10 to the Company’s Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2022 (File No. 001-36872), filed with the Commission on February 27, 2023, and incorporated by reference).

Table of Contents

*10.12 Form of Restricted Stock Unit Award Agreement effective January 1, 2022 (filed as Exhibit 10.11 to the Company’s Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2022 (File No. 001-36872), filed with the Commission on February 27, 2023, and incorporated by reference).
*10.13 Form of Performance Stock Unit Award Agreement effective January 1, 2020 (filed as Exhibit 10.12 to the Company's Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2022 (File No. 001-36872), filed with the Commission on February 27, 2023, and incorporated by reference).
*10.14 Form of Performance Stock Unit Award Agreement effective January 1, 2022 (filed as Exhibit 10.13 to the Company’s Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2022 (File No. 001-36872), filed with the Commission on February 27, 2023, and incorporated by reference).
*10.15 Form of Hancock Whitney Performance Stock Award Agreement effective January 1, 2025 (filed as Exhibit 10.14 to the Company's Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2025 (File No. 001-36872), filed with the Commission on May 8, 2025, and incorporated by reference).
**19 Hancock Whitney Corporation Insider Trading Policy
**21.1 Subsidiaries of the Company.
**23.1 Consent of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP.
**31.1 Certification of Principal Executive Officer pursuant to Rule 13a-14(a) and Rule 15d-14(a) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.
**31.2 Certification of Principal Financial Officer pursuant to Rule 13a-14(a) and Rule 15d-14(a) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.
**32.1 Certification of Principal Executive Officer pursuant to 18 U.S.C. 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
**32.2 Certification of Principal Financial Officer pursuant to 18 U.S.C. 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
97 Hancock Whitney Corporation Compensation Recoupment Policy (filed as Exhibit 97 to the Company's Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2023 (File No 001-36872) filed with the Commission on February 28, 2024, and incorporated by reference)Compensation Recoupment Policy
101.INS Inline XBRL Instance Document – the instance document does not appear in the Interactive Data File because XBRL tags are embedded within the Inline XBRL document
101.SCH Inline XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema With Embedded Linkbase Documents
104 Cover Page Interactive Data File (formatted as iXBRL and contained in Exhibit 101).
* Compensatory plan or arrangement.
** Filed with this Form 10-K.

Table of Contents

ITEM 16. FORM 10-K SUMMARY

Not applicable.

Table of Contents

SIGNATURES

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the Registrant has duly caused this Report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.

HANCOCK WHITNEY CORPORATION
Registrant
February 26, 2026 By: /s/ John M. Hairston
Date John M. Hairston
President & Chief Executive Officer<br>(Principal Executive Officer)
February 26, 2026 By: /s/ Michael M. Achary
--- --- ---
Date Michael M. Achary
Senior Executive Vice President & Chief Financial Officer<br>(Principal Financial Officer)

Table of Contents

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this Report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the Registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated.

/s/ Jerry L. Levens<br><br>Jerry L. Levens Chairman of the Board, Director February 26, 2026
/s/ Frank E. Bertucci<br><br>Frank E. Bertucci Director February 26, 2026
/s/ Moses H. Feagin Sr.<br><br>Moses H. Feagin Sr. Director February 26, 2026
/s/ Randall W. Hanna<br><br>Randall W. Hanna Director February 26, 2026
/s/ Suzette K. Kent Director February 26, 2026
Suzette K. Kent
/s/ H. Merritt Lane III<br><br>H. Merritt Lane III Director February 26, 2026
/s/ Constantine S. Liollio<br><br>Constantine S. Liollio Director February 26, 2026
/s/ Sonya C. Little<br><br>Sonya C. Little Director February 26, 2026
/s/ Thomas H. Olinde<br><br>Thomas H. Olinde Director February 26, 2026
/s/ Sonia A. Pérez<br><br>Sonia A. Pérez Director February 26, 2026
/s/ Christine L. Pickering<br><br>Christine L. Pickering Director February 26, 2026
/s/ Joan C. Teofilo<br><br>Joan C. Teofilo Director February 26, 2026
/s/ C. Richard Wilkins<br><br>C. Richard Wilkins Director February 26, 2026
/s/Albert J. Williams<br><br>Albert J. Williams Director February 26, 2026

EX-19

Exhibit 19

Hancock Whitney Corporation

INSIDER TRADING POLICY

To comply with federal and state securities laws governing (a) trading in securities of Hancock Whitney Corporation (the “Company”) while aware of “material nonpublic information” concerning the Company, and (b) tipping or disclosing material nonpublic information to outsiders, and to prevent even the appearance of improper insider trading or tipping, the Company has adopted this Insider Trading Policy (“Policy”).

This Policy sets forth (i) the scope of persons and transactions subject to the Policy, (ii) the officers of the Company who are responsible for administration and enforcement of the Policy, (iii) definitions of relevant terms, (iv) the Company’s policies and procedures with respect to insider trading, including prohibited transactions, trading windows and blackout periods, pre-clearance of trades and transfers by certain persons, and certain policies relating to employee benefits plans and “10b5-1 plans” and (v) civil, criminal and disciplinary penalties associated with violations of this Policy and applicable law.

Each person subject to this policy is individually responsible for his or her own compliance with the terms of this Policy as well as all applicable laws. If you have any questions about this Policy, please contact Patricia K. Loupe, our Insider Trading Officer, or our Corporate Secretary.

  • SCOPE

  • Insiders. This Policy applies to all directors, officers and associates of the Company and its subsidiaries and their immediate family members (collectively, “Insiders”) and any other individuals whom the Company may designate as Insiders because they have access to material nonpublic information concerning the Company. It is important to remember that immediate family members of our directors, officers and associates are Insiders and are subject to all of the restrictions generally applicable to our other Insiders. The Insider Trading Officer will notify each other individual designated as an Insider of their status at such times as the Insider Trading Officer deems appropriate.

  • Section 16 Individuals. Each director and executive officer (as identified in our annual report on Form 10-K) of the Company (collectively, “Section 16 Individuals”) is subject to the reporting provisions and trading restrictions of Section 16 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (“Exchange Act”), and the underlying rules and regulations promulgated by the Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”). Additional reporting requirements applicable to Section 16 Individuals are set forth on the attached Exhibit B.

  • Financial and Strategic Insiders. From time to time management of the Company may designate certain individuals as “Strategic and Financial Insiders” and periodically report such designations to the Board of Directors. Insiders will generally be designated as Strategic and Financial Insiders if they routinely possess annual and quarterly financial information for the Company prior to its release to the public or otherwise routinely have access to material nonpublic information. The Insider Trading Officer will notify each person designated as a Strategic and Financial Insider of their status annually or at such other times as the Insider Trading Officer deems appropriate.

  • Transactions. The Policy applies to all trades and transactions (including gifts) in the Company’s securities, including its common stock and any other type of securities that the Company may issue, such as senior or subordinated debt securities, preferred stock, convertible debentures, warrants and options or other derivative securities. The Policy also applies, under certain circumstances, to transactions in the securities of other companies. All references in this Policy to “trading” in the Company’s or any other company’s securities should be read to include all of these types of transactions.

    Exhibit 19

  • Delivery and Acknowledgment. The Policy will be maintained on the Company’s intranet in a location that is generally available to all Company associates and otherwise provided or made available to all directors, officers and associates of the Company and its subsidiaries and designated outsiders. Additionally, each Section 16 Individual and Financial and Strategic Insider will be provided a copy of this Policy upon obtaining such status and upon first receiving a copy of the Policy or any revised versions, each Section 16 Individual and Financial and Strategic Insider must sign an acknowledgment that he or she has received a copy of the Policy and agrees to comply with the Policy’s terms, the form of which is attached hereto as Exhibit A.

  • ADMINISTRATION OF THE POLICY

  • ADMINISTRATION. The Company’s Corporate Secretary is responsible for the administration of this Policy and overseeing the Company’s compliance with all federal and state insider trading laws. The Company’s Board of Directors has designated Patricia K. Loupe as the Company’s Insider Trading Officer, who will assist the Corporate Secretary in the administration and enforcement of this Policy by carrying out the following duties:

  • pre-clearing certain trades and gifts, as described below;

  • responding to all inquiries relating to this Policy and its procedures;

  • announcing the opening and closing of trading windows and special blackout periods and providing other notifications required by this Policy;

  • providing copies of this Policy and other appropriate materials to all current and new directors, officers and associates, and such other persons who the Corporate Secretary or Insider Trading Officer determines have access to material nonpublic information concerning the Company;

  • revising the Policy as necessary to reflect changes in federal or state insider trading laws and regulations; and

  • such other duties as are given to the Insider Trading Officer by this Policy or the Corporate Secretary.

  • INQUIRIES. If you have any inquiries regarding this Policy, including any questions about whether you may have material or nonpublic information, please consult the Insider Trading Officer before trading in any company securities.

  • DEFINITIONS

  • “IMMEDIATE FAMILY MEMBER”. Immediate family members include, whether by blood, marriage or adoption, each Insider’s spouse, children or step children, grandchildren, siblings, parents or step parents, grandparents and in-laws who live in his or her household.

  • “HEDGING”. Hedging transactions include any monetization strategy involving exchange funds, prepaid variable forward contracts, equity swaps, puts, calls, collars, forwards and other derivative instruments. This definition also includes the establishment of a short position/sale in the Company's stock (i.e., the sale of a security that the seller does not own).

  • “MATERIAL” INFORMATION. There is no bright-line test as to what constitutes “material” information. Information is generally considered material if a reasonable shareholder or investor would consider it important in making a decision to buy, sell or hold securities. Any type of information that could reasonably be expected to affect the market price of securities should be considered material. Both positive and negative

    Exhibit 19

  • information may be material. While not intended as a comprehensive list, common examples of material information can include:

  • quarterly or annual financial position or results, including the various underlying elements of the financials, such as revenues, expenses, reserves, charge-offs, interest margin, liquidity etc.;

  • projections or forecasts of future financial position or results, including any changes in projections or forecasts as well as any information as to the continued accuracy of such projections;

  • potential restatements of the Company’s financial statements;

  • credit changes;

  • dividend increases or decreases, stock splits (including stock dividends) or share repurchase plans;

  • proposed mergers, acquisitions, divestitures, tender offers, joint ventures or purchases or sales of significant assets involving the Company or any of its subsidiaries;

  • new products, technologies or developments regarding our customers and clients;

  • public or private offerings or sales of debt or equity securities and non-routine financing or funding transactions;

  • actual or threatened litigation, material disputes, or governmental or self-regulatory investigations or other significant actions by regulatory bodies;

  • cybersecurity incidents;

  • changes in accounting methods, changes in auditors or auditor notification that a company may no longer rely on an auditor’s report; and

  • changes in directors, officers or senior management.

All securities transactions will be viewed after the fact. As a result, before engaging in any transaction, you should carefully consider how people might view your transaction in hindsight.

  • “NONPUBLIC” INFORMATION. Nonpublic information is information that is not generally available to the investing public. If you are aware of material nonpublic information, you may not trade in or make a gift of Company securities until the information has been widely disclosed to the public and the market has had sufficient time to absorb the information. For purposes of this policy, information will generally be considered public at the end of the second full trading day (i.e., two days on which the NASDAQ Stock Market LLC is open for trading) following the public release of the information (which will generally be via a press release or SEC filing). For example, if an announcement is made any time after 9:00 a.m. on a Friday and before 9:00 a.m. the following Monday, the opening of trading on the following Wednesday generally would be the first time at which you could trade.

You should keep in mind that information that is widely known within the Company may still be nonpublic if it has not been generally released to the investing public. You should also keep in mind that, even after a public disclosure, some related matters may remain nonpublic and thus still constitute material nonpublic information.

Exhibit 19

  • STATEMENT OF COMPANY POLICY AND PROCEDURES

  • PROHIBITED TRANSACTIONS

  • No Insider may trade in or make gifts of Company securities while aware of material nonpublic information concerning the Company or during blackout periods applicable to the Insider.

  • No Insider may “tip” or disclose material nonpublic information or give trading advice concerning the Company to any outside person.

  • No Insider may, while in possession of material nonpublic information about any other public company or the Company’s industry sector gained in the course of employment with, or the performance of services on behalf of, the Company, (a) trade in the securities of the other public company or companies within the industry sector while aware of such material nonpublic information concerning that company or the industry sector, (b) “tip” or disclose such material nonpublic information concerning that company or the industry sector to anyone, or (c) give trading advice of any kind to anyone concerning the other public company or the industry sector while aware of such material nonpublic information about that company or the industry sector. Other public companies that Insiders may obtain material nonpublic information about may include customers or vendors of the Company and others with which the Company may be negotiating major transactions, such as an acquisition, investment or sale. Information that is not material to the Company may nevertheless be material to one of those other firms.

  • No Insider may, at any time:

  • directly or indirectly engage in hedging or monetization transactions, through transactions in the Company's securities or through the use of financial instruments designed for such purpose;

  • engage in short sale transactions in the Company's securities; or

  • otherwise engage in transactions, that hedge or offset, or are designed to hedge or offset, any decrease in the market value of the Company’s securities.

  • No director, officer of other employee of the Company (or any other person designated as subject to this Policy) who, in the course of working for the Company, learns of material nonpublic information about a company (1) with which the Company does business, such as the Company's commercial partners, customers and suppliers, or (2) that is involved in a potential transaction or business relationship with the Company, may engage in transactions in that company's securities until the information becomes public or is no longer material.

  • TRADING WINDOWS AND BLACKOUT PERIODS

  • Trading Window and Blackout Period for Section 16 Individuals and Financial and Strategic Insiders. In addition to the prohibitions described above, Section 16 Individuals and Strategic and Financial Insiders may trade in Company securities only during the open trading window, which begins on the open of market on the third business day after each quarterly earnings release conference call and ends at the close of market on the 15th day prior to each quarter’s end. All periods other than the open trading windows are blackout periods, during which Section 16 Individuals and Strategic Insiders are prohibited from trading in Company Securities.

    Exhibit 19

  • No Trading During Special Blackout Periods. The Company may designate special blackout periods from time to time as the Corporate Secretary or Chief Financial Officer deem appropriate, including, without limitation, in connection with the public announcement of a share repurchase plan or program or an increase of an existing share repurchase plan or program. During such special blackout periods, certain designated Insiders will be prohibited from trading in Company securities, regardless of whether there is an open trading window. No Insider, whether or not subject to a special blackout period, may disclose to any outside third party that a special blackout period has been designated.

  • Written Plan Exception. The limitations of the blackout periods shall not apply to trading in Company securities pursuant to a “written plan for trading securities” provided that such plan meets the requirements of SEC Rule 10b5-1 and is approved in advance by the Corporate Secretary. See Section IV.F below.

  • PRE-CLEARANCE OF TRADES

  • Section 16 Individual Trades. No Section 16 Individual may trade in or make gifts of Company securities at any time unless:

  • the person trading has given the Insider Trading Officer reasonable notice prior to the proposed trade(s) of the amount and nature of the proposed trade(s);

  • the person trading has certified to the Insider Trading Officer prior to the proposed trade(s) that he or she is not aware of material nonpublic information concerning the Company; and

  • the Insider Trading Officer (in consultation with the Corporate Secretary or Chief Financial Officer, as appropriate) or Corporate Secretary has granted approval for such trade to move forward.

Clearance of a transaction is valid only for a 48-hour period. If a Section 16 Individual does not place the transaction order within 48-hours from approval of the transaction, he or she must submit a new pre-clearance request to the Insider Trading Officer.

In the event the Insider Trading Officer and Corporate Secretary are unavailable to review proposed trades, any Senior Assistant Corporate Secretary (in consultation with the Chief Financial Officer) may be consulted to review proposed trades and will have full authority to act in lieu of the Insider Trading Officer.

  • Insider Trading Officer Trades. If the Insider Trading Officer desires to complete any trades involving Company securities, he or she must first obtain the approval of the Corporate Secretary or the Chief Financial Officer of the Company generally in accordance with the procedures for pre-clearance of trading by Section 16 Individuals.

  • 10b5-1 Plan Participants. If an Insider that has a 10b5-1 plan in place desires to complete any trades involving Company securities outside the plan, he or she must first obtain the approval of the Corporate Secretary generally in accordance with the procedures for pre-clearance of trading by Section 16 Individuals.

  • Strategic and Financial Insider Trading. Strategic and Financial Insiders are encouraged to pre-clear their trades in Company stock with the Insider Trading Officer.

  • No Obligation to Approve Trades. The existence of the foregoing approval procedures does not in any way obligate the Insider Trading Officer, Corporate Secretary or Chief Financial Officer to approve any trades requested by Section 16 Individuals, Financial and Strategic Insiders, or the Insider Trading Officer.

    Exhibit 19

  • EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLANS

  • Employee Stock Purchase and 401(k) Plans. The trading prohibitions and restrictions set forth in this Policy do not apply to periodic contributions by the Company or associates to the Company Employee Stock Purchase Plan, 401(k) Plan, or other similar employee qualified benefit plan pursuant to the terms and conditions of such plan and where applicable, the associates’ advance instructions. However, no officer or associate may alter his or her instructions regarding the purchase or sale of Company securities in such plans: (i) while aware of material nonpublic information; (ii) in the case of Section 16 Individuals, prior to receiving preclearance of the trade in accordance with this Policy; and (iii) in the case of Strategic and Financial Insiders, while any applicable trading window is closed or special blackout period applicable to such associate is in effect.

  • Long Term Incentive Plan. The trading prohibitions and restrictions of this Policy do not apply to the vesting of restricted stock or the conversion of restricted stock units, or to the exercise of a tax withholding right pursuant to which an Insider elects to have the Company withhold shares upon vesting of restricted stock or conversion of restricted stock units to satisfy tax withholding requirements. The trading prohibitions and restrictions of this Policy do not apply to the exercise of a stock option or to the exercise of a tax withholding right pursuant to which an Insider elects to have the Company withhold shares subject to an option to satisfy tax withholding requirements. The policy does apply, however, to any sale of the underlying stock or to a broker-assisted cashless exercise of an option because this entails selling a portion of the underlying stock to generate the cash needed to pay the exercise price of the option.

  • PRIORITY OF STATUTORY OR REGULATORY TRADING RESTRICTIONS. The trading prohibitions and restrictions set forth in this Policy will be superseded by any greater prohibitions or restrictions under federal or state securities laws and regulations, such as short-swing trading prohibitions by Section 16 Individuals or restrictions on the sale of securities subject to Rule 144 under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended. Any Insider who is uncertain whether other prohibitions or restrictions apply should contact the Insider Trading Officer.

  • RULE 10b5-1 PLANS. Under Rule 10b5-1 of the Exchange Act, it is unlawful for a person to trade in a company’s securities while they are aware of material nonpublic information about the company. However, a person may avoid violating the insider trading rules by use of a plan for the sale or purchase of the securities that complies with certain requirements of Rule 10b5-1 (a “Rule 10b5-1 plan”). To be valid, a Rule 10b5-1 plan must:

  • be entered into when the insider is unaware of material nonpublic information;

  • be entered into in good faith, not as a scheme to evade the prohibitions of Rule 10b5-1;

  • include a representation certifying that the plan was entered into in accordance with 1 and 2 above;

  • include a cooling-off period until the later of (i) 90 days after adoption or modification of the plan and (ii) two business days after filing of the Company’s financial results in a Form 10-Q or Form 10-K for the completed fiscal quarter in which the plan was adopted or modified (not to exceed 120 days) before any trades may be made (10b5-1 plans for persons other than executive officers or directors must include a cooling-off period of 30 days after adoption or modification before any trades may be made);

    Exhibit 19

  • specify the amount, price and date of the transactions (or include a written formula, algorithm, or computer program for determining the amount, price and date);

  • not permit the insider to exercise any subsequent influence over how, when, or whether to effect purchases or sales;

  • not overlap with another Rule 10b5-1 plan of the participant with respect to open market purchases or sales of Company securities; and

  • not be a “single-trade plan” occurring within 12 months of a participant’s most recent “single-trade plan”.

In addition to the regulatory requirements described above, the Company requires that Rule 10b5-1 plans conform to the following practices:

  • Only directors and approved officers may enter into Rule 10b5-1 plans. The Company allows its directors and Section 16 officers to enter into Rule 10b5-1 plans. Additionally, the Company may approve the entry into plans by other officers who are subject to frequent trading blackouts.
  • The Company will designate a nationally-recognized brokerage firm to administer Rule 10b5-1 plans on an approved form of agreement. All Rule 10b5-1 plans will be administered by a nationally-recognized brokerage firm designated by the Company. Participants will need to deposit all shares subject to the plan with the designated firm and enter into a plan agreement with that firm in a form approved by the Company.
  • All Rule 10b5-1 plans and modifications must be provided to the Corporate Secretary for approval at least 30 days before effectiveness. Participants may not enter into, modify or change the termination date of any plan without the Corporate Secretary’s approval. Modifications will be approved only in limited circumstances.
  • Rule 10b5-1 plans may be established for either sales or purchases, not both. Trading under plans is subject to Section 16(b) short-swing profit prohibitions and plans that provide for both purchased and sales may run afoul of these rules.
  • Plans’ terms must last for one to two years. The Company requires that all plans remain in place for at least one year and must terminate after a maximum of two years.
  • Post-establishment communications are prohibited. Once the Rule 10b5-1 plan is adopted, the administering broker and participant should not communicate (other than trade execution notices).
  • Once a Rule 10b5-1 plan is established, trades outside the plan are strongly disfavored and require pre-clearance. Rule 10b5-1 plan participants must pre-clear trades outside the plan. Such trades will be cleared only in limited circumstances.
  • The Company’s legal department does not represent Rule 10b5-1 plan participants. Participants are urged to read the plan agreement in its entirety and to seek professional legal and financial guidance before entering into a Rule 10b5-1 plan.

Any Insider desiring to enter into or modify such a Rule 10b5-1 plan should contact the Corporate Secretary for guidance. Insiders may not enter into, modify or change the termination date of any Rule 10b5-1 plan without the Corporate Secretary’s approval and requests for approval should be provided to the Corporate Secretary at least 30 days prior to the anticipated effective time of the plan, modification or termination. Modifications and changes in termination dates are strongly disfavored by the Company and will be approved only in limited circumstances.

  • MISCELLANEOUS. It is the policy of the Company to comply with all applicable securities laws when transacting in its own securities.

    Exhibit 19

  • POTENTIAL CIVIL, CRIMINAL AND DISCIPLINARY SANCTIONS

  • CIVIL AND CRIMINAL PENALTIES. The consequences of insider trading or tipping can be severe. Persons violating insider trading or tipping rules may be required to disgorge the profit made or the loss avoided by the trading, pay the loss suffered by the person who purchased securities from or sold securities to the Insider or tippee, pay civil penalties up to three times the profit made or loss avoided, pay a criminal penalty of up to $5 million, and serve a jail term of up to twenty years. The Company in such circumstances may also be required to pay major civil or criminal penalties.

  • COMPANY DISCIPLINE. Violation of this Policy or federal or state insider trading or tipping laws by any Insider may, in the case of a director, subject the director to dismissal proceedings and, in the case of an officer or associate, subject the officer or associate to disciplinary action by the Company up to and including termination for cause.

  • REPORTING OF VIOLATIONS. Any Insider who violates this Policy or any federal or state law governing insider trading or tipping, or knows of any such violation by any other Insider, must report the violation immediately to the Corporate Secretary. Upon determining that any such violation has occurred, the Corporate Secretary, where appropriate, shall consult with the Company’s Executive Committee or the Chair of the Audit Committee of the Company’s Board of Directors, to determine whether the Company should release any material nonpublic information, and, when required by applicable law, will cause the Company to report the violation to the SEC or other appropriate governmental authority.

/68229v13

Exhibit 19

Exhibit A

Receipt and Acknowledgment

Upon first receiving a copy of the Company’s Insider Trading Policy or any revised version, each member of the Board of Directors of the Company or its subsidiary banks, each officer designated a “Section 16 Individual” and each Financial and Strategic Insider, must sign and return to the Insider Trading Officer the following receipt and acknowledgement.

I, ____________________________________, hereby acknowledge that I have received and read a copy of the “Insider Trading Policy” and agree to comply with its terms. I understand that violation of insider trading or tipping laws or regulations may subject me to severe civil and/or criminal penalties, and that violation of the terms of the above titled policy may subject me to discipline by the Company up to and including termination for cause.

___________________________________________________ __________________________________

Signature Date

___________________________________________________

(Print Name)

Exhibit 19

Exhibit B

Additional SEC Reporting Requirements and Limitations on

Short-swing Transactions for Section 16 Individuals

Section 16 Individuals and members of their immediate families1 must also comply with the reporting obligations and limitations on short-swing transactions set forth in Section 16 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended. To assure compliance with these additional requirements, Hancock Whitney Corporation (the “Company”) adopted reporting procedures and guidelines, which are described below and are in addition to the other provisions of this Policy.

The practical effect of these provisions is that Section 16 Individuals who purchase and sell the Company’s securities within a six-month period must disgorge all profits to the Company whether or not they had knowledge of any material non-public information. Under these provisions, there are exemptions for transactions with the Company in the Company’s incentive plans, provided the terms are approved in advance by the Company’s independent compensation committee, or certain other criteria are met. Under these exemptions, neither the receipt of an option or other equity award, such as restricted stock, nor the exercise of an option is deemed a purchase under Section 16; however, the subsequent sale of any acquired shares is a non-exempt sale under Section 16. Further, the withholding of shares to cover the taxes due in connection with the exercise or vesting of an award is generally an exempt transaction under Section 16. In contrast, cashless exercises made through a broker (i.e., not a transaction with the Company) are not eligible for the exemption and would be a sale under Section 16. In addition, the receipt of stock under the Company’s qualified employee benefit plan(s), is not deemed a purchase under Section 16, but the subsequent sale of such stock is not exempt from Section 16. Section 16 also prohibits Section 16 Individuals from ever making a short sale of the Company’s stock. A short sale is a sale of securities not owned by the seller or, if owned, not delivered. Transactions in put and call options for the Company’s securities may in some instances constitute a short sale or may otherwise result in liability for short swing profits. All Section 16 Individuals must confer with the Insider Trading Officer and pre-clear these transactions. In addition, all Section 16 Individuals should confirm the availability of any exemption(s) with the Insider Trading Officer in advance of any proposed transaction, and confirm the proper reporting procedure(s).

From a reporting standpoint, the key requirement applicable to Section 16 Individuals is the two-day SEC Form 4 filing requirement. In addition to open market purchases and sales, Section 16 Individuals should assume the two-day Form 4 filing requirement applies to any change in Company stock ownership or ownership of stock equivalents held in retirement plans, except as noted below.

Transactions with the Company are also reported as line items on Form 4 under the two-day rule, for example:

  • The grant of stock options, restricted stock, restricted stock units or similar equity incentives;
  • The withholding of shares on exercise or vesting to pay taxes;
  • The withholding of shares on exercise to pay the exercise price of an option;
  • The forfeiture of restricted stock or restricted stock units;

1 “Immediate family members” include – whether by blood, marriage or adoption – the director’s or executive officer’s spouse, children or step children, grandchildren, siblings, parents or step parents, grandparents and in-laws who live in his or her household. Under some circumstances, directors and executive officers may need to report Company stock held by trusts (in which he or she is the trustee or a beneficiary), as well as partnerships, LLCs or corporations in which the director or executive officer owns interests or serves in management. Section 16 officers may need to include Company stock held in retirement plans. Call the Insider Trading Officer for advice because these are complex questions of law and fact.

Exhibit 19

  • The vesting of restricted stock or restricted stock units;
  • The acquisition of Company stock, an interest in the Company stock fund, or common stock equivalent units under a nonqualified deferred compensation arrangement (but additional stock or stock equivalent units acquired within the plan through the reinvestment of dividends is not immediately reportable);
  • The payment of fees in the form of stock; and
  • The transfer of existing account balances into or out of the Company stock fund in a 401(k) or similar qualified employee benefit plan.2

The Company’s proxy statement must state in a separately captioned section the name of any Section 16 Individual who filed a late Form 4 during the prior fiscal year. The SEC has been granted broad authority to seek “any equitable relief that may be appropriate or necessary for the benefit of investors” for violations of any provisions of the securities laws.

The two-day reporting of transactions requires a tight interface with brokers who handle transactions for the Company’s Section 16 Individuals. A knowledgeable, alert broker can act as a gatekeeper, helping ensure compliance with the Company’s pre-clearance procedures and prevent inadvertent violations.

The Company recommends that any broker handling a trade for a Section 16 Individual sign a Broker Instruction/Representation, in a form substantially similar to the one attached hereto as Exhibit B-1, which imposes two requirements:

  • That the broker will not enter any order (except for orders under pre-approved Rule 10b5-1 plans) without (i) verifying with the Company that the transaction was pre-cleared and (ii) complying with the brokerage firm’s internal procedures involving purchases and sales of Company stock (e.g., Rule 144).
  • That the broker will report immediately to the Company, via telephone and in writing (via e-mail or fax), the details of every transaction involving Company stock, including gifts, transfers, pledges and all 10b5-1 transactions.

Each Section 16 Individual should sign a Power of Attorney (in the form attached hereto as Exhibit B-2) that authorizes the Corporate Secretary, any one of the Senior Assistant Corporate Secretaries or the Manager of Investor Relations of the Company to sign required Forms 3, 4 or 5 on his or her behalf and submit same to the SEC in Washington. The Company has established electronic filing procedures to expedite the filing of Forms 3, 4 and 5.

2 The acquisition of an interest in the Company stock fund by regular, periodic investments of contributions into a 401(k) or other qualified employee benefit plan remains exempt from the two-day Form 4 reporting requirement. These acquisitions continue to be reported on a Form 5 as an increase in the end-of-period holdings.

Exhibit 19

Exhibit B-1

HANCOCK WHITNEY CORPORATION

BROKER INSTRUCTION/REPRESENTATION FORM

The Sarbanes-Oxley Accounting/Corporate Responsibility legislation contains a two business day Form-4 filing requirement. The Company has adopted insider reporting procedures, including a pre-clearance requirement and broker interface procedures. Please review this information carefully and execute this Broker Instruction/Representation Form.

Name of Reporting Person: __________________________________________________________

Name of Broker: __________________________________________________________

Brokerage Firm Name: __________________________________________________________

Address of Brokerage Firm: __________________________________________________________

Broker Telephone Number: __________________________________________________________

REPRESENTATION

By signature below, I hereby agree to the following broker interface procedures:

1) The brokerage firm will not enter any order (except for orders under pre-approved Rule 10b5-1 plans) without (i) verifying with the Company that the Reporting Person’s transaction was pre-cleared, and (ii) complying with the brokerage firm’s internal procedures involving purchases and sales of Company stock (e.g. Rule 144).

2) The brokerage firm will report immediately to the Company, via telephone and in writing (via e-mail or fax) to the contact named below, the details of every transaction involving Company stock, including gifts, transfers, pledges, and all 10b5-1 transactions.

Date: _____________________________ Signature:__________________________________________

Name:

Title:

Please sign and date this Broker Instruction/Representation Form and return it to Kathryn Shrout Mistich, Investor Relations Dept, Hancock Whitney Bank, 701 Poydras Street, 34th Floor, New Orleans, LA 70139 or call (504) 539-7836 or email to kathryn.mistich@hancockwhitney.com before you enter into a broker-assisted transaction for the above named Reporting Person.

Exhibit 19

Exhibit B-2

POWER OF ATTORNEY

Know all by these present that the undersigned hereby constitutes and appoints Kathryn Mistich, Manager, Investor Relations, Allison Montgomery, Shareholder Operations Specialist, or Patricia Loupe, Lead Assistant Corporate Secretary, signing singly, the undersigned’s true and lawful attorney-in-fact to:

  • execute for and on behalf of the undersigned, in the undersigned’s capacity as a director of Hancock Whitney Corporation (the “Company”) or as an officer of the Company or any of its banking subsidiaries, Forms 3, 4, and 5 in accordance with Section 16(a) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, and the rules thereunder;
  • do and perform any and all acts for and on behalf of the undersigned that may be necessary or desirable to complete and execute any such Form 3, 4, or 5, complete and execute any amendment or amendments thereto, and timely file such form with the United States Securities and Exchange Commission and any stock exchange or similar authority, including, without limitation, acting as an account administrator and/or with delegated filing authority to manage EDGAR accounts and make such filings; and
  • take any other action of any type whatsoever in connection with the foregoing which, in the opinion of such attorney-in-fact, may be of benefit to, in the best interest of, or legally required by, the undersigned, it being understood that the documents executed by such attorney-in-fact on behalf of the undersigned pursuant to this Power of Attorney shall be in such form and shall contain such terms and conditions as such attorney-in-fact may approve in such attorney-in-fact’s discretion.

The undersigned hereby grants to each such attorney-in-fact full power and authority to do and perform any and every act and thing whatsoever requisite, necessary, or proper to be done in the exercise of any of the rights and powers herein granted, as fully to all intents and purposes as the undersigned might or could do if personally present, with full power of substitution or revocation, hereby ratifying and confirming all that such attorney-in-fact, or such attorney-in-fact’s substitute or substitutes, shall lawfully do or cause to be done by virtue of this power of attorney and the rights and powers herein granted. The undersigned acknowledges that the foregoing attorneys-in-fact, in serving in such capacity at the request of the undersigned, are not assuming, nor is the Company assuming, any of the undersigned’s responsibilities to comply with Section 16 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.

This Power of Attorney shall remain in full force and effect until the undersigned is no longer required to file Forms 3, 4, and 5 with respect to the undersigned’s holdings of and transactions in securities issued by the Company, unless earlier revoked by the undersigned in a signed writing delivered to the foregoing attorneys-in-fact.

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned has caused this Power of Attorney to be executed as of this _____ day of __________________, 20____.

Signature

Print name

Sworn to and subscribed before me, this ____ day of ________________, 20_____.

________________________________________, Notary Public

Print Name:

Bar/Commission No.

My Commission Expires:

EX-21.1

Exhibit 21.1

Subsidiaries of Hancock Whitney Corporation

Name Jurisdiction
Hancock Whitney Bank Mississippi
Hancock Whitney Equipment Finance, LLC Louisiana
Hancock Whitney Equipment Finance and Leasing, LLC Louisiana
Hancock Whitney Investment Services, Inc. Mississippi
Hancock Whitney New Markets Fund, LLC Louisiana
Hancock Insurance Agency Mississippi

EX-23.1

Exhibit 23.1

CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

We hereby consent to the incorporation by reference in the Registration Statements on Form S-3 (No. 333-285818) and Form S-8 (Nos. 333-284625, 333-240246, 333-238226, 333-232716, 333-219733, 333-174738, 333-195698, 333-130962, 333-171882, 333-185731, 333-258295 and 333-286847) of Hancock Whitney Corporation of our report dated February 26, 2026 relating to the financial statements and the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, which appears in this Form 10-K.

/s/ PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP New Orleans, Louisiana February 26, 2026

EX-31.1

EXHIBIT 31.1

CERTIFICATION

I, John M. Hairston, certify that:

  • I have reviewed this Annual Report on Form 10-K of Hancock Whitney Corporation;

  • Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;

  • Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;

  • The registrant’s other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the registrant and have:

(a) Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;

(b) Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;

(c) Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and

(d) Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the registrant’s most recent fiscal quarter (the registrant's fourth fiscal quarter in the case of an annual report) that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting; and

  • The registrant’s other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the registrant’s auditors and the audit committee of the registrant’s Board of Directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):

(a) All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and

(b) Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting.

February 26, 2026 By: /s/ John M. Hairston
Date John M. Hairston
President & Chief Executive Officer
(Principal Executive Officer)

EX-31.2

EXHIBIT 31.2

CERTIFICATION

I, Michael M. Achary, certify that:

  • I have reviewed this Annual Report on Form 10-K of Hancock Whitney Corporation;

  • Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;

  • Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;

  • The registrant’s other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the registrant and have:

(a) Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;

(b) Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;

(c) Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and

(d) Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the registrant’s most recent fiscal quarter (the registrant's fourth fiscal quarter in the case of an annual filing) that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting; and

  • The registrant’s other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the registrant’s auditors and the audit committee of the registrant’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):

(a) All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and

(b) Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting.

February 26, 2026 By: /s/ Michael M. Achary
Date Michael M. Achary
Senior Executive Vice President & Chief Financial Officer
(Principal Financial Officer)

EX-32.1

EXHIBIT 32.1

CERTIFICATION

Certification Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350

(Adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002)

In connection with this Annual Report on Form 10-K of Hancock Whitney Corporation (the “Company”) for the year ended December 31, 2025, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on the date hereof (the “Report”), John M. Hairston, as Chief Executive Officer of the Company hereby certifies, pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, that to the best of his knowledge:

  • The Report fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934; and

  • The information contained in the Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of the Company.

February 26, 2026 By: /s/ John M. Hairston
Date John M. Hairston
President & Chief Executive Officer
(Principal Executive Officer)

A signed original of this written statement required by Section 906 has been provided to the Company and will be retained by the Company and furnished to the Securities and Exchange Commission or its staff upon request.

This certification shall not be deemed filed by the Company for purposes of §18 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.

EX-32.2

EXHIBIT 32.2

CERTIFICATION

Certification Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350

(Adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002)

In connection with this Annual Report on Form 10-K of Hancock Whitney Corporation (the “Company”) for the year ended December 31, 2025, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on the date hereof (the “Report”), Michael M. Achary, as Chief Financial Officer of the Company hereby certifies, pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, that to the best of his knowledge:

  • The Report fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934; and

  • The information contained in the Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of the Company.

February 26, 2026 By: /s/ Michael M. Achary
Date Michael M. Achary
Senior Executive Vice President & Chief Financial Officer
(Principal Financial Officer)

A signed original of this written statement required by Section 906 has been provided to the Company and will be retained by the Company and furnished to the Securities and Exchange Commission or its staff upon request.

This certification shall not be deemed filed by the Company for purposes of §18 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.